EXHIBIT T3C.1
SENIOR FIRST LIEN NOTES INDENTURE
Dated as of [ ], 2012
by and between
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.
and
Wilmington Trust, National Association
as Trustee
13% SENIOR FIRST LIEN NOTES DUE 2030
CROSS-REFERENCE TABLE*
Trust Indenture Act Section
|
Indenture Section
|
|
|
310(a)(1)
|
8.10
|
(a)(2)
|
8.10
|
(a)(3)
|
N.A.
|
(a)(4)
|
N.A.
|
(a)(5)
|
8.10
|
(b)
|
8.10
|
311(a)
|
8.11
|
(b)
|
8.11
|
312(a)
|
2.05
|
(b)
|
13.03
|
(c)
|
13.03
|
313(a)
|
8.06
|
(b)(1)
|
8.06
|
(b)(2)
|
8.06; 8.07
|
(c)
|
8.06; 13.02
|
(d)
|
8.06
|
314(a)
|
5.05; 5.06; 13.05
|
(b)
|
12.01
|
(c)(1)
|
13.04
|
(c)(2)
|
13.04
|
(c)(3)
|
N.A.
|
(d)
|
N.A.
|
(e)
|
13.05
|
(f)
|
N.A.
|
315(a)
|
8.01
|
(b)
|
8.05; 13.02
|
(c)
|
8.01
|
(d)
|
8.01
|
(e)
|
7.15
|
316(a)(1)(A)
|
7.06
|
(a)(1)(B)
|
7.05
|
(a)(2)
|
N.A.
|
(b)
|
10.02
|
(c)
|
2.12; 10.04
|
317(a)(1)
|
7.09
|
(a)(2)
|
7.13
|
(b)
|
2.04
|
318(a)
|
13.01
|
(b)
|
N.A.
|
(c)
|
13.01
|
N.A. means not applicable.
* This Cross-Reference Table is not part of this Indenture.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Page
|
DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
|
1
|
|
|
|
SECTION 1.01.
|
Definitions
|
1
|
SECTION 1.02.
|
Other Definitions
|
9
|
SECTION 1.03.
|
Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act
|
9
|
SECTION 1.04.
|
Rules of Construction
|
9
|
SECTION 1.05.
|
Acts of Holders
|
9
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE II
|
THE NOTES
|
11
|
|
|
|
SECTION 2.01.
|
Form and Dating; Terms
|
11
|
SECTION 2.02.
|
Execution and Authentication
|
12
|
SECTION 2.03.
|
Registrar and Paying Agent
|
12
|
SECTION 2.04.
|
Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust
|
12
|
SECTION 2.05.
|
Holder Lists
|
13
|
SECTION 2.06.
|
Transfer and Exchange
|
13
|
SECTION 2.07.
|
Replacement Notes
|
14
|
SECTION 2.08.
|
Outstanding Notes
|
14
|
SECTION 2.09.
|
Treasury Notes
|
15
|
SECTION 2.10.
|
Temporary Notes
|
15
|
SECTION 2.11.
|
Cancellation
|
15
|
SECTION 2.12.
|
Defaulted Interest
|
15
|
SECTION 2.13.
|
CUSIP/ISIN Numbers
|
16
|
SECTION 2.14.
|
Calculation of Principal Amount of Securities
|
16
|
SECTION 2.15.
|
No Gross Up; Withholding
|
16
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE III
|
REDEMPTION
|
16
|
|
|
|
SECTION 3.01.
|
Notices to Trustee
|
16
|
SECTION 3.02.
|
Selection of Notes to Be Redeemed
|
17
|
SECTION 3.03.
|
Notice of Redemption
|
17
|
SECTION 3.04.
|
Effect of Notice of Redemption
|
18
|
SECTION 3.05.
|
Deposit of Redemption Price
|
18
|
SECTION 3.06.
|
Notes Redeemed in Part
|
18
|
SECTION 3.07.
|
Optional Redemption
|
18
|
SECTION 3.08.
|
Mandatory Redemption
|
19
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE IV
|
ESTABLISHMENT OF FUNDS AND APPLICATION AND INVESTMENT OF MONIES THEREIN
|
19
|
|
|
|
SECTION 4.01.
|
Maintenance of Collateral Account
|
19
|
SECTION 4.02.
|
Deposit of Runoff Proceeds and Application Thereof
|
19
|
SECTION 4.03.
|
Investment of Funds
|
20
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE V
|
COVENANTS
|
20
|
|
|
|
SECTION 5.01.
|
Payment of Notes
|
20
|
SECTION 5.02.
|
Deposit of Runoff Proceeds Distributions.
|
21
|
SECTION 5.03.
|
Liens
|
21
|
SECTION 5.04.
|
Maintenance of Office or Agency
|
21
|
SECTION 5.05.
|
Reports and Other Information
|
22
|
SECTION 5.06.
|
Compliance Certificate
|
22
|
SECTION 5.07.
|
Limitations on Business Activities
|
22
|
SECTION 5.08.
|
Prohibition on Commingling
|
22
|
SECTION 5.09.
|
Stay, Extension and Usury Laws
|
22
|
SECTION 5.10.
|
Corporate Existence
|
22
|
SECTION 5.11.
|
Security Documents
|
23
|
SECTION 5.12.
|
Reporting of Debt for Tax Purposes
|
23
|
SECTION 5.13.
|
Prohibition on Sale of Interests in Trusts
|
23
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE VI
|
SUCCESSORS
|
23
|
|
|
|
SECTION 6.01.
|
Merger, Consolidation or Sale of All or Substantially All Assets
|
23
|
SECTION 6.02.
|
Successor Corporation Substituted
|
24
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE VII
|
DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES
|
24
|
|
|
|
SECTION 7.01.
|
Events of Default
|
24
|
SECTION 7.02.
|
Acceleration
|
25
|
SECTION 7.03.
|
Other Remedies
|
25
|
SECTION 7.04.
|
Specific Performance
|
25
|
SECTION 7.05.
|
Waiver of Past Defaults
|
26
|
SECTION 7.06.
|
Control by Majority
|
26
|
SECTION 7.07.
|
Limitation on Suits
|
26
|
SECTION 7.08.
|
Rights of Holders of Notes to Receive Payment
|
26
|
SECTION 7.09.
|
Collection Suit by Trustee
|
27
|
SECTION 7.10.
|
Restoration of Rights and Remedies
|
27
|
SECTION 7.11.
|
Rights and Remedies Cumulative
|
27
|
SECTION 7.12.
|
Delay or Omission Not Waiver
|
27
|
SECTION 7.13.
|
Trustee May File Proofs of Claim
|
28
|
SECTION 7.14.
|
Priorities
|
28
|
SECTION 7.15.
|
Undertaking for Costs
|
28
|
SECTION 7.16.
|
Limitation on the Issuer’s Obligations
|
28
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE VIII
|
TRUSTEE
|
29
|
|
|
|
SECTION 8.01.
|
Duties of Trustee
|
29
|
SECTION 8.02.
|
Rights of Trustee
|
30
|
SECTION 8.03.
|
Individual Rights of Trustee
|
31
|
SECTION 8.04.
|
Trustee’s Disclaimer
|
31
|
SECTION 8.05.
|
Notice of Defaults
|
31
|
SECTION 8.06.
|
Reports by Trustee to Holders of the Notes
|
31
|
SECTION 8.07.
|
Compensation and Indemnity
|
31
|
SECTION 8.08.
|
Replacement of Trustee
|
32
|
SECTION 8.09.
|
Successor Trustee by Merger, etc
|
33
|
SECTION 8.10.
|
Eligibility; Disqualification
|
33
|
SECTION 8.11.
|
Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer
|
33
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE IX
|
LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE
|
33
|
|
|
|
SECTION 9.01.
|
Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance
|
33
|
SECTION 9.02.
|
Legal Defeasance and Discharge
|
33
|
SECTION 9.03.
|
Covenant Defeasance
|
34
|
SECTION 9.04.
|
Conditions to Legal or Covenant Defeasance
|
35
|
SECTION 9.05.
|
Deposited Money and Government Securities to Be Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions
|
36
|
SECTION 9.06.
|
Repayment to Issuer
|
36
|
SECTION 9.07.
|
Reinstatement
|
36
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE X
|
AMENDMENT, SUPPLEMENT AND WAIVER
|
36
|
|
|
|
SECTION 10.01.
|
Without Consent of Holders of Notes
|
36
|
SECTION 10.02.
|
With Consent of Holders of Notes
|
37
|
SECTION 10.03.
|
Compliance with Trust Indenture Act
|
39
|
SECTION 10.04.
|
Revocation and Effect of Consents
|
39
|
SECTION 10.05.
|
Notation on or Exchange of Notes
|
39
|
SECTION 10.06.
|
Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc
|
39
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE XI
|
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
|
40
|
|
|
|
SECTION 11.01.
|
Satisfaction and Discharge
|
40
|
SECTION 11.02.
|
Application of Trust Money
|
40
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE XII
|
SECURITY
|
41
|
|
|
|
SECTION 12.01.
|
Security Documents
|
41
|
SECTION 12.02.
|
Collateral Agent
|
41
|
SECTION 12.03.
|
Authorization of Actions to Be Taken
|
42
|
SECTION 12.04.
|
Release of Collateral; Substitution
|
42
|
SECTION 12.05.
|
Powers Exercisable by Receiver or Trustee
|
43
|
SECTION 12.06.
|
No Fiduciary Duties; Collateral
|
43
|
SECTION 12.07.
|
Intercreditor Agreement Controls
|
43
|
|
|
|
ARTICLE XIII
|
MISCELLANEOUS
|
43
|
|
|
|
SECTION 13.01.
|
Trust Indenture Act Controls
|
43
|
SECTION 13.02.
|
Notices
|
44
|
SECTION 13.03.
|
Communication by Holders of Notes with Other Holders of Notes
|
44
|
SECTION 13.04.
|
Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent
|
45
|
SECTION 13.05.
|
Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion
|
45
|
SECTION 13.06.
|
Rules by Trustee and Agents
|
45
|
SECTION 13.07.
|
No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees and Stockholders
|
45
|
SECTION 13.08.
|
Governing Law
|
45
|
SECTION 13.09.
|
Waiver of Jury Trial
|
45
|
SECTION 13.10.
|
Force Majeure
|
46
|
SECTION 13.11.
|
No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements
|
46
|
SECTION 13.12.
|
Successors
|
46
|
SECTION 13.13.
|
Severability
|
46
|
SECTION 13.14.
|
Counterpart Originals
|
46
|
SECTION 13.15.
|
Table of Contents, Headings, etc
|
46
|
EXHIBITS
SENIOR FIRST LIEN NOTES INDENTURE, dated as of [ ], 2012, between Washington Mutual, Inc., a Washington corporation (“
Issuer
”), and Wilmington Trust, National Association, as trustee.
W I T N E S S E T H
WHEREAS, the Issuer has duly authorized the creation of an issue of $110,000,000 aggregate principal amount of 13% Senior First Lien Notes due 2030 (together with any increases in the aggregate principal amount thereof, or any PIK Notes, the “
Notes
”); and
WHEREAS, the Issuer has duly authorized the execution and delivery of this Indenture.
NOW, THEREFORE, the Issuer and the Trustee agree as follows for the benefit of each other and for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes.
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS AND INCORPORATION BY REFERENCE
SECTION 1.01.
Definitions
.
“
Acquisition Credit Facility
” means that financing agreement dated as of [ ], 2012, by and among the Issuer, the guarantors party thereto, the lenders party thereto and [ ], as agent, including any guarantees, collateral documents, instruments and agreements executed in connection therewith, and any amendments, supplements, modifications, extensions, renewals, restatements, refundings or refinancings or replacements (whether upon or after termination or otherwise) thereof in whole or in part from time to time, including any agreement that replaces, refunds or refinances any part of the loans, notes, other credit facilities or commitments thereunder, including any such replacement, refunding or refinancing facility or indenture that increases the amount borrowable thereunder or alters the maturity thereof or adds or removes borrowers or guarantors, and whether with the same or another agent, lender or group of lenders.
“
Affiliate
” of any specified Person means any other Person directly or indirectly controlling or controlled by or under direct or indirect common control with such specified Person. For purposes of this definition, “control” (including, with correlative meanings, the terms “controlling,” “controlled by” and “under common control with”), as used with respect to any Person, shall mean the possession, directly or indirectly, of the power to direct or cause the direction of the management or policies of such Person, whether through the ownership of voting securities, by agreement or otherwise.
“
Agent
” means any Registrar or Paying Agent.
“
Applicable Procedures
” means, with respect to any transfer or exchange of or for beneficial interests in any Global Note, the rules and procedures of the Depositary, Euroclear and Clearstream that apply to such transfer, redemption or exchange.
“
Bankruptcy Law
” means Title 11, U.S. Code or any similar federal law or Chapter 431, Article 15 of the Hawaii Code or any similar state law.
“
Business Day
” means each day which is not a Legal Holiday.
“
Capital Stock
” means:
(1) in the case of a corporation, corporate stock;
(2) in the case of an association or business entity, any and all shares, interests, participations, rights or other equivalents (however designated) of corporate stock;
(3) in the case of a partnership or limited liability company, partnership or membership interests (whether general or limited); and
(4) any other interest or participation that confers on a Person the right to receive a share of the profits and losses of, or distributions of assets of, the issuing Person.
"
Cash Equivalents
" means (a) marketable direct obligations issued or unconditionally guaranteed by the United States Government or issued by any agency thereof and backed by the full faith and credit of the United States, in each case, maturing within six months from the date of acquisition thereof, (b) commercial paper, maturing not more than 270 days after the date of issue rated P-1 by Moody's or A-1 by Standard & Poor's, (c) certificates of deposit maturing not more than 270 days after the date of issue, issued by commercial banking institutions and money market or demand deposit accounts maintained at commercial banking institutions, each of which is a member of the Federal Reserve System and has a combined capital and surplus and undivided profits of not less than $500,000,000 and a Thomson Bank Watch Rating of “BBB” or better, (d) money market accounts maintained with mutual funds having assets in excess of $2,500,000,000, and (e) marketable tax exempt securities rated A or higher by Moody's or A+ or higher by Standard & Poor's, in each case, maturing within six months from the date of acquisition thereof.
“
Clearstream
” means Clearstream Banking, Société Anonyme.
“
Collateral
” means all assets and property in which a security interest is granted to secure the Notes Obligations.
“
Collateral Account
” means a separate securities and/or deposit account established and maintained by the Issuer in which the Collateral Agent has a valid perfected first and second priority security interest and exclusive dominion and control in accordance with the terms of the Security Documents.
“
Collateral Agent
” means [ ], in its capacity as collateral agent under the Security Documents, until a successor replaces it in accordance with the applicable provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement and thereafter means the successor serving thereunder.
“
Control Agreement
” means the Control Agreement, dated as of [ ], among the Issuer, Collateral Agent and [ ], as depository bank and/or securities intermediary, and any other agreement providing to the Collateral Agent “control” of the Collateral Account within the meaning of Articles 8 and 9 or the Uniform Commercial Code.
“
Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee
” shall be at the address of the Trustee specified in Section 13.02 hereof or such other address as to which the Trustee may give notice to the Holders and the Issuer.
“
Credit Facility
” means, with respect to the Issuer or any of its subsidiaries, one or more debt facilities, including the Acquisition Credit Facility, or other financing arrangements (including, with-
out limitation, commercial paper facilities or indentures) providing for revolving credit loans, term loans, letters of credit or other long-term indebtedness, including any notes, mortgages, guarantees, collateral documents, instruments and agreements executed in connection therewith, and any amendments, supplements, modifications, extensions, renewals, restatements, refundings or replacements (whether or not upon or after termination or otherwise) thereof and any indentures or credit facilities or commercial paper facilities that replace, refund or refinance any part of the loans, notes, other credit facilities or commitments thereunder, including any such replacement, refunding or refinancing facility or indenture that increases the amount permitted to be borrowed thereunder or alters the maturity thereof or adds subsidiaries as additional borrowers or guarantors thereunder and whether by the same or any other agent, lender or group of lenders.
“
Custodian
” means the Trustee, as custodian with respect to the Notes, each in global form, or any successor entity thereto.
“
Default
” means any event that is, or with the passage of time or the giving of notice or both would be, an Event of Default.
“
Definitive Note
” means a certificated Note registered in the name of the Holder thereof and issued in accordance with Section 2.06 hereof, substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
hereto, except that such Note shall not bear the Global Note Legend and shall not have the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto.
“
Depositary
” means, with respect to the Notes issuable or issued in whole or in part in global form, any Person specified in Section 2.03 hereof as the Depositary with respect to the Notes, and any and all successors thereto appointed as Depositary hereunder and having become such pursuant to the applicable provision of this Indenture.
“
Euroclear
” means Euroclear S.A./N.V., as operator of the Euroclear system.
“
Exchange Act
” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder.
“
Global Note Legend
” means the legend set forth in Section 2.06(b) hereof, which is required to be placed on all Global Notes issued under this Indenture.
“
Global Notes
” means, individually and collectively, each of the Global Notes, substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
hereto, issued in accordance with Section 2.01 or 2.06 hereof.
“
Government Securities
” means securities that are:
(1) direct obligations of the United States of America for the timely payment of which its full faith and credit is pledged; or
(2) obligations of a Person controlled or supervised by and acting as an agency or instrumentality of the United States of America the timely payment of which is unconditionally guaranteed as a full faith and credit obligation by the United States of America,
which, in either case, are not callable or redeemable at the option of the issuer thereof, and shall also include a depository receipt issued by a bank (as defined in Section 3(a)(2) of the Securities Act), as custodian with respect to any such Government Securities or a specific payment of principal of or interest on any such Government Securities held by such custodian for the account of
the holder of such depository receipt;
provided
that (except as required by law) such custodian is not authorized to make any deduction from the amount payable to the holder of such depository receipt from any amount received by the custodian in respect of the Government Securities or the specific payment of principal of or interest on the Government Securities evidenced by such depository receipt.
"
Governmental Authority
" means any nation or government, any Federal, state, city, town, municipality, county, local or other political subdivision thereof or thereto and any department, commission, board, bureau, instrumentality, agency or other entity exercising executive, legislative, judicial, taxing, regulatory or administrative powers or functions of or pertaining to government.
“
guarantee
” means a guarantee (other than by endorsement of negotiable instruments for collection in the ordinary course of business), direct or indirect, in any manner (including letters of credit and reimbursement agreements in respect thereof), of all or any part of any indebtedness or other Obligations.
“
Holder
” means the Person in whose name a Note is registered on the Registrar’s books.
“
Indenture
” means this Senior First Lien Notes Indenture, as amended or supplemented from time to time.
“
Insurance Book Closing
” means the transfer by WMMRC of (i) all Runoff Proceeds held on the date of such transfer, (ii) the right to receive all future Runoff Proceeds and (iii) the Trusts and their assets along with all insurance liabilities associated therewith as of the date of transfer to a protected cell established and maintained pursuant to § 431:19-303 of Title 24 of the Hawaii Insurance Code in conformance with all applicable Requirements of Law, which complies with the following requirements: (w) the protected cell shall be organized as a direct wholly owned subsidiary of the Issuer; (x) the assets of the protected cell shall not be chargeable with liabilities arising out of any other business WMMRC may conduct; (y) the business plan establishing the protected cell shall restrict its business to the administration and management of the Trusts and the assets thereof along with the liabilities associated therewith, and the distribution of the Runoff Proceeds; and (z) the governing documents of the protected cell shall provide that no dividend or distribution may be made to any Person other than the Issuer as provided for in the Notes Documentation and the Second Lien Documentation.
“
Intercreditor Agreement
” means the Intercreditor Agreement, dated as of [ ], among the Issuer, the other grantors party thereto and [ ], as collateral agent for the First Lien Secured Parties, Second Lien Secured Parties and Third Lien Secured Parties (each, as defined therein) and as authorized representative for [ ], as amended, modified and supplemented from time to time.
“
Interest Payment Date
” has the meaning set forth in paragraph 1 of each Note.
“
Issue Date
” means [ ].
“
Issuer
” means Washington Mutual, Inc., a Washington corporation, and any of its successors.
“
Issuer Order
” means a written request or order signed on behalf of the Issuer by an Officer of the Issuer, who must be the principal executive officer, the principal financial officer, the treasurer or the principal accounting officer of the Issuer, and delivered to the Trustee or the Collateral Agent.
“
Issuer Incremental Amount
” means an amount accruing on the outstanding Issuer Priority Amount or the Issuer Secondary Amount, as applicable, at 13% per annum, payable quarterly in arrears on each Interest Payment Date, to the Issuer.
“
Issuer Priority Amount
” means (i) a principal amount equal to $4.0 million plus (ii) any amounts added due to unpaid Issuer Incremental Amounts in respect of the Issuer Priority Amount, less (iii) any repayments of the Issuer Priority Amounts to the Issuer.
“
Issuer Secondary Amount
” means (i) a principal amount equal to $6.0 million plus (ii) any amounts added due to unpaid Issuer Incremental Amounts in respect of the Issuer Secondary Amount, less (iii) any repayments of the Issuer Secondary Amounts to the Issuer.
“
Legal Holiday
” means a Saturday, a Sunday or a day on which commercial banking institutions are not required to be open in the State of New York, the place of payment or the State of Washington, as the case may be. In any case where any Interest Payment Date, Redemption Date or maturity date of any Note shall not be a Business Day, then (notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture or of the Notes) payment of principal (or premium, if any) or interest need not be made on such date, but may be made on the next succeeding Business Day with the same force and effect as if made on the Interest Payment Date, Redemption Date, or at the maturity date; provided that no interest shall accrue for the period from and after such Interest Payment Date, Redemption Date or maturity date, as the case may be.
“
Lien
” means, with respect to any asset, any mortgage, lien (statutory or otherwise), pledge, hypothecation, charge, security interest, preference, priority or encumbrance of any kind in respect of such asset, whether or not filed, recorded or otherwise perfected under applicable law, including any conditional sale or other title retention agreement, any lease in the nature thereof, any option or other agreement to sell or give a security interest in and any filing of or agreement to give any financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code (or equivalent statutes) of any jurisdiction;
provided
that in no event shall an operating lease be deemed to constitute a Lien.
“
Moody's
” means Moody's Investors Service, Inc. and any successor thereto.
“
Notes
” means the Notes authenticated and delivered under this Indenture including any PIK Notes subsequently issued under this Indenture.
“
Notes Documentation
” means the Notes, this Indenture and the Security Documents.
“
Notes Obligations
” means Obligations in respect of this Indenture, the Notes and the Security Documents, including for the avoidance of doubt, Obligations in respect of guarantees thereof.
“
Obligations
” means any principal, interest, penalties, fees, indemnifications, reimbursements and all other present and future indebtedness, obligations, and liabilities under the documentation governing any indebtedness, whether or not the right of payment in respect of such indebtedness, obligations and liabilities is reduced to judgment, liquidated, unliquidated, fixed, contingent, matured, disputed, undisputed, legal, equitable, secured, unsecured, and whether or not such indebtedness, obligations, interest and liabilities are discharged, allowed, stayed or otherwise affected by any proceeding (including whether or not allowed in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law).
“
Officer
” means the Chairman of the Board, the Chief Executive Officer, the President, any Executive Vice President, Senior Vice President or Vice President, the Treasurer or the Secretary of the Issuer.
“
Officer’s Certificate
” means a certificate signed on behalf of the Issuer by an Officer of the Issuer, who must be the principal executive officer, the principal financial officer, the treasurer or the principal accounting officer of the Issuer, that meets the requirements set forth in this Indenture.
“
Opinion of Counsel
” means a written opinion from legal counsel who is reasonably acceptable to the Trustee. The counsel may be an employee of or counsel to the Issuer or the Trustee.
“
Owner
” means (x) WMMRC until the occurrence of an Insurance Book Closing and (y) the protected cell created by such Insurance Book Closing to which the Runoff Proceeds, the Trusts and the assets thereof are transferred, thereafter, in accordance with the terms of the Notes Documentation.
“
Participant
” means, with respect to the Depositary, Euroclear or Clearstream, a Person who has an account with the Depositary, Euroclear or Clearstream, respectively, (and, with respect to DTC, shall include Euroclear and Clearstream).
“
Permitted Lien
” means a Lien securing Obligations of the Issuer under (i) the Notes Documentation, (ii) the Second Lien Documentation and (iii) the Acquisition Credit Facility, in each case, subject to the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.
“
Person
” means any individual, corporation, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, association, joint stock company, trust, unincorporated organization, government or any agency or political subdivision thereof or any other entity.
“
PIK Interest
” means interest paid with respect to the Notes in the form of increasing the outstanding principal amount of the Notes or issuing PIK Notes.
“
PIK Notes
” mean additional Notes issued under this Indenture on the same terms and conditions as the Notes issued on the Issue Date in connection with a PIK Payment. For purposes of this Indenture, all references to “PIK Notes” shall include the Related PIK Notes.
“
PIK Paymen
t” means an interest payment with respect to the Notes made by increasing the outstanding principal amount of the Notes or issuing PIK Notes.
“
Record Date
” for the interest payable on any applicable Interest Payment Date means with respect to the Notes, the [ ], [ ], [ ] or [ ] (whether or not a Business Day) immediately preceding such Interest Payment Date.
“
Related PIK Notes
” means, with respect to a Note, (i) each PIK Note issued in connection with a PIK Payment on such Note and (ii) each additional PIK Note issued in connection with a PIK Payment on a Related PIK Note with respect to such Note.
“
Requirements of Law”
means, with respect to any Person, collectively, the common law and all federal, state, provincial, local, foreign, multinational or international laws, statutes, codes, treaties, standards, rules and regulations, guidelines, ordinances, orders, judgments, writs, injunctions, decrees (including administrative or judicial precedents or authorities) and the interpretation or administration thereof by, and other determinations, directives, requirements or requests of, any Governmental Authority, in each case that are applicable to or binding upon such Person or any of its property or to which such Person or any of its property is subject.
“
Responsible Officer
” means, when used with respect to the Trustee, any officer within the corporate trust department of the Trustee, including any vice president, assistant vice president, assis-
tant secretary, assistant treasurer, trust officer or any other officer of the Trustee who customarily performs functions similar to those performed by the Persons who at the time shall be such officers, respectively, or to whom any corporate trust matter is referred because of such Person’s knowledge of and familiarity with the particular subject and who shall have direct responsibility for the administration of this Indenture.
“
Runoff Proceeds
” means (a)(i) all net premiums, reinsurance recoverables, net revenue resulting from commutation of insurance contracts, net interest income, reserve releases and other revenues derived from the reinsurance contracts, investments and other assets of the Trusts less, without duplication, (ii)(A) the reasonable and necessary costs and expenses of the Trusts and the Owner (including, but not limited to, general and administrative expenses, audit fees, required regulatory capital contributions (which capital contributions will be added back to the Runoff Proceeds if applicable regulations permit such distributions thereof), expenses of regulatory compliance, including all costs associated with the Insurance Book Closing, expenses of administering this Indenture and taxes) attributable to the administration of the Trusts or the assets thereof and the collection of premiums and/or management of investments in connection therewith (which expenses shall include reasonable and customary expenses attributable to the foregoing paid under any administrative services agreement, investment management agreement or similar agreement), and (B) claims paid for covered losses and (b) the proceeds from the foregoing received by the Owner or the Issuer in cash, securities and/or other property from any sale, liquidation, merger or other disposition in respect of the Owner or its interests in the Trusts or the assets thereof. The inclusion of clause (b) of this definition shall not be construed as a consent to any sale, liquidation, merger or other disposition or waiver of compliance with any covenant related thereto. For the avoidance of doubt, to the extent that Issuer or WMMRC pays any such cost , capital contribution or expense described in clause (ii)(A), payment by Issuer or WMMRC will be deemed a cost or expense of the Trusts.
“
SEC
” means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission.
“
Second Lien Collateral
” means all assets and property in which a security interest is granted to secure the Second Lien Notes.
“
Second Lien Documentation
” means the Second Lien Notes, the Second Lien Indenture and the Second Lien Notes Security Documents.
“
Second Lien Indenture
” means that certain Senior Second Lien Notes Indenture, dated as of [ ], 2012, between the Issuer and the Second Lien Trustee with respect to the Second Lien Notes, as amended or supplemented from time to time.
“
Second Lien Notes
” means $20.0 million aggregate principal amount of the Issuer’s 13% Senior Second Lien Notes due 2030 issued pursuant to and in accordance with the Second Lien Indenture.
“
Second Lien Notes Obligations
” means Obligations in respect of the Second Lien Indenture, the Second Lien Notes and the Second Lien Security Documents, including for the avoidance of doubt, Obligations in respect of guarantees thereof.
“
Second Lien Notes Security Documents
” means , collectively, the Intercreditor Agreement and any security agreements, control agreements and directions to pay relating to the Second Lien Collateral executed and delivered and/or filed and recorded in appropriate jurisdictions to preserve and protect the Liens on the Collateral (including, without limitation, financing statements under the Uniform Commercial Code of the relevant states) related to the security interests granted by any of the foregoing
documents and any other document or instrument evidencing, creating or providing for a Lien on any real or personal tangible or intangible property as security for any or all of the obligations under the Second Lien Documentation.
“
Second Lien Trustee
” means Law Debenture Trust Company of New York, as trustee under the Second Lien Indenture, until a successor trustee replaces it in accordance with the applicable provisions of the Second Lien Indenture, after which time such term shall mean the successor trustee serving thereunder.
“
Securities Act
” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the rules and regulations of the SEC promulgated thereunder.
“
Security Agreement
” means the Security Agreement, dated as of [ ], by and among the Issuer and the Collateral Agent, as the same may be amended, restated, amended and restated, renewed, replaced, supplemented or otherwise modified from time to time.
“
Security Documents
” means, collectively, the Security Agreement, the Intercreditor Agreement, the Control Agreement, other security agreements and directions to pay relating to the Collateral executed and delivered and/or filed and recorded in appropriate jurisdictions to preserve and protect the Liens on the Collateral (including, without limitation, financing statements under the Uniform Commercial Code of the relevant states) related to the security interests granted by any of the foregoing documents and any other document or instrument evidencing, creating or providing for a Lien on any real or personal tangible or intangible property as security for any or all of the Note Obligations under the Note Documents or any of the foregoing documents.
“
Standard & Poor's
” means Standard & Poor's Ratings Services, a division of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. and any successor thereto.
“
Subsidiary
” means, with respect to any Person:
(1) any corporation, association, or other business entity (other than a partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or similar entity) of which more than 50% of the total voting power of shares of Capital Stock entitled (without regard to the occurrence of any contingency) to vote in the election of directors, managers or trustees thereof is at the time of determination owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by such Person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that Person or a combination thereof; and
(2) any partnership, joint venture, limited liability company or similar entity of which
(x) more than 50% of the capital accounts, distribution rights, total equity and voting interests or general or limited partnership interests, as applicable, are owned or controlled, directly or indirectly, by such Person or one or more of the other Subsidiaries of that Person or a combination thereof whether in the form of membership, general, special or limited partnership or otherwise, and
(y) such Person or any Subsidiary of such Person is a controlling general partner or otherwise controls such entity.
“
Trust Indenture Act
” means the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (15 U.S.C. §§ 77aaa-77bbbb).
“
Trustee
” means Wilmington Trust, National Association, as trustee, until a successor replaces it in accordance with Section 8.08 or Section 8.09 and thereafter means the successor serving hereunder.
“
Trusts
” means (a) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. United Guaranty Residential Insurance Company Reinsurance Agreement (Acct. No. x6401); (b) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. Genworth Reinsurance Co. Trust Agreement (Acct. No. x6403); (c) Mortgage Guaranty Insurance Corporation/WM MTG Reinsurance Co. Trust; (Acct. No. x2400); (d) Reinsurance Escrow Agreement among WM Mortgage Reinsurance Co. PMI Mortgage Insurance Company and US Bank (Acct. No. x6404); (e) Radian Guaranty Inc. and WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company Agreement, dated March 27, 2001 (Acct. No. x5700); (f) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. Republic Mortgage Co. Reinsurance Agreement, dated December 14, 1998 (Acct. No. x6402); (g) Washington Mutual Custody Account (Acct. No. x6406); and (h) WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company Inc. (Acct. No. x4202).
“
Uniform Commercial Code
” means the New York Uniform Commercial Code as in effect from time to time.
“
WMMRC
” means WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company, Inc., a Hawaii corporation and direct wholly-owned subsidiary of the Issuer.
SECTION 1.02.
Other Definitions
.
Term
|
|
|
|
|
“Authentication Order”
|
|
2.02
|
|
|
“Covenant Defeasance”
|
|
9.03
|
|
|
“DTC”
|
|
2.03
|
|
|
“Event of Default”
|
|
7.01
|
|
|
“Legal Defeasance”
|
|
9.02
|
|
|
“Note Register”
|
|
2.03
|
|
|
“Paying Agent”
|
|
2.03
|
|
|
“Redemption Date”
|
|
3.07
|
|
|
“Registrar”
|
|
2.03
|
|
|
“Runoff Payment Date”
|
|
4.02(b)
|
|
|
“Runoff Proceeds Distribution”
|
|
4.02(a)
|
|
|
“Successor Company”
|
|
6.01
|
|
SECTION 1.03.
Incorporation by Reference of Trust Indenture Act
. Whenever this Indenture refers to a provision of the Trust Indenture Act (“
TIA
”), the provision is incorporated by reference in and made a part of this Indenture. The following TIA terms have the following meanings:
“
indenture securities
” means the Notes;
“
indenture security Holder
” means a Holder of a Note;
“
indenture to be qualified
” means this Indenture;
“
indenture trustee
” or “
institutional trustee
” means the Trustee; and
“
obligor
” on the Notes means the Issuer and any successor obligor upon the Notes. All other terms used in this Indenture that are defined by the Trust Indenture Act, defined by Trust Indenture Act reference to another statute or defined by SEC rule under the Trust Indenture Act have the meanings so assigned to them.
SECTION 1.04.
Rules of Construction
. Unless the context otherwise requires:
(a)
a term has the meaning assigned to it;
(b)
an accounting term not otherwise defined has the meaning assigned to it in accordance with GAAP;
(c)
“or” is not exclusive;
(d)
“including” means including without limitation;
(e)
words in the singular include the plural, and in the plural include the singular;
(f)
“will” shall be interpreted to express a command;
(g)
provisions apply to successive events and transactions;
(h)
references to sections of, or rules under, the Securities Act shall be deemed to include substitute, replacement or successor sections or rules adopted by the SEC from time to time;
(i)
unless the context otherwise requires, any reference to an “Article,” “Section” or “clause” refers to an Article, Section or clause, as the case may be, of this Indenture; and
(j)
the words “herein,” “hereof” and “hereunder” and other words of similar import refer to this Indenture as a whole and not any particular Article, Section, clause or other subdivision.
SECTION 1.05.
Acts of Holders
.
(a)
Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action provided by this Indenture to be given or taken by Holders may be embodied in and evidenced by one or more instruments of substantially similar tenor signed by such Holders in person or by an agent duly appointed in writing. Except as herein otherwise expressly provided, such action shall become effective when such instrument or instruments or record or both are delivered to the Trustee and, where it is hereby expressly required, to the Issuer. Proof of execution of any such instrument or of a writing appointing any such agent, or the holding by any Person of a Note, shall be sufficient for any purpose of this Indenture and (subject to Section 8.01) conclusive in favor of the Trustee and the Issuer, if made in the manner provided in this Section 1.05.
(b)
The fact and date of the execution by any Person of any such instrument or writing may be proved by the affidavit of a witness of such execution or by the certificate of any notary public or other officer authorized by law to take acknowledgments of deeds, certifying that the individual signing such instrument or writing acknowledged to him the execution thereof. Where such execution is by or on behalf of any legal entity other than an individual, such certificate or affidavit shall also constitute proof of the authority of the Person executing the same. The fact and date of the execution of any such
instrument or writing, or the authority of the Person executing the same, may also be proved in any other manner that the Trustee deems sufficient.
(c)
The ownership of Notes shall be proved by the Note Register.
(d)
Any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action by the Holder of any Note shall bind every future Holder of the same Note and the Holder of every Note issued upon the registration of transfer thereof or in exchange therefor or in lieu thereof, in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by the Trustee or the Issuer in reliance thereon, whether or not notation of such action is made upon such Note.
(e)
The Issuer may, at its option in the circumstances permitted by the Trust Indenture Act, set a record date for purposes of determining the identity of Holders entitled to give any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or take any other act, or to vote or consent to any action by vote or consent authorized or permitted to be given or taken by Holders, but the Issuer shall have no obligation to do so.
(f)
Without limiting the foregoing, a Holder entitled to take any action hereunder with regard to any particular Note may do so with regard to all or any part of the principal amount of such Note or by one or more duly appointed agents, each of which may do so pursuant to such appointment with regard to all or any part of such principal amount. Any notice given or action taken by a Holder or its agents with regard to different parts of such principal amount pursuant to this paragraph shall have the same effect as if given or taken by separate Holders of each such different part.
(g)
Without limiting the generality of the foregoing, a Holder, including the Depositary, may make, give or take, by a proxy or proxies duly appointed in writing, any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action provided in this Indenture to be made, given or taken by Holders, and the Depositary may provide its proxy to the beneficial owners of interests in any such Global Note through such Depositary’s standing instructions and customary practices.
(h)
The Issuer may fix a record date for the purpose of determining the Persons who are beneficial owners of interests in any Global Note held by DTC entitled under the procedures of such Depositary to make, give or take, by a proxy or proxies duly appointed in writing, any request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action provided in this Indenture to be made, given or taken by Holders. If such a record date is fixed, the Holders on such record date or their duly appointed proxy or proxies, and only such Persons, shall be entitled to make, give or take such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action, whether or not such Holders remain Holders after such record date. No such request, demand, authorization, direction, notice, consent, waiver or other action shall be valid or effective if made, given or taken more than 90 days after such record date.
ARTICLE II
THE NOTES
SECTION 2.01.
Form and Dating; Terms
.
(a)
General
. The Notes and the Trustee’s certificate of authentication shall be substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
hereto. The Notes may have notations, legends or endorsements required by law, stock exchange rules or usage. Each Note shall be dated the date of its authentication. The Notes shall be issued in whole dollar ($1.00) amounts and integral multiples of $1.00, subject to the issu-
ance of PIK Interest pursuant to Section 4.02 hereof, in which case the aggregate principal amount of Notes may be increased by, or PIK Notes may be issued in, an aggregate principal amount equal to the amount of PIK Interest paid by the Issuer for the applicable period, rounded up to the nearest whole dollar.
(b)
Global Notes
. Notes issued in global form shall be substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
hereto (including the Global Note Legend thereon and the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto). Notes issued in definitive form shall be substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
hereto (but without the Global Note Legend thereon and without the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto). Each Global Note shall represent such of the outstanding Notes as shall be specified on the face of such Global Note, as increased or decreased in the “Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note” attached thereto and by the payment of PIK Interest and each shall provide that it shall represent up to the aggregate principal amount of Notes from time to time endorsed thereon and that the aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes represented thereby may from time to time be reduced or increased, as applicable, to reflect exchanges and redemptions and the payment of PIK interest by increasing or reducing the aggregate principal amount of such Global Note. Any endorsement of a Global Note to reflect the amount of any increase or decrease in the aggregate principal amount of outstanding Notes represented thereby shall be made by the Trustee or the Custodian, at the direction of the Trustee, in accordance with instructions given by the Holder thereof as required by Section 2.06 hereof or the Issuer in accordance with Section 2.01(d).
(c)
Terms
. The terms and provisions contained in the Notes shall constitute, and are hereby expressly made, a part of this Indenture and the Issuer and the Trustee, by their execution and delivery of this Indenture, expressly agree to such terms and provisions and to be bound thereby. However, to the extent any provision of any Note conflicts with the express provisions of this Indenture, the provisions of this Indenture shall govern and be controlling.
(d)
Issuance of PIK Notes
. In connection with the payment of PIK Interest, the Issuer is entitled to, without the consent of the Holders, increase the outstanding principal amount of the Notes or issue PIK Notes.
SECTION 2.02.
Execution and Authentication
. At least one Officer of the Issuer shall execute the Notes on behalf of the Issuer by manual, facsimile or electronic (e.g. .pdf) signature.
If an Officer of the Issuer whose signature is on a Note no longer holds that office at the time the Trustee authenticates the Note, the Note shall nevertheless be valid.
A Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under this Indenture or be valid or obligatory for any purpose until authenticated substantially in the form of
Exhibit A
attached hereto, as the case may be, by the manual signature of the Trustee. The signature shall be conclusive evidence that the Note has been duly authenticated and delivered under this Indenture.
On the Issue Date, the Trustee shall, upon receipt of an Issuer Order (an “
Authentication Order
”), which order shall set forth the number of separate Note certificates, the principal amount of each of the Notes to be authenticated, the date on which the Notes are to be authenticated, the registered holder of each Note and delivery instructions, authenticate and deliver the Notes. In addition, at any time, from time to time, the Trustee shall upon receipt of an Authentication Order authenticate and deliver any PIK Notes.
The Trustee may appoint an authenticating agent acceptable to the Issuer to authenticate Notes. An authenticating agent may authenticate Notes whenever the Trustee may do so. Each reference
in this Indenture to authentication by the Trustee includes authentication by such agent. An authenticating agent has the same rights as an Agent to deal with Holders or an Affiliate of the Issuer.
SECTION 2.03.
Registrar and Paying Agent
. The Issuer shall maintain (i) an office or agency where Notes may be presented for registration of transfer or for exchange (“
Registrar
”) and (ii) an office or agency where Notes may be presented for payment (“
Paying Agent
”). The Registrar shall keep a register of the Notes (“
Note Register
”) reflecting the ownership of the Notes outstanding from time to time and of their transfer. The Registrar shall also facilitate the transfer of the Notes on behalf of the Issuer in accordance with Section 2.06 and Article XIV hereof. The Issuer may appoint one or more co-registrars and one or more additional paying agents. The term “
Registrar
” includes any co-registrar, and the term “
Paying Agent
” includes any additional paying agents. The Issuer initially appoints the Trustee as Paying Agent. The Issuer may change any Paying Agent or Registrar without prior notice to any Holder. The Issuer shall notify the Trustee in writing of the name and address of any Agent not a party to this Indenture. If the Issuer fails to appoint or maintain another entity as Registrar or Paying Agent, the Trustee shall, to the extent that it is capable, act as such.
The Issuer initially appoints The Depository Trust Company (“
DTC
”) to act as Depositary with respect to the Global Notes representing the Notes.
The Issuer initially appoints the Trustee to act as the Registrar and Paying Agent for the Notes and the Trustee agrees to initially so act.
SECTION 2.04.
Paying Agent to Hold Money in Trust
. The Issuer shall require each Paying Agent other than the Trustee to agree in writing that the Paying Agent shall hold in trust for the benefit of Holders or the Trustee all money held by the Paying Agent for the payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest on the Notes, and will notify the Trustee of any default by the Issuer in making any such payment. While any such default continues, the Trustee may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee. The Issuer at any time may require a Paying Agent to pay all money held by it to the Trustee. Upon payment over to the Trustee, the Paying Agent (if other than the Issuer or a Subsidiary) shall have no further liability for such funds. If the Issuer or a Subsidiary acts as Paying Agent, it shall segregate and hold in a separate trust fund for the benefit of the Holders all funds held by it as Paying Agent. Upon any Event of Default pursuant to Section 7.01(5), (6) or (7), the Trustee shall serve as Paying Agent for the Notes.
SECTION 2.05.
Holder Lists
. The Trustee shall preserve in as current a form as is reasonably practicable the most recent list available to it of the names and addresses of all Holders and shall otherwise comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 312(a). If the Trustee is not the Registrar, the Issuer shall furnish to the Trustee at least five (5) Business Days before each Interest Payment Date and at such other times as the Trustee may request in writing, a list in such form and as of such date as the Trustee may reasonably require of the names and addresses of the Holders of Notes and the Issuer shall otherwise comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 312(a).
SECTION 2.06.
Transfer and Exchange
.
(a)
When Notes are presented to the Registrar with a request to register the transfer or to exchange them for an equal principal amount of Notes of other denominations, the Registrar shall register the transfer or make the exchange if its requirements for such transactions are met; provided, however, that any Note presented or surrendered for transfer or exchange shall be duly endorsed or accompanied by a written instruction of transfer in form satisfactory to the Registrar and the Trustee duly executed by the Holder thereof or by his attorney duly authorized in writing. To permit registrations of
transfers and exchanges, the Issuer shall execute and the Trustee shall authenticate Global Notes and Definitive Notes upon the Issuer's order or at the Registrar's request.
The Registrar shall not be required to register the transfer of or exchange any Note selected for prepayment in whole or in part, except the portion not being paid of any Note being prepaid in part.
The Issuer shall not be required (A) to issue, to register the transfer of or to exchange any Notes during a period beginning at the opening of business 15 days before the day of selection of Notes to be redeemed under Section 3.02 hereof and ending at the close of business on the day of selection, (B) to register the transfer of or to exchange any Note so selected for redemption in whole or in part, except the portion not being paid of any Note being redeemed in part or (C) to register the transfer of or to exchange a Note between a record date and the next succeeding Interest Payment Date.
No service charge shall be made to any Holder of a Note for any registration of transfer or exchange (except as otherwise permitted herein), but the Issuer may require payment of a sum sufficient to cover any transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable in connection therewith (other than such transfer tax or similar governmental charge payable upon exchanges pursuant to Sections 2.10 and 3.06 hereof, which shall be paid by the Issuer).
Prior to due presentment for the registration of a transfer of any Note, the Trustee, any Agent and the Issuer may deem and treat the Person in whose name any Note is registered as the absolute owner of such Note for the purpose of receiving payment of principal of and Interest on such Notes and for all other purposes, and none of the Trustee, any Agent or the Issuer shall be affected by notice to the contrary.
(b)
Each Global Note shall bear a legend in substantially the following form:
“UNLESS THIS CERTIFICATE IS PRESENTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF THE DEPOSITORY TRUST COMPANY, A NEW YORK CORPORATION ("DTC"), NEW YORK, NEW YORK, TO THE ISSUER OR ITS AGENT FOR REGISTRATION OF TRANSFER, EXCHANGE OR PAYMENT, AND ANY CERTIFICATE ISSUED IS REGISTERED IN THE NAME OF CEDE & CO. OR IN SUCH OTHER NAME AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC (AND ANY PAYMENT IS MADE TO CEDE & CO. OR TO SUCH OTHER ENTITY AS IS REQUESTED BY AN AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OF DTC), ANY TRANSFER, PLEDGE OR OTHER USE HEREOF FOR VALUE OR OTHERWISE BY OR TO ANY PERSON IS WRONGFUL INASMUCH AS THE REGISTERED OWNER HEREOF, CEDE & CO., HAS AN INTEREST HEREIN.
TRANSFERS OF THIS GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS IN WHOLE, BUT NOT IN PART, TO NOMINEES OF DTC OR TO A SUCCESSOR THEREOF OR SUCH SUCCESSOR'S NOMINEE AND TRANSFERS OF PORTIONS OF THIS GLOBAL SECURITY SHALL BE LIMITED TO TRANSFERS MADE IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE RESTRICTIONS SET FORTH IN THE INDENTURE REFERRED TO ON THE REVERSE HEREOF.”
(c)
Cancellation and/or Adjustment of Global Notes. At such time as all beneficial interests in a particular Global Note have been exchanged for Definitive Notes or the Issuer has repurchased a particular Global Note or a particular Global Note has been prepaid, repurchased or canceled in whole and not in part, each such Global Note shall be returned to or retained and canceled by the Trustee
in accordance with Section 2.11 hereof. At any time prior to such cancellation, if any beneficial interest in a Global Note is exchanged for or transferred to a Person who will take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in another Global Note or for Definitive Notes, the principal amount of Notes represented by such Global Note shall be reduced accordingly and an endorsement shall be made on such Global Note by the Trustee or by the Custodian at the direction of the Trustee to reflect such reduction; and if the beneficial interest is being exchanged for or transferred to a Person who will take delivery thereof in the form of a beneficial interest in another Global Note, such other Global Note shall be increased accordingly and an endorsement shall be made on such Global Note by the Trustee or by the Custodian at the direction of the Trustee to reflect such increase.
(d)
Owners of interests in the Global Note will be entitled to have individual Definitive Notes registered in their names and to receive certificates in respect thereof if (i) DTC notifies the Issuer in writing that it is no longer willing or able to discharge properly its responsibilities as Depositary with respect to the Notes, or ceases to be a “clearing agency” under applicable law, or is at any time no longer eligible to act as such and the Issuer is not able to appoint a qualified successor within 90 days of receiving notice or becoming aware of such ineligibility, or (ii) DTC or any alternative clearing system on behalf of which the Notes evidenced by a Global Note may be held is closed for business for a continuous period of 14 days (other than by reason of holidays, statutory or otherwise) or announces an intention permanently to cease business or in fact does so, the Issuer will cause sufficient certificates for individual Definitive Notes to be issued, executed and delivered to the Registrar and upon receipt of an Issuer Order by the Trustee, such Notes shall be authenticated and dispatched to the relevant Holders. In connection with any such delivery, a person having an interest in the Global Note must provide to the Registrar a written order containing instructions and such other information and certifications as the Issuer and the Trustee may require to complete, execute and deliver such certificates in respect of individual Definitive Notes.
SECTION 2.07.
Replacement Notes
If any mutilated Note is surrendered to the Trustee, the Registrar or the Issuer or the Trustee receives evidence to its satisfaction of the ownership and destruction, loss or theft of any Note, the Issuer shall issue and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, shall authenticate a replacement Note if the Trustee’s requirements are met. If required by the Trustee or the Issuer an indemnity bond must be supplied by the Holder that is sufficient in the judgment of the Trustee and the Issuer to protect the Issuer, the Trustee, any Agent and any authenticating agent from any loss that any of them may suffer if a Note is replaced. The Issuer and the Trustee may charge the Holder for their expenses in replacing a Note.
Every replacement Note issued in accordance with this Section 2.07 is a contractual obligation of the Issuer and shall be entitled to all of the benefits of this Indenture equally and proportionately with all other Notes duly issued hereunder.
SECTION 2.08.
Outstanding Notes
. The Notes outstanding at any time are all the Notes authenticated by the Trustee except for those canceled by it, those delivered to it for cancellation, those reductions in the interest in a Global Note effected by the Trustee in accordance with the provisions hereof and those described in this Section 2.08 as not outstanding. Except as set forth in Section 2.09 hereof, a Note does not cease to be outstanding because the Issuer or an Affiliate of the Issuer holds the Note.
If a Note is replaced pursuant to Section 2.07 hereof, it ceases to be outstanding unless the Trustee receives proof satisfactory to it that the replaced Note is held by a protected purchaser (as defined in Section 8-303 of the Uniform Commercial Code).
If the principal amount of any Note is considered paid under Section 5.01 hereof, it ceases to be outstanding and interest on it ceases to accrue.
If the Paying Agent holds, on a Redemption Date or maturity date, money sufficient to pay the principal amount of the Notes (or portions thereof) payable on that date and accrued but unpaid interest thereon, then on and after that date such Notes (or portions thereof) shall be deemed to be no longer outstanding and shall cease to accrue interest.
SECTION 2.09.
Treasury Notes
. In determining whether the Holders of the required principal amount of Notes have concurred in any direction, waiver or consent, Notes owned by the Issuer or by any Affiliate of the Issuer, shall be considered as though not outstanding, except that for the purposes of determining whether the Trustee shall be protected in relying on any such direction, waiver or consent, only Notes that a Responsible Officer of the Trustee knows are so owned shall be so disregarded.
SECTION 2.10.
Temporary Notes
. Until certificates representing Notes are ready for delivery, the Issuer may prepare and the Trustee, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, shall authenticate temporary Notes. Temporary Notes shall be substantially in the form of Definitive Notes but may have variations that the Issuer considers appropriate for temporary Notes and as shall be reasonably acceptable to the Trustee. Without unreasonable delay, the Issuer shall prepare and the Trustee shall authenticate Definitive Notes in exchange for temporary Notes.
Holders and beneficial holders, as the case may be, of temporary Notes shall be entitled to all of the benefits accorded to Holders, or beneficial holders, respectively, of Notes under this Indenture.
SECTION 2.11.
Cancellation
. The Issuer at any time may deliver Notes to the Trustee for cancellation. The Registrar and Paying Agent shall forward to the Trustee any Notes surrendered to them for registration of transfer, exchange or payment. The Trustee or, at the direction of the Trustee, the Registrar or the Paying Agent and no one else shall cancel all Notes surrendered for registration of transfer, exchange, payment, replacement or cancellation and shall destroy cancelled Notes (subject to the record retention requirement of the Exchange Act). Upon the request of the Issuer, certification of the destruction of all cancelled Notes shall be delivered to the Issuer. The Issuer may not issue new Notes to replace Notes that it has paid or that have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation.
SECTION 2.12.
Defaulted Interest
. If the Issuer defaults in a payment of interest on the Notes, it shall pay the defaulted interest in any lawful manner plus, to the extent lawful, interest payable on the defaulted interest, in each case at the rate provided in the Notes and in Section 5.01 hereof to the Persons who are Holders on a subsequent special record date. The Issuer shall notify the Trustee in writing of the amount of defaulted interest proposed to be paid on each Note and the date of the proposed payment, and at the same time the Issuer shall deposit with the Trustee an amount of money equal to the aggregate amount proposed to be paid in respect of such defaulted interest or shall make arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee for such deposit prior to the date of the proposed payment, such money when deposited to be held in trust for the benefit of the Persons entitled to such defaulted interest as provided in this Section 2.12. The Issuer shall fix or cause to be fixed each such special record date and payment date;
provided
that no such special record date shall be less than 10 days prior to the related payment date for such defaulted interest. At least 15 days before any such special record date, the Issuer (or, upon the
written request of the Issuer, the Trustee in the name and at the expense of the Issuer) shall mail or cause to be mailed, first-class postage prepaid, to each Holder, with a copy to the Trustee, a notice at his or her address as it appears in the Note Register that states the special record date, the related payment date and the amount of such interest to be paid.
Subject to the foregoing provisions of this Section 2.12 and for greater certainty, each Note delivered under this Indenture upon registration of transfer of or in exchange for or in lieu of any other Note shall carry the rights to interest accrued and unpaid, and to accrue, which were carried by such other Note.
SECTION 2.13.
CUSIP/ISIN Numbers
. The Issuer in issuing the Notes may use CUSIP and ISIN numbers (in each case, if then generally in use) and, if so, the Trustee shall use CUSIP and ISIN numbers in notices of redemption as a convenience to Holders;
provided
, that any such notice may state that no representation is made as to the correctness of such numbers either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption and that reliance may be placed only on the other identification numbers printed on the Notes, and any such redemption shall not be affected by any defect in or omission of such numbers. The Issuer will as promptly as practicable notify the Trustee in writing of any change in the CUSIP and ISIN numbers.
SECTION 2.14.
Calculation of Principal Amount of Securities
. The aggregate principal amount of the Notes, at any date of determination, shall be the principal amount of the Notes, including any PIK Notes issued in respect thereof, and any increase in the principal amount thereof, as a result of a PIK Payment at such date of determination. With respect to any matter requiring consent, waiver, approval or other action of the Holders of a specified percentage of the principal amount of all the Notes, such percentage shall be calculated, on the relevant date of determination, by dividing (a) the principal amount, as of such date of determination, of Notes, the Holders of which have so consented by (b) the aggregate principal amount, as of such date of determination, of the Notes then outstanding, in each case, as determined in accordance with the preceding sentence, Section 2.08 and Section 2.09 of this Indenture. Any such calculation made pursuant to this Section 2.14 shall be made by the Issuer and delivered to the Trustee pursuant to an Officer’s Certificate.
SECTION 2.15.
No Gross Up; Withholding
. The Issuer shall not be obligated to pay additional amounts to the Holders or beneficial owners of the Notes as a result of any withholding or deduction for, or an account of, any present or future taxes, duties, assessments, withholding or governmental change with respect to the Notes. Because the status of the Second Lien Notes is unclear, it is anticipated that distributions on the Second Lien Notes is subject to U.S. federal income withholding tax.
ARTICLE III
REDEMPTION
SECTION 3.01.
Notices to Trustee
. If the Issuer elects to redeem the Notes pursuant to Section 3.07 hereof, it shall furnish to the Trustee, at least five (5) Business Days (or such shorter period as allowed by the Trustee) before notice of redemption is required to be mailed or caused to be mailed to Holders pursuant to Section 3.03 hereof but not more than 60 days before a Redemption Date, an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer setting forth (i) the paragraph or subparagraph of such Note and/or Section of this Indenture pursuant to which the redemption shall occur, (ii) the Redemption Date, (iii) the principal amount of the Notes, to be redeemed and (iv) the redemption price.
SECTION 3.02.
Selection of Notes to Be Redeemed
. If less than all of the Notes are to be redeemed at any time, the Trustee shall select the Notes of such series to be redeemed (a) if the Notes are listed on any national securities exchange, in compliance with the requirements of the principal national securities exchange on which the Notes are listed or (b) on a
pro rata
basis to the extent practicable, or, if the
pro rata
basis is not practicable for any reason, by lot or by such other method the Trustee shall deem fair and appropriate. In the event of partial redemption by lot, the particular Notes to be redeemed shall be selected, unless otherwise provided herein, not less than 30 nor more than 60 days prior to the Redemption Date by the Trustee from the outstanding Notes not previously called for redemption.
The Trustee shall promptly notify the Issuer in writing of the Notes selected for redemption and, in the case of any Note selected for partial redemption, the principal amount thereof to be redeemed. Notes and portions of Notes selected shall be in whole dollar ($1.00) amounts or whole dollar multiples in excess thereof. Except as provided in the preceding sentence, provisions of this Indenture that apply to Notes called for redemption also apply to portions of Notes called for redemption.
SECTION 3.03.
Notice of Redemption
. The Issuer shall request and the Trustee shall be authorized to provide a list of record holders, as of a date determined by the Issuer. The Issuer shall mail or cause to be mailed by first-class mail notices of redemption at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder of Notes to be redeemed at such Holder’s registered address appearing in the Note Register or otherwise in accordance with Applicable Procedures. Notices of redemption may not be conditional.
The notice shall identify the Notes to be redeemed and shall state:
(a)
the Redemption Date;
(b)
if any Note is to be redeemed in part only, the portion of the principal amount of that Note that is to be redeemed and that, after the Redemption Date upon surrender of such Note, a new Note or Notes in principal amount equal to the unredeemed portion of the original Note representing the same indebtedness to the extent not redeemed will be issued in the name of the Holder of the Notes upon cancellation of the original Note;
(c)
the name and address of the Paying Agent;
(d)
that Notes called for redemption must be surrendered to the Paying Agent to collect the redemption price;
(e)
that, unless the Issuer defaults in making such redemption payment, interest on Notes called for redemption ceases to accrue on and after the Redemption Date;
(f)
the paragraph or subparagraph of the Notes and/or Section of this Indenture pursuant to which the Notes called for redemption are being redeemed; and
(g)
the CUSIP and ISIN number, if any, printed on the Notes being redeemed and that no representation is made as to the correctness or accuracy of any such CUSIP and ISIN number that is listed in such notice or printed on the Notes.
At the Issuer’s request, the Trustee shall give the notice of redemption in the Issuer’s name and at its expense;
provided
that the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee, at least five (5) Business Days before notice of redemption is required to be mailed or caused to be mailed to Holders pursuant to this Section 3.03 (unless a shorter notice shall be agreed to by the Trustee), an Officer’s Certificate of
the Issuer requesting that the Trustee give such notice (in which case the Issuer shall provide to the Trustee the complete form of such notice in the name and at the expense of the Issuer) and setting forth the information to be stated in such notice as provided in the preceding paragraph.
The Issuer may provide in the notice of redemption that payment of the redemption price and performance of the Issuer’s obligations with respect to such redemption or purchase may be performed by another Person.
SECTION 3.04.
Effect of Notice of Redemption
. Once notice of redemption is mailed in accordance with Section 3.03 hereof, Notes called for redemption become irrevocably due and payable on the Redemption Date at the redemption price. The notice, if mailed in a manner herein provided, shall be conclusively presumed to have been given, whether or not the Holder receives such notice. In any case, failure to give such notice by mail or any defect in the notice to the Holder of any Note designated for redemption in whole or in part shall not affect the validity of the proceedings for the redemption of any other Note. Subject to Section 3.05 hereof, on and after the Redemption Date, interest ceases to accrue on Notes or portions of Notes called for redemption.
SECTION 3.05.
Deposit of Redemption Price
.
(a)
Prior to 11:00 a.m. (New York City time) on the Redemption Date, the Issuer shall deposit with the Trustee or with the Paying Agent money sufficient to pay the redemption price of and accrued and unpaid interest on all Notes to be redeemed on that Redemption Date. The Trustee or the Paying Agent shall promptly, and in any event within two (2) Business Days after the Redemption Date, return to the Issuer any money deposited with the Trustee or the Paying Agent by the Issuer in excess of the amounts necessary to pay the redemption price of, and accrued and unpaid interest on, all Notes to be redeemed.
(b)
If the Issuer complies with the provisions of the preceding paragraph (a), on and after the Redemption Date, interest shall cease to accrue on the applicable series of Notes or the portions of Notes called for redemption, whether or not such Notes are presented for payment. If a Note is redeemed on or after a Record Date but on or prior to the related Interest Payment Date, then any accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date shall be paid to the Person in whose name such Note was registered at the close of business on such Record Date. If any Note called for redemption shall not be so paid upon surrender for redemption because of the failure of the Issuer to comply with the preceding paragraph, interest shall be paid on the unpaid principal, from the Redemption Date until such principal is paid, and to the extent lawful on any interest accrued to the Redemption Date not paid on such unpaid principal, in each case at the rate provided in the Notes and in Section 5.01 hereof.
SECTION 3.06.
Notes Redeemed in Part
. Upon surrender of a Note that is redeemed in part, the Issuer shall issue and the Trustee shall authenticate for the Holder at the expense of the Issuer a new Note equal in principal amount to the unredeemed portion of the Note surrendered representing the same indebtedness to the extent not redeemed;
provided
that each new Note will be in a whole dollar ($1.00) principal amount. It is understood that, notwithstanding anything in this Indenture to the contrary, only an Authentication Order and not an Opinion of Counsel or Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer is required for the Trustee to authenticate such new Note.
SECTION 3.07.
Optional Redemption
. At any time the Notes may be redeemed or purchased (by the Issuer or any other Person designated by the Issuer), in whole or in part, at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of Notes redeemed (the “
Redemption Date
”), and, without duplication, accrued and unpaid interest to the Redemption Date, subject to the rights of Holders on
the relevant Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date. Any redemption pursuant to this Section 3.07 shall be made pursuant to the provisions of Sections 3.01 through 3.06 hereof.
SECTION 3.08.
Mandatory Redemption
. The Issuer shall not be required to make any mandatory redemption or sinking fund payments with respect to the Notes (other than pursuant to Section 4.02).
ARTICLE IV
ESTABLISHMENT OF FUNDS AND APPLICATION AND INVESTMENT OF MONIES THEREIN
SECTION 4.01.
Maintenance of Collateral Account
. The Issuer shall maintain the Collateral Account at all times.
SECTION 4.02.
Deposit of Runoff Proceeds and Application Thereof
.
(a)
Issuer shall, and shall cause the Owner to, deposit all distributions, dividends or other receipts in respect of Runoff Proceeds on the date paid to the Issuer (“Runoff Proceeds Distributions”) directly into the Collateral Account. If Issuer shall nevertheless receive any Runoff Proceeds Distributions other than by deposit directly into the Collateral Account, it shall cause all such Runoff Proceeds Distributions to be deposited into the Collateral Account on the same Business Day on which they are received. Runoff Proceeds Distributions shall not be deposited in any deposit or securities account other than the Collateral Account, and all such Runoff Proceeds Distributions, while not held in the Collateral Account shall be held by the Issuer in trust for the Collateral Agent and shall not be commingled with any other assets of the Issuer.
(b)
Subject to Section 7.14, on each Interest Payment Date, all amounts on deposit in the Collateral Account and any other Runoff Proceeds Distributions shall be applied in the following order (each such date of application, a “
Runoff Payment Date
”):
(i)
FIRST: To the pro rata payment of any compensation, fees and expenses, if any, due to the Trustee, the Second Lien Trustee and the Collateral Agent on such Runoff Payment Date for any services rendered under the Indenture, the Second Lien Indenture or the Security Documents.
(ii)
SECOND: To the payment to the Issuer of an amount equal to the Issuer Incremental Amount accrued, if any, since the immediately preceding Interest Payment Date on the Issuer Priority Amount.
(iii)
THIRD: To the payment to the Issuer of an amount equal to any unpaid Issuer Priority Amount.
(iv)
FOURTH: To the payment to the Holders of any accrued and unpaid interest, if any, with respect to the Notes; provided, however, that if on any Runoff Payment Date the Runoff Proceeds Distributions are not sufficient for such purposes, then any accrued and unpaid interest, if any, shall be paid as PIK Interest or as additional principal in accordance with the terms of the Notes.
(v)
FIFTH: To the payment to the Holders of any unpaid principal and other Notes Obligations, if any, with respect to the Notes.
After the payments required by paragraphs FIRST, SECOND, THIRD, FOURTH and FIFTH above have been made, the balance on deposit in the Collateral Account shall be paid as provided in the Intercreditor Agreement.
1
(c)
Any Issuer Incremental Amount not paid with respect to the Issuer Priority Amount or Issuer Secondary Amount on any Interest Payment Date, shall be added to the then outstanding Issuer Priority Amount or Issuer Secondary Amount, as applicable.
SECTION 4.03.
Investment of Funds
. All moneys in the Collateral Account shall be invested at the written direction of an Officer of the Issuer in cash and Cash Equivalents. On each Interest Payment Date on which any Cash Equivalents are held in or credited to the Collateral Account, the Collateral Agent shall sell or otherwise convert such Cash Equivalents to cash in order to make the payments provided above.
ARTICLE V
COVENANTS
SECTION 5.01.
Payment of Notes
. The Issuer shall pay or cause to be paid the principal of and interest on the Notes on the dates and in the manner provided in the Notes (in the case of the payment of principal and interest in cash, only to the extent funds are available therefor) as provided for in paragraphs FOURTH and FIFTH of Section 4.02(b) herein. Principal and interest shall be considered paid on the date due if the Paying Agent holds as of 11:00 a.m. Eastern Time on the due date money deposited by the Issuer or transferred from the Collateral Account in immediately available funds and designated for and sufficient to pay all principal, premium, if any, and interest then due. PIK Interest shall be considered paid on the date due if the Trustee is directed on or prior to such date to issue PIK Notes or increase the principal amount of the applicable Notes, in each case in an amount equal to the amount of the applicable PIK Interest.
The Issuer shall pay interest (including post-petition interest in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law whether or not allowed) on, (i) overdue principal at the rate that is 2% higher than the
___________________________________
1
|
The Intercreditor Agreement shall provide a waterfall generally as follows: (a) as set forth in clauses (i) – (v), then (b) to the payment to the Issuer of an amount equal to the Issuer Incremental Amount accrued since the immediately preceding Interest Payment Date on the Issuer Secondary Amount, and then to the payment to the Issuer of an amount equal to any unpaid Issuer Secondary Amount; provided, however, that if on any Runoff Payment Date the Runoff Proceeds Distributions are not sufficient for such purposes, then interest shall continue to accrue on such unpaid Issuer Secondary Amount, then (c) to the payment to the Second Lien Noteholders of any accrued and unpaid interest, if any, with respect to the Second Lien Notes; provided, however, that if on any Runoff Payment Date the Runoff Proceeds Distributions are not sufficient for such purposes, then any accrued and unpaid interest, if any, shall be paid as PIK Interest or as additional principal in accordance with the terms of the Second Lien Notes, then (d) to the payment to the Second Lien Noteholders of any unpaid principal, if any, with respect to the Second Lien Notes. After making the payments required by clauses (a) through (d) above, the balance on deposit in the Collateral Account shall be paid to the Issuer, free and clear of the Lien established in respect of the Notes and the Second Lien Notes, to be transferred, used, or paid at the direction of the Issuer; provided, however, that upon the occurrence and continuation of an Event of Default, such balance shall not be paid to the Issuer and shall be held in the Collateral Account.
|
then applicable interest rate on the Notes to the extent lawful, and (ii) overdue installments of interest (without regard to any applicable grace period) at the same rate to the extent lawful, provided, however that with respect to clauses (i) and (ii) above, payments of interest shall only be made in cash to the extent moneys are in the Collateral Account in accordance with Article IV.
SECTION 5.02.
Deposit of Runoff Proceeds Distributions
. (a) So long as the Owner shall have accumulated Runoff Proceeds at such time, the Issuer shall cause the Owner to use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain the appropriate regulatory approval on or before the ninetieth (90th) day following the end of each fiscal year (or more frequently as the Issuer may in good faith determine to be commercially reasonable), of a dividend or distribution of the maximum amount of undistributed Runoff Proceeds that could reasonably be expected to be approved after consulting with the Owner’s Hawaiian regulatory advisers and counsel, and within three (3) Business Days of the receipt of such approval, to pay to the Issuer such dividend or distribution and deposit such dividend or distribution on the date paid directly into the Collateral Account.
(b) On the Issue Date, the Issuer will irrevocably instruct and authorize WMMRC in writing (which instruction shall be applicable to the protected cell following an Insurance Book Closing) to deposit all Runoff Proceeds Distributions into the Collateral Account.
SECTION 5.03.
Liens
. (a) The Issuer will not, and will cause the Owner not to, directly or indirectly, create, incur, assume or suffer to exist any Lien of any kind (except Permitted Liens) on the Collateral, the equity interests issued by the Owner, any interests of the Owner in any of the Trusts or assets thereof, Runoff Proceeds Distributions or any Runoff Proceeds, or any proceeds of any of the foregoing.
(b) The Issuer will, and will cause WMMRC to, use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain approval from the applicable regulatory authorities to: (i) effect, as soon as reasonably practicable, the Insurance Book Closing and (ii) grant a first priority perfected security interest (subject to whatever limitations or conditions any such authority may impose) under the Security Documents in the equity issued by the Owner (including, upon the Insurance Book Closing, the protected cell to which the Trusts and their assets are transferred) and, after the Insurance Book Closing, the excess assets of the Owner. As soon as reasonably practicable following receipt of the necessary regulatory approvals, the Issuer will, and will cause WMMRC to, consummate the Insurance Book Closing and grant such security interest, which for clarification purposes, may occur at different times depending on the timing of the receipt of such necessary regulatory approvals.
SECTION 5.04.
Maintenance of Office or Agency
. The Issuer shall maintain the offices or agencies (which may be an office of the Trustee or an affiliate of the Trustee, Registrar or co-registrar), as required under Section 2.03 where Notes may be surrendered for registration of transfer or for exchange and where notices and demands to or upon the Issuer in respect of the Notes and this Indenture may be served. The Issuer shall give prompt written notice to the Trustee of the location, and any change in the location, of such office or agency. If at any time the Issuer shall fail to maintain any such required office or agency or shall fail to furnish the Trustee with the address thereof, such presentations, surrenders, notices and demands may be made or served at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee.
The Issuer may also from time to time designate one or more other offices or agencies where the Notes may be presented or surrendered for any or all such purposes and may from time to time rescind such designations;
provided
that no such designation or rescission shall in any manner relieve the Issuer of its obligation to maintain such offices or agencies as required by Section 2.03 for such purposes. The Issuer shall give prompt written notice to the Trustee of any such designation or rescission and of any change in the location of any such other office or agency.
The Issuer hereby designates the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee as one such office or agency of the Issuer in accordance with Section 2.03 hereof.
SECTION 5.05.
Reports and Other Information
. The Issuer shall, and shall cause the Owner to, provide to the Holders or cause the Trustee to provide to the Holders (a) an annual audited balance sheet and income statement of the Issuer and the Owner within 90 days following the end of each fiscal year and (b) monthly unaudited balance sheets and income statements of the Owner and each of the Trusts and the account statement of each segregated account into which any Runoff Proceeds are deposited within 45 days following the end of each month. The Issuer shall, and shall cause the Owner to, provide to the Holders or cause the Trustee to provide to the Holders a monthly statement of the Collateral Account, including the amount and nature of any of its investments and any gain or loss associated therewith, within 30 days following the end of each month.
SECTION 5.06.
Compliance Certificate
. So long as any of the Notes are outstanding, the Issuer will deliver to the Trustee, within 5 Business Days after any Officer becomes aware of any Default or Event of Default, an Officers’ Certificate specifying such Default or Event of Default and what action the Issuer is taking or propose to take with respect thereto. The Issuer shall furnish to the Trustee not less than annually, an Officers’ Certificate as to his or her knowledge of the Issuer’s compliance with all conditions and covenants under the Indenture.
SECTION 5.07.
Limitation on Business Activities
. The Issuer shall cause the Owner (i) to engage in no activities, other than administering the Trusts, collecting premiums and depositing the Runoff Proceeds Distributions into the Collateral Account and activities incidental thereto, (ii) to not originate any new insurance policies, and (iii) to not create, incur, issue, assume, guarantee or suffer to exist any indebtedness. The Issuer shall not permit the Owner to invest, or allow to be invested, any of the assets of the Trusts except in accordance with the applicable trust documents and substantially in accordance with past practices.
SECTION 5.08.
Prohibition on Commingling
. The Issuer shall cause the Owner to deposit all Runoff Proceeds released to it from the Trusts into a segregated account, which account shall consist solely of such Runoff Proceeds and proceeds thereof or interest thereon, and to hold such amounts in the segregated account until such time as they are distributed as Runoff Proceeds Distributions as provided for in Article IV hereof and will invest the same only in cash and Cash Equivalents. The Issuer shall cause the Owner to not deposit such Runoff Proceeds and other amounts in any deposit or securities account other than the segregated account referred to in the preceding sentence, and all such amounts shall be held by the Owner in trust for distribution as provided for in Article IV hereof and shall not be commingled with any other assets of the Owner or the Issuer.
SECTION 5.09.
Stay, Extension and Usury Laws
. The Issuer covenants (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) that it shall not at any time insist upon, plead, or in any manner whatsoever claim or take the benefit or advantage of, any stay, extension or usury law wherever enacted, now or at any time hereafter in force, that may affect the covenants or the performance of this Indenture; and the Issuer (to the extent that it may lawfully do so) hereby expressly waives all benefit or advantage of any such law, and covenant that it shall not, by resort to any such law, hinder, delay or impede the execution of any power herein granted to the Trustee, but shall suffer and permit the execution of every such power as though no such law has been enacted.
SECTION 5.10.
Corporate Existence
. Except as permitted by Article VI or required by 5.03(b), the Issuer shall do or cause to be done all things necessary (i) to preserve and keep in full force and effect its corporate existence, and the corporate, partnership or other existence of the Owner in
accordance with the respective organizational documents of the Issuer or the Owner (which, in the case of the Owner, will not be amended except as necessary to comply with regulatory requirements, effect the Insurance Book Closing and to maintain the ability to pay dividends), (ii) to maintain its direct ownership and voting control over 100% of the equity issued by the Owner (iii) to preserve and keep in full force and effect the rights (charter and statutory), licenses and franchises of the Issuer and the Owner; provided that the Issuer shall not be required to preserve any such right, license or franchise described in this clause (iii) if the preservation thereof is no longer necessary for the administration of the Trusts or collection of the Runoff Proceeds and that the loss thereof is not adverse in any material respect to the Holders of the Notes, taken as a whole, and (iv) to not consolidate or merge the Owner with or into another Person.
SECTION 5.11.
Security Documents
. The Issuer will and will cause the Owner to comply with the terms of each Security Document to which it is a party.
SECTION 5.12.
Reporting of Debt for Tax Purposes
. The Issuer shall treat the Runoff Notes as debt for federal income tax purposes, and shall use commercially reasonable efforts to defend such treatment in connections with any examination or subsequent proceedings.
SECTION 5.13.
Prohibition on Sale of Interests in Trusts
. Except pursuant to an Insurance Book Closing and required by this Indenture, the Issuer will cause the Owner not to, directly or indirectly, (a) sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its interest in any of the Trusts, (b) permit any Trust to sell, lease, transfer or otherwise dispose of any of its assets other than in the ordinary course of administering and managing the assets of the Trust in accordance with the trust documents and investment policies of the Owner or (c) enter into any contract, agreement or understanding to effectuate (a) or (b) above.
ARTICLE VI
SUCCESSORS
SECTION 6.01.
Merger, Consolidation or Sale of All or Substantially All Assets
.
The Issuer shall not, directly or indirectly, consolidate or merge with or into or wind up into (whether or not the Issuer is the surviving corporation), and shall not sell, assign, transfer, lease, convey or otherwise dispose of all or substantially all of the properties or assets of the Issuer, in one or more related transactions, to any Person unless:
(1) the Issuer is the surviving corporation or the Person formed by or surviving any such consolidation or merger (if other than the Issuer) or the Person to whom such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition will have been made, is a Person organized or existing under the laws of the United States, any state or territory thereof or the District of Columbia (such Person, as the case may be, being herein called the “
Successor Company
”);
provided
that in the case where the Successor Company is not a corporation, a co-obligor of the Notes is a corporation, organized or existing under any such laws;
(2) the Successor Company, if other than the Issuer, expressly assumes all the Notes Obligations pursuant to a supplemental indenture or other documents or instruments in form reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee (subject to the non-recourse provisions contained herein);
(3) at the time of such transaction, no Default exists and after giving effect to such transaction, no Default would exist;
(4) immediately after such transaction, WMMRC continues to be a direct or indirect wholly-owned subsidiary of the Successor Company; and
(5) the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel, each stating that such consolidation, merger or transfer and such supplemental indentures, if any, comply with this Indenture, the Notes and the Security Documents.
SECTION 6.02.
Successor Corporation Substituted
. Upon any consolidation or merger, or any sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition of all or substantially all of the assets of the Issuer in accordance with Section 6.01(a) hereof, the successor corporation formed by such consolidation or into or with which the Issuer is merged or to which such sale, assignment, transfer, lease, conveyance or other disposition is made shall succeed to, and be substituted for (so that from and after the date of such consolidation, merger, sale, lease, conveyance or other disposition, the provisions of this Indenture and the Security Documents referring to the Issuer shall refer instead to the successor corporation and not to the Issuer), and may exercise every right and power of the Issuer under this Indenture and the Security Documents with the same effect as if such successor Person had been named as the Issuer herein and therein;
provided
that the predecessor Issuer shall not be relieved from the obligation to pay the principal of and interest on the Notes except in the case of a sale, assignment, transfer, conveyance or other disposition of all of the Issuer’s assets that meets the requirements of Section 6.01 hereof.
ARTICLE VII
DEFAULTS AND REMEDIES
SECTION 7.01.
Events of Default
. An “
Event of Default
” wherever used herein, means any one of the following events (whatever the reason for such Event of Default and whether it shall be voluntary or involuntary or be effected by operation of law or pursuant to any judgment, decree or order of any court or any order, rule or regulation of any administrative or governmental body):
(1) default in payment when due and payable, at maturity, upon redemption, acceleration or otherwise, of principal of, or premium, if any, on the Notes;
(2) default for five Business Days or more in the payment when due of interest on or with respect to the Notes;
(3) the failure by the Issuer to perform, observe or comply with Sections 4.02, 5.02, 5.03, 5.06, 5.07, 5.08, 5.10 and 5.13 of this Indenture;
(4) failure by the Issuer for 30-days after receipt of written notice given by the Trustee or the Holders of not less than 25% in aggregate principal amount of the Notes to perform, observe or comply with any other covenant or agreement on its part under Article V of this Indenture (other than Sections 5.02, 5.03, 5.06, 5.07, 5.08, 5.10 and 5.13), provided that, it shall not constitute an Event of Default if, within 30-days after receipt of such written notice, corrective action is instituted and thereafter diligently pursued until the Default is cured;
(5) the Owner or the Issuer, pursuant to or within the meaning of any Bankruptcy Law:
(A) commences proceedings to be adjudicated bankrupt or insolvent;
(B) consents to the institution of bankruptcy or insolvency proceedings against it, or the filing by it of a petition or answer or consent seeking reorganization or relief under applicable Bankruptcy law;
(C) consents to the appointment of a receiver, liquidator, assignee, trustee, sequestrator or other similar official of it or for all or a substantial part of its property; or
(D) makes a general assignment for the benefit of its creditors;
(6) a court of competent jurisdiction enters an order or decree under any Bankruptcy Law that:
(A) is for relief against the Owner or the Issuer, in a proceeding in which the Owner or the Issuer, is to be adjudicated bankrupt or insolvent;
(B) appoints a receiver, liquidator, assignee, trustee, sequestrator or other similar official of the Owner or the Issuer, or for all or a substantial part of the property of the Issuer or the Owner; or
(C) orders the liquidation of the Owner or the Issuer;
and the order or decree remains unstayed and in effect for 60 consecutive days;
(7) the Insurance Division of the Hawaii Department of Commerce and Consumer Affairs commences a dissolution, liquidation, insolvency or other similar proceeding against the Owner or the Issuer, or petitions a court of competent jurisdiction for an order of rehabilitation in accordance with applicable law.
SECTION 7.02.
Acceleration
.
(a)
If any Event of Default (other than an Event of Default specified in clause (5), (6) or (7) of Section 7.01 hereof) occurs and is continuing under this Indenture, the Trustee by notice to the Issuer or the Holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the then total outstanding Notes by notice to the Issuer and the Trustee, in either case specifying in such notice the respective Event of Default and that such notice is a “notice of acceleration,” may declare the principal, interest and premium, if any, on all the then outstanding Notes to be due and payable. Upon the effectiveness of such declaration, such principal and interest shall be due and payable immediately. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of an Event of Default arising under clause (5), (6) or (7) of Section 7.01 hereof, all outstanding Notes shall be due and payable without further action or notice.
(b)
The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes by written notice to the Trustee may on behalf of the Holders of all of the Notes rescind any acceleration with respect to the Notes and its consequences if such rescission would not conflict with any judgment or decree of a court of competent jurisdiction and if all existing Events of Default (except nonpayment of principal, interest or premium that has become due solely because of the acceleration) have been cured or waived.
SECTION 7.03.
Other Remedies
. If an Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee may pursue any available remedy to collect the payment of principal, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes or to enforce the performance of any provision of the Notes, this Indenture or the Security Documents.
The Trustee may maintain a proceeding even if it does not possess any of the Notes or does not produce any of them in the proceeding. A delay or omission by the Trustee or any Holder of a Note in exercising any right or remedy accruing upon an Event of Default shall not impair the right or remedy or constitute a waiver of or acquiescence in the Event of Default. All remedies are cumulative to the extent permitted by law.
SECTION 7.04.
Specific Performance
. The Issuer agrees that irreparable damage would occur and that the Trustee, the Collateral Agent and the Holders would not have any adequate remedy at law in the event that any of the provisions of this Indenture were not performed in accordance with their specific terms or were otherwise breached. It is accordingly agreed that the Trustee, Collateral Agent and the Holders shall be entitled to an injunction or injunctions to prevent breaches of this Indenture and to enforce specifically the terms and provisions of this Indenture, including but not limited to Sections 4.02, 5.01, 5.02, 5.03, 5.07, 5.08, 5.11 and 5.13, in any court of competent jurisdiction, without proof of actual damages (and each party hereby waives any requirement for the securing or posting of any bond or other security in connection therewith); specific performance being in addition to any other remedy to which the parties are entitled at law or in equity.
SECTION 7.05.
Waiver of Past Defaults
. Holders of not less than a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes (unless a higher percentage would be required under Section 10.02 to consent to an amendment of the relevant provision, in which case such higher percentage shall apply) by notice to the Trustee may on behalf of the Holders of all of the Notes waive any existing Default (other than a Default under Section 5.01). Holders of not less than all affected Notes of the then outstanding Notes by notice to the Trustee may on behalf of the Holders of all of the Notes waive any existing Default under Section 5.01 and its respective consequences hereunder. Upon any such waiver, such Default shall cease to exist, and any Event of Default arising therefrom shall be deemed to have been cured for every purpose of this Indenture; but no such waiver shall extend to any subsequent or other Default or impair any right consequent thereon. This Section 7.05 is subject to Section 7.02 hereof.
SECTION 7.06.
Control by Majority
. Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then total outstanding Notes may direct the time, method and place of conducting any proceeding for any remedy available to the Trustee or of exercising any trust or power conferred on the Trustee. The Trustee, however, may refuse to follow any direction that conflicts with law or this Indenture or that the Trustee determines is unduly prejudicial to the rights of any other Holder of a Note or that would involve the Trustee in personal liability.
SECTION 7.07.
Limitation on Suits
. Subject to Sections 7.04 and 7.08 hereof, no Holder of a Note may pursue any remedy with respect to this Indenture or the Notes unless:
(a)
such Holder has previously given the Trustee notice that an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing;
(b)
Holders of at least 25% in aggregate principal amount of the total outstanding Notes have requested the Trustee to pursue the remedy;
(c)
Holders of the Notes have offered the Trustee satisfactory security or indemnity against any loss, liability or expense;
(d)
the Trustee has not complied with such request within 60 days after the receipt thereof and the offer of security or indemnity; and
(e)
Holders of a majority in principal amount of the total outstanding Notes have not given the Trustee a direction inconsistent with such request within such 60-day period.
A Holder of a Note may not use this Indenture to prejudice the rights of another Holder of a Note or to obtain a preference or priority over another Holder of a Note.
SECTION 7.08.
Rights of Holders of Notes to Receive Payment
. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Indenture and subject to Section 7.16, the right of any Holder of a Note to receive payment of principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Note, on or after the respective due dates expressed in the Note, or to bring suit for the enforcement of any such payment on or after such respective dates, shall not be impaired or affected without the consent of such Holder.
SECTION 7.09.
Collection Suit by Trustee
. If an Event of Default specified in Section 7.01(1) or (2) hereof occurs and is continuing, the Trustee is authorized to recover judgment, subject to the limitation in Section 7.16 hereof, in its own name and as trustee of an express trust against the Issuer for the whole amount of principal of, premium, if any, and interest remaining unpaid on the Notes and interest on overdue principal and, to the extent lawful, interest and such further amount as shall be sufficient to cover the costs and expenses of collection, including the compensation and reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel.
SECTION 7.10.
Restoration of Rights and Remedies
. If the Trustee or any Holder has instituted any proceeding to enforce any right or remedy under this Indenture and such proceeding has been discontinued or abandoned for any reason, or has been determined adversely to the Trustee or to such Holder, then and in every such case, subject to any determination in such proceedings, the Issuer, the Trustee and the Holders shall be restored severally and respectively to their former positions hereunder and thereafter all rights and remedies of the Trustee and the Holders shall continue as though no such proceeding has been instituted.
SECTION 7.11.
Rights and Remedies Cumulative
. Except as otherwise provided with respect to the replacement or payment of mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes in Section 2.07 hereof, and subject to Section 7.16 hereof, no right or remedy herein or in the Security Documents conferred upon or reserved to the Trustee or to the Holders is intended to be exclusive of any other right or remedy, and every right and remedy shall, to the extent permitted by law, be cumulative and in addition to every other right and remedy given hereunder or now or hereafter existing at law or in equity or otherwise. The assertion or employment of any right or remedy hereunder or in the Security Documents, or otherwise, shall not prevent the concurrent assertion or employment of any other appropriate right or remedy.
SECTION 7.12.
Delay or Omission Not Waiver
. No delay or omission of the Trustee or of any Holder of any Note to exercise any right or remedy accruing upon any Event of Default shall impair any such right or remedy or constitute a waiver of any such Event of Default or an acquiescence therein. Every right and remedy given by this Article or by law to the Trustee or to the Holders may be exercised from time to time, and as often as may be deemed expedient, by the Trustee or by the Holders, as the case may be.
SECTION 7.13.
Trustee May File Proofs of Claim
. The Trustee is authorized to file such proofs of claim and other papers or documents as may be necessary or advisable in order to have the claims of the Trustee (including any claim for the compensation and reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel) and the Holders of the Notes allowed in any judicial proceedings relative to the Issuer (or any other obligor upon the Notes), its creditors or its property and to collect, receive and distribute any money or other property payable or deliverable on any such claims and
any custodian in any such judicial proceeding is hereby authorized by each Holder to make such payments to the Trustee, and in the event that the Trustee shall consent to the making of such payments directly to the Holders, to pay to the Trustee any amount due to it for the compensation and reasonable expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 8.07 hereof. To the extent that the payment of any such compensation, expenses, disbursements and advances of the Trustee, its agents and counsel, and any other amounts due the Trustee under Section 8.07 hereof out of the estate in any such proceeding, shall be denied for any reason, payment of the same shall be secured by a Lien on, and shall be paid out of, any and all distributions, dividends, money, securities and other properties that the Holders may be entitled to receive in such proceeding whether in liquidation or under any plan of reorganization or arrangement or otherwise. Nothing herein contained shall be deemed to authorize the Trustee to authorize or consent to or accept or adopt on behalf of any Holder any plan of reorganization, arrangement, adjustment or composition affecting the Notes or the rights of any Holder, or to authorize the Trustee to vote in respect of the claim of any Holder in any such proceeding.
SECTION 7.14.
Priorities
. If the Trustee or any Agent collects any money or property pursuant to this Article VII, it shall, subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, pay out the money in the following order:
(a)
First, to the Trustee, such Agent, their agents and attorneys for amounts due under Section 8.07 hereof, including payment of all compensation, expenses and liabilities incurred, and all advances made, by the Trustee or such Agent and the costs and expenses of collection;
(b)
Second, to Holders of Notes for amounts due and unpaid on the Notes for principal, premium, if any, and interest, ratably, without preference or priority of any kind, according to the amounts due and payable on the Notes for principal, premium, if any, and interest, respectively; and
(c)
Third, to the Issuer or to such party as a court of competent jurisdiction shall direct.
The Trustee may fix a record date and payment date for any payment to Holders of Notes pursuant to this Section 7.14.
SECTION 7.15.
Undertaking for Costs
. In any suit for the enforcement of any right or remedy under this Indenture or in any suit against the Trustee for any action taken or omitted by it as a Trustee, a court in its discretion may require the filing by any party litigant in the suit of an undertaking to pay the costs of the suit, and the court in its discretion may assess reasonable costs, including reasonable attorneys’ fees, against any party litigant in the suit, having due regard to the merits and good faith of the claims or defenses made by the party litigant. This Section 7.15 does not apply to a suit by the Trustee, a suit by a Holder of a Note pursuant to Section 7.08 hereof, or a suit by Holders of more than 10% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes.
SECTION 7.16.
Limitation on the Issuer’s Obligations
. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Indenture, the Notes, the Intercreditor Agreement and the other Security Documents to the contrary, the Trustee, on behalf of itself and the Holders, agrees that it and the Holders shall not have or take recourse (other than actions for specific performance under Section 7.04) with respect to the Notes Documentation against the Issuer or its assets and property or against WMMRC or the Owner or their respective assets and property (other than assets that were required to be transferred to the protected cell pursuant to the Insurance Book Closing), except (i) to the Collateral Account, (ii) if the Issuer fails to comply with its obligations pursuant to Sections 4.02(a), 4.02(b), 5.02 or 5.08, to the assets of the Issuer
in an amount equal to the aggregate amount of any Runoff Proceeds or Runoff Proceeds Distributions that were not deposited into the Collateral Account, (iii) to the equity interests in and the excess assets of the Owner to the extent a Lien has been granted therein in favor of the Collateral Agent and (iv) to the Owner or the Issuer for costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney’s fees, related to the enforcement of Sections 4.01, 4.02, 4.03, 5.02, 5.03, 5.07, 5.08, 5.10 and 5.13 herein, if the Holders or the Trustee, as applicable, are the prevailing party in such enforcement action.
ARTICLE VIII
TRUSTEE
SECTION 8.01.
Duties of Trustee
.
(a)
If an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee shall exercise such of the rights and powers vested in it by this Indenture, and use the same degree of care and skill in its exercise, as a prudent person would exercise or use under the circumstances in the conduct of such person’s own affairs.
(b)
Except during the continuance of an Event of Default:
(i)
the duties of the Trustee shall be determined solely by the express provisions of this Indenture and the Trustee need perform only those duties that are specifically set forth in this Indenture and no others, and no implied covenants or obligations shall be read into this Indenture against the Trustee; and
(ii)
in the absence of bad faith on its part, the Trustee may conclusively rely, as to the truth of the statements and the correctness of the opinions expressed therein, upon certificates or opinions furnished to the Trustee and conforming to the form required in this Indenture. However, in the case of any such certificates or opinions which by any provision hereof are specifically required to be furnished to the Trustee, the Trustee shall examine the certificates and opinions to determine whether or not they conform to the requirements of this Indenture (but need not confirm or investigate the accuracy of mathematical calculations or other facts stated therein).
(c)
The Trustee may not be relieved from liabilities for its own negligent action, its own negligent failure to act, or its own willful misconduct, except that:
(i)
this paragraph does not limit the effect of paragraph (b) of this Section 8.01;
(ii)
the Trustee shall not be liable for any error of judgment made in good faith by a Responsible Officer, unless it is proved in a court of competent jurisdiction that the Trustee was negligent in ascertaining the pertinent facts; and
(iii)
the Trustee shall not be liable with respect to any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in accordance with a direction received by it pursuant to Section 8.02, 8.04 or 8.05 hereof.
(d)
Whether or not therein expressly so provided, every provision of this Indenture that in any way relates to the Trustee is subject to paragraphs (a), (b) and (c) of this Section 8.01.
(e)
The Trustee shall be under no obligation to exercise any of its rights or powers under this Indenture at the request or direction of any of the Holders of the Notes unless the Holders have
offered to the Trustee indemnity or security satisfactory to the Trustee against any loss, liability or expense.
(f)
The Trustee shall not be liable for interest on any money received by it except as the Trustee may agree in writing with the Issuer. Money held in trust by the Trustee need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
SECTION 8.02.
Rights of Trustee
.
(a)
The Trustee may conclusively rely upon any document believed by it to be genuine and to have been signed or presented by the proper Person. The Trustee need not investigate any fact or matter stated in the document, but the Trustee, in its discretion, may make such further inquiry or investigation into such facts or matters as it may see fit, and, if the Trustee shall determine to make such further inquiry or investigation, it shall be entitled to examine the books, records and premises of the Issuer and its Subsidiaries, personally or by agent or attorney at the sole cost of the Issuer and shall incur no liability or additional liability of any kind by reason of such inquiry or investigation.
(b)
Before the Trustee acts or refrains from acting, it may require an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer or an Opinion of Counsel or both. The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith in reliance on such Officer’s Certificate or Opinion of Counsel. The Trustee may consult with counsel of its selection and the advice of such counsel or any Opinion of Counsel shall be full and complete authorization and protection from liability in respect of any action taken, suffered or omitted by it hereunder in good faith and in reliance thereon.
(c)
The Trustee may act through its attorneys and agents and shall not be responsible for the misconduct or negligence of any agent or attorney appointed with due care.
(d)
The Trustee shall not be liable for any action it takes or omits to take in good faith that it believes to be authorized or within the rights or powers conferred upon it by this Indenture.
(e)
Unless otherwise specifically provided in this Indenture, any demand, request, direction or notice from the Issuer shall be sufficient if signed by an Officer of the Issuer.
(f)
None of the provisions of this Indenture shall require the Trustee to expend or risk its own funds or otherwise to incur any liability, financial or otherwise, in the performance of any of its duties hereunder, or in the exercise of any of its rights or powers if it shall have reasonable grounds for believing that repayment of such funds or indemnity satisfactory to it against such risk or liability is not assured to it.
(g)
The Trustee shall not be deemed to have notice of any Default or Event of Default unless a Responsible Officer of the Trustee has actual knowledge thereof or unless written notice of any event which is in fact such a Default is received by the Trustee at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee, and such notice references the Notes and this Indenture.
(h)
The rights, privileges, protections, immunities and benefits given to the Trustee, including, without limitation, its right to be indemnified, are extended to, and shall be enforceable by, the Trustee in each of its capacities hereunder, and each agent, custodian and other Person employed to act hereunder.
(i)
In no event shall the Trustee be responsible or liable for special, indirect, or consequential loss or damage of any kind whatsoever (including, but not limited to, loss of profit) irrespec-
tive of whether the Trustee has been advised of the likelihood of such loss or damage and regardless of the form of action.
SECTION 8.03.
Individual Rights of Trustee
. The Trustee in its individual or any other capacity may become the owner or pledgee of Notes and may otherwise deal with the Issuer or any Affiliate of the Issuer with the same rights it would have if it were not Trustee. However, in the event that the Trustee acquires any conflicting interest it must eliminate such conflict within 90 days, apply to the SEC for permission to continue as trustee or resign. Any Agent may do the same with like rights and duties. The Trustee is also subject to Sections 8.10 and 8.11 hereof.
SECTION 8.04.
Trustee’s Disclaimer
. The Trustee shall not be responsible for and makes no representation as to the validity or adequacy of this Indenture or the Notes, it shall not be accountable for the Issuer’s use of the proceeds from the Notes or any money paid to the Issuer or upon the Issuer’s direction under any provision of this Indenture, it shall not be responsible for the use or application of any money received by any Paying Agent other than the Trustee, and it shall not be responsible for any statement or recital herein or any statement in the Notes or any other document in connection with the sale of the Notes or pursuant to this Indenture other than its certificate of authentication. The recitals and statements contained herein and in the Notes, except those contained in any Trustee’s certificate of authentication, shall be taken as the recitals and statements of the Issuer, and the Trustee or any authenticating agent assumes no responsibility for their correctness.
SECTION 8.05.
Notice of Defaults
. If a Default occurs and is continuing and if it is known to the Trustee, the Trustee shall mail to Holders of Notes a notice of the Default within 90 days after it occurs. Except in the case of a Default relating to the payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest on any Note, the Trustee may withhold from the Holders notice of any continuing Default if and so long as the board of directors, the executive committee, or a trust committee of directors and/or Responsible Officers in good faith determines that withholding the notice is in the interests of the Holders of the Notes. The Trustee shall not be deemed to know of any Default unless a Responsible Officer of the Trustee has actual knowledge thereof or unless written notice of any event which is such a Default is received by the Trustee in accordance with Section 14.02 hereof at the Corporate Trust Office of the Trustee and such notice references the Notes and this Indenture. During any period in which an Event of Default has occurred and is continuing, the Trustee shall be entitled to have all Agents and Collateral Agents act at its direction.
SECTION 8.06.
Reports by Trustee to Holders of the Notes
. Within 60 days after each April 15, beginning with the April 15 following the date of this Indenture, and for so long as Notes remain outstanding, the Trustee shall mail to the Holders of the Notes a brief report dated as of such reporting date that complies with Trust Indenture Act Section 313(a) (but if no event described in Trust Indenture Act Section 313(a) has occurred within the twelve months preceding the reporting date, no report need be transmitted). The Trustee also shall comply with Trust Indenture Act Section 313(b)(1) and Section 313(b)(2) (to the extent applicable). The Trustee shall also transmit by mail all reports as required by Trust Indenture Act Section 313(c).
A copy of each report at the time of its mailing to the Holders of Notes shall be mailed to the Issuer and filed with each stock exchange on which the Notes are listed and the SEC in accordance with Trust Indenture Act Section 313(d). The Issuer shall promptly notify the Trustee when the Notes are listed on any stock exchange.
SECTION 8.07.
Compensation and Indemnity
. The Issuer shall pay to the Trustee from time to time such compensation for its acceptance of this Indenture and services hereunder as the
parties shall agree in writing from time to time. The Trustee’s compensation shall not be limited by any law on compensation of a trustee of an express trust. The Issuer shall reimburse the Trustee promptly upon request for all reasonable disbursements, advances and expenses incurred or made by it in addition to the compensation for its services. Such expenses shall include the compensation and reasonable disbursements and expenses of the Trustee’s agents and counsel.
The Issuer shall indemnify the Trustee and its officers, directors, employees, agents and any predecessor trustee (in its capacity as trustee) and its officers, directors, employees and agents for, and hold the Trustee harmless against, any and all loss, damage, claims, liability or expense (including reasonable attorneys’ fees) incurred by it in connection with the acceptance or administration of this trust and the performance of its duties hereunder (including the costs and expenses of enforcing this Indenture against the Issuer (including this Section 8.07) or defending itself against any claim whether asserted by any Holder or the Issuer, or liability in connection with the acceptance, exercise or performance of any of its powers or duties hereunder). The Trustee shall notify the Issuer promptly of any claim for which it may seek indemnity. Failure by the Trustee to so notify the Issuer shall not relieve the Issuer of its obligations hereunder except to the extent the Issuer has been materially prejudiced thereby. The Issuer shall defend the claim and the Trustee may have separate counsel and the Issuer shall pay the fees and expenses of such counsel. The Issuer need not pay for any settlement made without its consent, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld. The Issuer need not reimburse any expense or indemnify against any loss, liability or expense incurred by the Trustee through the Trustee’s own willful misconduct or negligence.
The obligations of the Issuer under this Section 8.07 shall survive the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture or the earlier resignation or removal of the Trustee.
To secure the payment obligations of the Issuer in this Section 8.07, the Trustee shall have a Lien prior to the Notes on all money or property held or collected by the Trustee. Such Lien shall survive the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture.
When the Trustee incurs expenses or renders services after an Event of Default specified in Section 7.01(5), (6) or (7) hereof occurs, the expenses and the compensation for the services (including the fees and expenses of its agents and counsel) are intended to constitute expenses of administration under any Bankruptcy Law.
SECTION 8.08.
Replacement of Trustee
. A resignation or removal of the Trustee and appointment of a successor Trustee shall become effective only upon the successor Trustee’s acceptance of appointment as provided in this Section 8.08. The Trustee may resign in writing at any time and be discharged from the trust hereby created by so notifying the Issuer. The Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may remove the Trustee by so notifying the Trustee and the Issuer in writing. The Issuer may remove the Trustee if:
(a)
the Trustee fails to comply with Section 8.10 hereof or Section 310 of the Trust Indenture Act;
(b)
the Trustee is adjudged a bankrupt or an insolvent or an order for relief is entered with respect to the Trustee under any Bankruptcy Law;
(c)
a custodian or public officer takes charge of the Trustee or its property; or
(d)
the Trustee becomes incapable of acting.
If the Trustee resigns or is removed or if a vacancy exists in the office of Trustee for any reason, the Issuer shall promptly appoint a successor Trustee. Within one year after the successor Trustee takes office, the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may appoint a successor Trustee to replace the successor Trustee appointed by the Issuer.
If a successor Trustee does not take office within 60 days after the retiring Trustee resigns or is removed, the retiring Trustee (at the Issuer’s expense), the Issuer or the Holders of at least 10% in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a successor Trustee.
If the Trustee, after written request by any Holder who has been a Holder for at least six months, fails to comply with Section 8.10 hereof, such Holder may petition any court of competent jurisdiction for the removal of the Trustee and the appointment of a successor Trustee.
A successor Trustee shall deliver a written acceptance of its appointment to the retiring Trustee and to the Issuer. Thereupon, the resignation or removal of the retiring Trustee shall become effective, and the successor Trustee shall have all the rights, powers and duties of the Trustee under this Indenture. The successor Trustee shall mail a notice of its succession to Holders. The retiring Trustee shall promptly transfer all property held by it as Trustee to the successor Trustee;
provided
all sums owing to the Trustee hereunder have been paid and subject to the Lien provided for in Section 8.07 hereof. Notwithstanding replacement of the Trustee pursuant to this Section 8.08, the Issuer’s obligations under Section 8.07 hereof shall continue for the benefit of the retiring Trustee.
SECTION 8.09.
Successor Trustee by Merger, etc
.
If the Trustee consolidates, merges or converts into, or transfers all or substantially all of its corporate trust business to, another corporation, the successor corporation without any further act shall be the successor Trustee.
SECTION 8.10.
Eligibility; Disqualification
. There shall at all times be a Trustee hereunder that is a corporation organized and doing business under the laws of the United States of America or of any state thereof that is authorized under such laws to exercise corporate trustee power, that is subject to supervision or examination by federal or state authorities and that has, together with its parent, a combined capital and surplus of at least $50,000,000 as set forth in its most recent published annual report of condition.
This Indenture shall always have a Trustee who satisfies the requirements of Trust Indenture Act Sections 310(a)(1), (2) and (5). The Trustee is subject to Trust Indenture Act Section 310(b).
SECTION 8.11.
Preferential Collection of Claims Against Issuer
. The Trustee is subject to Trust Indenture Act Section 311(a), excluding any creditor relationship listed in Trust Indenture Act Section 311(b). A Trustee who has resigned or been removed shall be subject to Trust Indenture Act Section 311(a) to the extent indicated therein.
ARTICLE IX
LEGAL DEFEASANCE AND COVENANT DEFEASANCE
SECTION 9.01.
Option to Effect Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance
. The Issuer may, at its option and at any time, elect to have either Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof applied to all outstanding Notes upon compliance with the conditions set forth below in this Article IX.
SECTION 9.02.
Legal Defeasance and Discharge
. Upon the Issuer’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.02, the Issuer shall, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, be deemed to have been discharged from their Obligations with respect to all outstanding Notes (including their Obligations under the Security Documents with respect to the Notes Obligations) on the date the conditions set forth below are satisfied (“
Legal Defeasance
”). For this purpose, Legal Defeasance means that the Issuer shall be deemed to have paid and discharged the entire Indebtedness represented by the outstanding Notes, which shall thereafter be deemed to be “outstanding” only for the purposes of Section 9.05 hereof and the other Sections of this Indenture referred to in (a) and (b) below, and to have satisfied all its other Obligations under such Notes and this Indenture (and the Trustee, on demand of and at the expense of the Issuer, shall execute proper instruments acknowledging the same), except for the following provisions which shall survive until otherwise terminated or discharged hereunder:
(a)
the rights of Holders of Notes to receive payments in respect of the principal of, premium, if any, and interest on the Notes when such payments are due solely out of the trust created pursuant to this Indenture referred to in Section 9.04 hereof;
(b)
the Issuer’s obligations with respect to Notes concerning issuing temporary Notes, registration of such Notes, mutilated, destroyed, lost or stolen Notes and the maintenance of an office or agency for payment and money for security payments held in trust;
(c)
the rights, powers, trusts, duties and immunities of the Trustee, and the Issuer’s obligations in connection therewith; and
(d)
this Section 9.02.
If the Issuer exercises under Section 9.01 the option applicable to this Section 9.02, subject to satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, payment of the Notes may not be accelerated because of an Event of Default under clauses (3), (4), (5), (6) and (7) of Section 7.01. Subject to compliance with this Article IX, the Issuer may exercise its option under this Section 9.02 notwithstanding the prior exercise of its option under Section 9.03 hereof.
SECTION 9.03.
Covenant Defeasance
. Upon the Issuer’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.03, the Issuer shall, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, be released from their obligations under the covenants contained in Sections 5.03, 5.05, 5.06, 5.07, 5.09, 5.10 and 5.13 and from the applicability of clauses (3) and (4) of Section 6.01 hereof with respect to the outstanding Notes on and after the date the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof are satisfied (“
Covenant Defeasance
”), and the Notes shall thereafter be deemed not “outstanding” for the purposes of any direction, waiver, consent or declaration or act of Holders (and the consequences of any thereof) in connection with such covenants, but shall continue to be deemed “outstanding” for all other purposes hereunder (it being understood that such Notes shall not be deemed outstanding for accounting purposes). For this purpose, Covenant Defeasance means that, with respect to the outstanding Notes, the Issuer may omit to comply with and shall have no liability in respect of any term, condition or limitation set forth in any such covenant, whether directly or indirectly, by reason of any reference elsewhere herein to any such covenant or by reason of any reference in any such covenant to any other provision herein or in any other document and such omission to comply shall not constitute a Default or an Event of Default under Section 7.01 hereof, but, except as specified above, the remainder of this Indenture and such Notes shall be unaffected thereby. In addition, upon the Issuer’s exercise under Section 9.01 hereof of the option applicable to this Section 9.03 hereof, subject to the satisfaction of the conditions set forth in Section 9.04 hereof, Sections 7.01(3) (solely with respect to the covenants that are
released upon a Covenant Defeasance), 7.01(5), 7.01(6) and 7.01(7) hereof shall not constitute Events of Default.
SECTION 9.04.
Conditions to Legal or Covenant Defeasance
. The following shall be the conditions to the application of either Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof to the outstanding Notes:
In order to exercise either Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance with respect to the Notes:
(a)
the Issuer must irrevocably deposit with the Trustee, in trust, for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes, cash in U.S. dollars, Government Securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants, to pay the principal amount of, premium, if any, and interest due on the Notes on the stated maturity date or on the Redemption Date, as the case may be, of such principal amount, premium, if any, or interest on such Notes and the Issuer must specify whether such Notes are being defeased to maturity or to a particular Redemption Date.
(b)
in the case of Legal Defeasance, the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel stating that, subject to customary assumptions and exclusions,
(i)
the Issuer has received from, or there has been published by, the United States Internal Revenue Service a ruling, or
(ii)
since the issuance of the Notes, there has been a change in the applicable U.S. federal income tax law,
in either case to the effect that, and based thereon such Opinion of Counsel shall confirm that, subject to customary assumptions and exclusions, the Holders of the Notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes, as applicable, as a result of such Legal Defeasance and will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such Legal Defeasance had not occurred;
(c)
in the case of Covenant Defeasance, the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee an Opinion of Counsel stating that, subject to customary assumptions and exclusions, the Holders of the Notes will not recognize income, gain or loss for U.S. federal income tax purposes as a result of such Covenant Defeasance and will be subject to such tax on the same amounts, in the same manner and at the same times as would have been the case if such Covenant Defeasance had not occurred;
(d)
no Default (other than that resulting from borrowing funds to be applied to make such deposit and any similar and simultaneous deposit relating to other indebtedness, and in each case, the granting of Liens in connection therewith) shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit;
(e)
the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate stating that the deposit was not made by the Issuer with the intent of defeating, hindering, delaying or defrauding any creditors of the Issuer; and
(f)
the Issuer shall have delivered to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel (which Opinion of Counsel may be subject to customary assumptions and exclusions)
each stating that all conditions precedent provided for or relating to the Legal Defeasance or the Covenant Defeasance, as the case may be, have been complied with.
SECTION 9.05.
Deposited Money and Government Securities to Be Held in Trust; Other Miscellaneous Provisions
. Subject to Section 9.06 hereof, all money and Government Securities (including the proceeds thereof) deposited with the Trustee (or other qualifying trustee, collectively for purposes of this Section 9.05, the “
Trustee
”) pursuant to Section 9.04 hereof in respect of the outstanding Notes shall be held in trust and applied by the Trustee, in accordance with the provisions of such Notes and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent as the Trustee may determine, to the Holders of such Notes of all sums due and to become due thereon in respect of principal, premium and interest, but such money need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
The Issuer shall pay and indemnify the Trustee against any tax, fee or other charge imposed on or assessed against the cash or Government Securities deposited pursuant to Section 9.04 hereof or the principal and interest received in respect thereof other than any such tax, fee or other charge which by law is for the account of the Holders of the outstanding Notes. Anything in this Article IX to the contrary notwithstanding, the Trustee shall deliver or pay to the Issuer from time to time upon the request of the Issuer any money or Government Securities held by it as provided in Section 9.04 hereof which, in the opinion of a nationally recognized firm of independent public accountants expressed in a written certification thereof delivered to the Trustee (which may be the opinion delivered under Section 9.04(a) hereof), are in excess of the amount thereof that would then be required to be deposited to effect an equivalent Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance.
SECTION 9.06.
Repayment to Issuer
. Subject to any applicable abandoned property law, any money deposited with the Trustee or any Paying Agent, or then held by the Issuer, in trust for the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note and remaining unclaimed for two years after such principal, and premium, if any, or interest has become due and payable shall be paid to the Issuer on its request or (if then held by the Issuer) shall be discharged from such trust; and the Holder of such Note shall thereafter look only to the Issuer for payment thereof, and all liability of the Trustee or such Paying Agent with respect to such trust money, and all liability of the Issuer as trustee thereof, shall thereupon cease.
SECTION 9.07.
Reinstatement
. If the Trustee or Paying Agent is unable to apply any United States dollars or Government Securities in accordance with Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof, as the case may be, by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, then the Issuer’s obligations under this Indenture and the Notes shall be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof until such time as the Trustee or Paying Agent is permitted to apply all such money in accordance with Section 9.02 or 9.03 hereof, as the case may be;
provided
that, if the Issuer makes any payment of principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Note following the reinstatement of its obligations, the Issuer shall be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to receive such payment from the money held by the Trustee or Paying Agent.
ARTICLE X
AMENDMENT, SUPPLEMENT AND WAIVER
SECTION 10.01.
Without Consent of Holders of Notes
. Notwithstanding Section 10.02 hereof, the Issuer and the Trustee (or the Collateral Agent, as applicable) may amend or supplement this
Indenture, the Notes, any Security Document or the Intercreditor Agreement without the consent of any Holder:
(a)
to cure any ambiguity, omission, mistake, defect or inconsistency;
(b)
to provide for uncertificated Notes of such series in addition to or in place of Definitive Notes;
(c)
to comply with Section 6.01 hereof;
(d)
to provide for the assumption of the Issuer’s obligations to the Holders;
(e)
to make any change that would provide any additional rights or benefits to the Holders or that does not adversely affect the legal rights under this Indenture, the Notes, the Security Documents or the Intercreditor Agreement of any such Holder;
(f)
to add covenants for the benefit of the Holders or to surrender any right or power conferred upon the Issuer;
(g)
to comply with requirements of the SEC in order to effect or maintain the qualification of this Indenture under the Trust Indenture Act;
(h)
to evidence and provide for the acceptance and appointment under this Indenture of a successor Trustee hereunder pursuant to the requirements hereof;
(i)
to make any amendment to the provisions of this Indenture relating to the transfer and legending of Notes as permitted by this Indenture, including, without limitation to facilitate the issuance and administration of the Notes;
provided
,
however
, that (i) compliance with this Indenture as so amended would not result in Notes being transferred in violation of the Securities Act or any applicable securities law and (ii) such amendment does not materially and adversely affect the rights of Holders to transfer Notes;
(j)
to add or release Collateral from, or subordinate, the Lien of the Security Documents only as expressly set forth in this Indenture, the Security Documents or the Intercreditor Agreement; and
(k)
to mortgage, pledge, hypothecate or grant any other Lien in favor of the Trustee or the Collateral Agent for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes, as additional security for the payment and performance of all or any portion of the Notes Obligations, on any property or assets, including any which are required to be mortgaged, pledged or hypothecated, or on which a Lien is required to be granted to or for the benefit of the Trustee or the Collateral Agent pursuant to this Indenture, any of the Security Documents or otherwise.
Upon the request of the Issuer accompanied by a resolution of its board of directors authorizing the execution of any such amended or supplemental indenture, and upon receipt by the Trustee of the documents described in Section 8.02 hereof, the Trustee shall join with the Issuer in the execution of any amended or supplemental indenture authorized or permitted by the terms of this Indenture and to make any further appropriate agreements and stipulations that may be therein contained, but the Trustee shall have the right, but not be obligated to, enter into such amended or supplemental indenture that affects its own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise.
SECTION 10.02.
With Consent of Holders of Notes
. Except as provided below in this Section 10.02, the Issuer and the Trustee (or the Collateral Agent, as applicable) may amend or supplement this Indenture, the Notes, the Intercreditor Agreement or any Security Documents with the consent of the Holders of at least a majority in principal amount of the Notes then outstanding voting as a single class (including consents obtained in connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for, or purchase of, the Notes). Subject to Sections 7.04 and 7.08 hereof, any existing Default or Event of Default (other than a Default or Event of Default in the payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on the Notes, except a payment default resulting from an acceleration that has been rescinded) or compliance with any provision of this Indenture or the Notes may be waived with the consent of the Holders of a majority in principal amount of the then outstanding Notes voting as a single class (including consents obtained in connection with a tender offer or exchange offer for, or purchase of, the Notes). Section 2.08 hereof, Section 2.09 hereof and Section 2.14 hereof shall determine which Notes are considered to be “outstanding” for the purposes of this Section 10.02.
Upon the request of the Issuer accompanied by a resolution of its board of directors authorizing the execution of any such amended or supplemental indenture, and upon the filing with the Trustee of evidence satisfactory to the Trustee of the consent of the Holders of Notes as aforesaid, and upon receipt by the Trustee of the documents described in Section 8.02 hereof, the Trustee shall join with the Issuer in the execution of such amended or supplemental indenture unless such amended or supplemental indenture directly affects the Trustee’s own rights, duties or immunities under this Indenture or otherwise, in which case the Trustee may in its discretion, but shall not be obligated to, enter into such amended or supplemental indenture.
It shall not be necessary for the consent of the Holders of Notes under this Section 10.02 to approve the particular form of any proposed amendment or waiver, but it shall be sufficient if such consent approves the substance thereof.
After an amendment, supplement or waiver under this Section 10.02 becomes effective, the Issuer shall mail to the Holders of Notes affected thereby a notice briefly describing the amendment, supplement or waiver. Any failure of the Issuer to mail such notice, or any defect therein, shall not, however, in any way impair or affect the validity of any such amended or supplemental indenture or waiver.
Without the consent of each affected Holder of Notes, an amendment or waiver under this Section 10.02 may not, with respect to any Notes held by a non-consenting Holder:
(a) reduce the principal amount of such Notes whose Holders must consent to an amendment, supplement or waiver;
(b) reduce the principal amount of or change the fixed final maturity of any such Note or alter or waive the provisions with respect to the redemption of such Note;
(c) reduce the rate of or change the time for payment of interest on any Note;
(d) waive a Default in the payment of principal of or premium, if any, or interest on the Notes (except a rescission of acceleration of the Notes by the Holders of at least a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes and a waiver of the payment default that resulted from such acceleration) or in respect of a covenant or provision contained in this Indenture which cannot be amended or modified without the consent of each Holder affected thereby;
(e) make any Note payable in money or a currency other than that stated therein;
(f) make any change in the provisions of this Indenture relating to waivers of past Defaults or the rights of Holders to receive payments of principal of or premium, if any, or interest on the Notes;
(g) make any change in these amendment and waiver provisions;
(h) impair the right of any Holder to receive payment of principal of, or interest on such Holder’s Notes on or after the due dates therefor or to institute suit for the enforcement of any payment on or with respect to such Holder’s Notes;
(i) amend, supplement, waive or modify the provisions of this Indenture dealing with the Security Documents or application of Runoff Proceeds in any manner, in each case that would subordinate the Lien of the Collateral Agent to the Liens securing any other Obligations (other than as contemplated under clause (j) of Section 10.01 or otherwise release any material portion of the Collateral, in each case other than in accordance with this Indenture, the Security Documents and the Intercreditor Agreement; or
(j) to amend the definition of Runoff Proceeds, Runoff Proceeds Distribution and Section 4.02.
In addition, without the consent of the Holders of at least two-thirds in aggregate principal amount of Notes then outstanding, no amendment, supplement or waiver may modify Sections 5.02, 5.03, 5.07, 5.08, 5.10 and 5.13 of this Indenture.
SECTION 10.03.
Compliance with Trust Indenture Act
. Every amendment or supplement to this Indenture or the Notes shall be set forth in an amended or supplemental indenture that complies in all material respects with the Trust Indenture Act as then in effect.
SECTION 10.04.
Revocation and Effect of Consents
. Until an amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective, a consent to it by a Holder of a Note is a continuing consent by the Holder of a Note and every subsequent Holder of a Note or portion of a Note that evidences the same debt as the consenting Holder’s Note, even if notation of the consent is not made on any Note. However, any such Holder of a Note or subsequent Holder of a Note may revoke the consent as to its Note if the Trustee receives written notice of revocation before the date the waiver, supplement or amendment becomes effective. An amendment, supplement or waiver becomes effective in accordance with its terms and thereafter binds every Holder.
The Issuer may, but shall not be obligated to, fix a record date for the purpose of determining the Holders entitled to consent to any amendment, supplement, or waiver. If a record date is fixed, then, notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, those Persons who were Holders at such record date (or their duly designated proxies), and only such Persons, shall be entitled to consent to such amendment, supplement, or waiver or to revoke any consent previously given, whether or not such Persons continue to be Holders after such record date. No such consent shall be valid or effective for more than 120 days after such record date unless the consent of the requisite number of Holders has been obtained.
SECTION 10.05.
Notation on or Exchange of Notes
. The Trustee may place an appropriate notation about an amendment, supplement or waiver on any Note thereafter authenticated. The Issuer in exchange for all Notes may issue and the Trustee shall, upon receipt of an Authentication Order, authenticate new Notes that reflect the amendment, supplement or waiver.
Failure to make the appropriate notation or issue a new Note shall not affect the validity and effect of such amendment, supplement or waiver.
SECTION 10.06.
Trustee to Sign Amendments, etc
.
The Trustee shall sign any amendment, supplement or waiver authorized pursuant to this Article X if the amendment or supplement does not adversely affect the rights, duties, liabilities or immunities of the Trustee. The Issuer may not sign an amendment, supplement or waiver until the board of directors (or similar governing body) approves it. In executing any amendment, supplement or waiver, the Trustee shall be entitled to receive, and (subject to Section 8.01 hereof) shall be fully protected in relying upon, in addition to the documents required by Section 13.04 hereof, an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel stating that the execution of such amended or supplemental indenture is authorized or permitted by this Indenture and that such amendment, supplement or waiver is the legal, valid and binding obligation of the Issuer, enforceable against them in accordance with its terms, subject to customary exceptions, and complies with the provisions hereof (including Section 10.03).
ARTICLE XI
SATISFACTION AND DISCHARGE
SECTION 11.01.
Satisfaction and Discharge
. This Indenture shall be discharged and shall cease to be of further effect as to all Notes, when either:
(a)
all Notes heretofore authenticated and delivered, except lost, stolen or destroyed Notes which have been replaced or paid and Notes for whose payment money has heretofore been deposited in trust, have been delivered to the Trustee for cancellation; or
(b)
(A) all Notes not heretofore delivered to the Trustee for cancellation have become due and payable by reason of the making of a notice of redemption or otherwise, will become due and payable within one year or are to be called for redemption and redeemed within one year under arrangements satisfactory to the Trustee for the giving of notice of redemption by the Trustee in the name, and at the expense, of the Issuer, and the Issuer has irrevocably deposited or caused to be deposited with the Trustee as trust funds in trust solely for the benefit of the Holders of the Notes, cash in U.S. dollars, Government Securities, or a combination thereof, in such amounts as will be sufficient without consideration of any reinvestment of interest to pay and discharge the entire indebtedness on the Notes not heretofore delivered to the Trustee for cancellation for principal, premium, if any, and accrued interest to the date of maturity or redemption;
(B) no Default (other than that resulting from borrowing funds to be applied to make such deposit and any similar and simultaneous deposit relating to other Indebtedness to the extent such Indebtedness is simultaneously being discharged or repaid and the granting of Liens in connection therewith) with respect to this Indenture or the Notes shall have occurred and be continuing on the date of such deposit or shall occur as a result of such deposit and such deposit will not result in a breach or violation of, or constitute a default under any other material agreement or instrument to which the Issuer is a party or by which the Issuer is bound;
(C) the Issuer has paid or caused to be paid all sums payable by it under this Indenture; and
(D) the Issuer has delivered irrevocable instructions to the Trustee to apply the deposited money toward the payment of the Notes at maturity or the Redemption Date, as the case may be.
In addition, the Issuer shall deliver an Officer’s Certificate and an Opinion of Counsel to the Trustee stating that all conditions precedent to satisfaction and discharge have been satisfied.
Notwithstanding the satisfaction and discharge of this Indenture, if money shall have been deposited with the Trustee pursuant to subclause (A) of clause (b) of this Section 11.01, the provisions of Section 11.02 and Section 9.07 hereof shall survive.
SECTION 11.02.
Application of Trust Money
. Subject to the provisions of Section 9.07 hereof, all money deposited with the Trustee pursuant to Section 11.01 hereof shall be held in trust and applied by it, in accordance with the provisions of the Notes and this Indenture, to the payment, either directly or through any Paying Agent (including the Issuer acting as its own Paying Agent) as the Trustee may determine, to the Persons entitled thereto, of the principal (and premium, if any) and interest for whose payment such money has been deposited with the Trustee; but such money need not be segregated from other funds except to the extent required by law.
If the Trustee or Paying Agent is unable to apply any money or Government Securities in accordance with Section 11.01 hereof by reason of any legal proceeding or by reason of any order or judgment of any court or governmental authority enjoining, restraining or otherwise prohibiting such application, the Issuer’s obligations under this Indenture and the Notes shall be revived and reinstated as though no deposit had occurred pursuant to Section 11.01 hereof;
provided
that if the Issuer has made any payment of principal of, premium, if any, or interest on any Notes because of the reinstatement of its obligations, the Issuer shall be subrogated to the rights of the Holders of such Notes to receive such payment from the money or Government Securities held by the Trustee or Paying Agent.
ARTICLE XII
SECURITY
SECTION 12.01.
Security Documents
. The payment of the principal of and interest (including without limitation, any PIK interest) and premium, if any, on the Notes when due, whether at maturity, by acceleration, repurchase, redemption or otherwise and whether by the Issuer pursuant to the Notes, the payment of all other Notes Obligations and the performance of all other Notes Obligations are secured as provided in the Security Documents which the Issuer has entered into and will be secured by Security Documents hereafter delivered as required or permitted by this Indenture. The Issuer shall comply with all provisions and covenants, make all filings (including filings of continuation statements and amendments to Uniform Commercial Code financing statements that may be necessary to continue the effectiveness of such Uniform Commercial Code financing statements) and all other actions as are necessary or required by the Security Documents to maintain (at the sole cost and expense of the Issuer) the security interest created by the Security Documents in the Collateral (other than with respect to any Collateral the security interest in which is not required to be perfected or maintained under the Security Documents) as a perfected security interest. The Issuer shall deliver an Opinion of Counsel to the Trustee within 30 calendar days following the end of each annual period beginning with the annual period beginning on [ ] of each year, to the effect that all actions required to maintain the Lien of the Security Documents with respect to items of Collateral that may be perfected solely by the filing of financing statements under the Uniform Commercial Code have been taken.
SECTION 12.02.
Collateral Agent
.
(a)
The Collateral Agent shall have all the rights and protections provided in the Security Documents and the Intercreditor Agreement and shall have no responsibility to exercise any discre-
tionary power or right provided in any Security Document except as expressly required pursuant to the Security Documents or the Intercreditor Agreement or to ensure the existence, genuineness, value or protection of any Collateral or to ensure the legality, enforceability, effectiveness or sufficiency of the Security Documents or the creation, perfection, priority, sufficiency or protection of any Lien or any defect or deficiency as to any such matters.
(b)
The Trustee, is authorized and directed to (i) enter into the Intercreditor Agreement, (ii) acknowledge the Collateral Agent as the Collateral Agent and to authorize the Collateral Agent (and the Holders hereby authorize the Collateral Agent) to enter into the Security Documents for the benefit of the Holders, (iii) bind the Holders on the terms as set forth in the Security Documents and the Intercreditor Agreement and (iv) perform and observe its obligations and exercise its rights (and the Holders hereby authorize the Collateral Agent to perform and observe its obligations and exercise its rights) under the Intercreditor Agreement and the Security Documents.
(c)
Subject to Section 8.01, neither the Trustee nor the Collateral Agent nor any of their officers, directors, employees, attorneys or agents will be responsible or liable for the existence, genuineness, value or protection of any Collateral, for the legality, enforceability, effectiveness or sufficiency of the Security Documents, for the creation, perfection, priority, sufficiency or protection of any Lien or any defect or deficiency as to any such matters.
SECTION 12.03.
Authorization of Actions to Be Taken
.
(a)
Each Holder of Notes, by its acceptance thereof, consents and agrees to the terms of each Security Document and the Intercreditor Agreement, as originally in effect and as amended, restated, amended and restated, renewed, modified, supplemented or replaced from time to time in accordance with its terms or the terms of this Indenture, authorizes and directs the Trustee to authorize the Collateral Agent to enter into the Security Documents for the benefit of the Holders, authorizes and empowers the Trustee and the Collateral Agent to enter into each of the Security Agreements and the Intercreditor Agreement and authorizes and empowers the Trustee and the Collateral Agent to bind the Holders of Notes pursuant to the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and to perform their respective obligations and exercise their respective rights and powers thereunder.
(b)
The Trustee is authorized and empowered to receive for the benefit of the Holders of Notes any funds collected or distributed under the Security Documents to which the Trustee is entitled pursuant to the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and to make further distributions of such funds to the Holders of Notes according to the provisions of this Indenture.
(c)
Subject to the Intercreditor Agreement, the Trustee is authorized and empowered to institute and maintain, or direct the Collateral Agent to institute and maintain, such suits and proceedings as it may deem expedient to protect or enforce the Liens of the Security Documents or to prevent any impairment of Collateral by any acts that may be unlawful or in violation of the Security Documents.
SECTION 12.04.
Release of Collateral
; Substitution
.
(a)
Liens granted pursuant to the Security Documents securing the Notes Obligations shall automatically terminate and/or be released in full all without delivery of any instrument or performance of any act by any party as of the date upon (i) all the Notes Obligations and this Indenture (other than contingent or unliquidated obligations or liabilities not then due) have been paid in full in cash or immediately available funds or (ii) a Legal Defeasance or Covenant Defeasance under Article VIX or a discharge in accordance with Article XI.
Upon the receipt of an Officer’s Certificate from the Issuer, as described in Section 12.04(b) below and any necessary or proper instruments of termination, satisfaction or release prepared by the Issuer, the Collateral Agent shall execute, deliver or acknowledge such instruments or releases to evidence the release of any Collateral permitted to be released pursuant to this Indenture or the Security Documents or the Intercreditor Agreement.
(b)
Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, in connection with (x) any release of Collateral pursuant to Section 12.04(a) above, such Collateral may not be released from the Lien and security interest created by the Security Documents and (y) any release of Collateral pursuant to Section 12.04(a), the Collateral Agent shall not be required to execute, deliver or acknowledge any instruments of termination, satisfaction or release unless, in each case, an Officer’s Certificate and Opinion of Counsel certifying that all conditions precedent, including, without limitation, this Section 12.04, have been met and stating under which of the circumstances set forth in Section 12.04(a) above the Collateral is being released have been delivered to the Collateral Agent on or prior to the date of such release or, in the case of clause (y) above, the date on which the Collateral Agent executes any such instrument. The Trustee shall be entitled to receive and rely on Officer’s Certificates and Opinions of Counsel delivered to the Collateral Agent under this Section 12.04(b).
(c)
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in the Notes Documentation or any Security Document upon the Insurance Book Closing, any Lien in the equity of WMMRC held by the Collateral Agent shall be deemed automatically released.
SECTION 12.05.
Powers Exercisable by Receiver or Trustee
. In case the Collateral shall be in the possession of a receiver or trustee, lawfully appointed, the powers conferred in this Article XII upon the Issuer with respect to the release, sale or other disposition of such property may be exercised by such receiver or trustee, and an instrument signed by such receiver or trustee shall be deemed the equivalent of any similar instrument of the Issuer or of any officer or officers thereof required by the provisions of this Article XII; and if the Trustee or the Collateral Agent shall be in the possession of the Collateral under any provision of this Indenture, then such powers may be exercised by the Trustee or the Collateral Agent, as the case may be.
SECTION 12.06.
No Fiduciary Duties; Collateral
. The Trustee shall have no duty as to any Collateral in its possession or control or in the possession or control of any agent or bailee or any income thereon or as to preservation of rights against prior parties or any other rights pertaining thereto and the Trustee shall not be responsible for filing any financing or continuation statements or recording any documents or instruments in any public office at any time or times or otherwise perfecting or maintaining the perfection of any security interest in the Collateral. The Trustee shall not be liable or responsible for any loss or diminution in the value of any of the Collateral, by reason of the act or omission of any carrier, forwarding agency or other agent or bailee selected by the Trustee in good faith.
SECTION 12.07.
Intercreditor Agreement Controls
. Upon the Trustee’s entry into the Intercreditor Agreement, the Holders of the Notes and the Trustee will be subject to and bound by the provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement. Notwithstanding anything herein to the contrary, (i) the liens and security interests granted to the Collateral Agent pursuant to the Security Documents and all rights and obligations of the Trustee hereunder are expressly subject to the Intercreditor Agreement and (ii) the exercise of any right or remedy by the Trustee hereunder is subject to the limitations and provisions of the Intercreditor Agreement. Subject to Section 7.16 and except for Article VIII, in the event of any conflict or inconsistency between the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement and the terms of this Indenture, the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement shall govern.
ARTICLE XIII
MISCELLANEOUS
SECTION 13.01.
Trust Indenture Act Controls
. If any provision of this Indenture limits, qualifies or conflicts with the duties imposed by Trust Indenture Act Section 318(c), the imposed duties shall control.
SECTION 13.02.
Notices
. Any notice or communication by the Issuer or the Trustee to the others is duly given if in writing and delivered in person or mailed by first-class mail (registered or certified, return receipt requested), fax or overnight air courier guaranteeing next day delivery, to the others’ address:
If to the Issuer:
Washington Mutual, Inc.
1201 Third Avenue, Suite 3000
Seattle, Washington 98101
Attention: General Counsel
Telephone No.: (206) 432-8731
Facsimile No.: (206) 432-8879
Email: chad.smith@wamuinc.net
with a copy to:
Weil Gotshal & Manges LLP
767 Fifth Avenue
New York, NY 10153
Attention: Todd R. Chandler
Telephone No.: (212) 310-8000
Facsimile No.: (212) 310-8007
Email: todd.chandler@weil.com
If to the Trustee:
Wilmington Trust, National Association
Corporate Capital Markets
50 South Sixth Street, Suite 1290
Minneapolis, MN, 55402
Attention: Washington Mutual, Inc. Administrator
Facsimile No.: (612) 217-5651
The Issuer or the Trustee, by notice to the others, may designate additional or different addresses for subsequent notices or communications.
All notices and communications (other than those sent to Holders) shall be deemed to have been duly given: at the time delivered by hand, if personally delivered; five calendar days after be-
ing deposited in the mail, postage prepaid, if mailed by first-class mail; when receipt acknowledged, if faxed; and the next Business Day after timely delivery to the courier, if sent by overnight air courier guaranteeing next day delivery;
provided
that any notice or communication delivered to the Trustee shall be deemed effective upon actual receipt thereof.
Any notice or communication to a Holder shall be mailed by first-class mail, certified or registered, return receipt requested, or by overnight air courier guaranteeing next day delivery to its address shown on the Note Register kept by the Registrar. Any notice or communication shall also be so mailed to any Person described in Trust Indenture Act Section 313(c), to the extent required by the Trust Indenture Act. Failure to mail a notice or communication to a Holder or any defect in it shall not affect its sufficiency with respect to other Holders.
If a notice or communication is mailed in the manner provided above within the time prescribed, it is duly given, whether or not the addressee receives it.
If the Issuer mails a notice or communication to Holders, it shall mail a copy to the Trustee and each Agent at the same time.
SECTION 13.03.
Communication by Holders of Notes with Other Holders of Notes
. Holders may communicate pursuant to Trust Indenture Act Section 312(b) with other Holders with respect to their rights under this Indenture or the Notes. The Issuer, the Trustee, the Registrar and anyone else shall have the protection of Trust Indenture Act Section 312(c).
SECTION 13.04.
Certificate and Opinion as to Conditions Precedent
.
(a)
Upon any request or application by the Issuer to the Trustee to take any action under this Indenture, the Issuer shall furnish to the Trustee an Officer’s Certificate of the Issuer in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee (which shall include the statements set forth in Section 13.05 hereof) stating that, in the opinion of the signers, all conditions precedent and covenants, if any, provided for in this Indenture relating to the proposed action have been satisfied; and
(b)
an Opinion of Counsel in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Trustee (which shall include the statements set forth in Section 13.05 hereof) stating that, in the opinion of such counsel, all such conditions precedent and covenants have been satisfied.
SECTION 13.05.
Statements Required in Certificate or Opinion
. Each certificate or opinion with respect to compliance with a condition or covenant provided for in this Indenture (other than a certificate provided pursuant to Section 5.06 hereof or Trust Indenture Act Section 314(a)(4)) shall comply with the provisions of Trust Indenture Act Section 314(e) and shall include:
(a)
a statement that the Person making such certificate or opinion has read such covenant or condition;
(b)
a brief statement as to the nature and scope of the examination or investigation upon which the statements or opinions contained in such certificate or opinion are based;
(c)
a statement that, in the opinion of such Person, he or she has made such examination or investigation as is necessary to enable him to express an informed opinion as to whether or not such covenant or condition has been complied with (and, in the case of an Opinion of Counsel, may be limited to reliance on an Officer’s Certificate, certificates of public officials or reports or opinions of experts as to matters of fact); and
(d)
a statement as to whether or not, in the opinion of such Person, such condition or covenant has been complied with.
SECTION 13.06.
Rules by Trustee and Agents
. The Trustee may make reasonable rules for action by or at a meeting of Holders. The Registrar or Paying Agent may make reasonable rules and set reasonable requirements for its functions.
SECTION 13.07.
No Personal Liability of Directors, Officers, Employees and Stockholders
. No past, present or future director, officer, employee, incorporator or stockholder of the Issuer or any of their parent companies shall have any liability for any obligations of the Issuer under the Notes or this Indenture or for any claim based on, in respect of, or by reason of such obligations or their creation. Each Holder by accepting Notes waives and releases all such liability. The waiver and release are part of the consideration for issuance of the Notes.
SECTION 13.08.
Governing Law
. THIS INDENTURE AND THE NOTES WILL BE GOVERNED BY AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.
SECTION 13.09.
Waiver of Jury Trial
. THE ISSUER AND THE TRUSTEE HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS INDENTURE, THE NOTES OR THE TRANSACTIONS CONTEMPLATED HEREBY.
SECTION 13.10.
Force Majeure
. In no event shall the Trustee be responsible or liable for any failure or delay in the performance of its obligations under this Indenture arising out of or caused by, directly or indirectly, forces beyond its reasonable control, including without limitation strikes, work stoppages, accidents, acts of war or terrorism, civil or military disturbances, nuclear or natural catastrophes or acts of God, and interruptions, loss or malfunctions of utilities, communications or computer (software or hardware) services.
SECTION 13.11.
No Adverse Interpretation of Other Agreements
. This Indenture may not be used to interpret any other indenture, loan or debt agreement of the Issuer or its Subsidiaries or of any other Person. Any such indenture, loan or debt agreement may not be used to interpret this Indenture.
SECTION 13.12.
Successors
. All agreements of the Issuer in this Indenture and the Notes shall bind its successors. All agreements of the Trustee in this Indenture shall bind its successors.
SECTION 13.13.
Severability
. In case any provision in this Indenture or in the Notes shall be invalid, illegal or unenforceable, the validity, legality and enforceability of the remaining provisions shall not in any way be affected or impaired thereby.
SECTION 13.14.
Counterpart Originals
. The parties may sign any number of copies of this Indenture. Each signed copy shall be an original, but all of them together represent the same agreement.
SECTION 13.15.
Table of Contents, Headings, etc
.
The Table of Contents, Cross-Reference Table and headings of the Articles and Sections of this Indenture have been inserted for convenience of reference only, are not to be considered a part of this Indenture and shall in no way modify or restrict any of the terms or provisions hereof.
[Signatures on following page]
|
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
|
[Signature Page to Senior First Lien Notes Indenture]
|
Wilmington Trust, National Association
as Trustee
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
|
[Signature Page to Senior First Lien Notes Indenture]
EXHIBIT A
[Face of Note]
[Insert the Global Note Legend, if applicable]
CUSIP [ ]
13% Senior First Lien Note due 2030
No. ___
|
[$______________]
|
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.
promises to pay, subject to the terms of the Indenture, to __________ or registered assigns, the principal sum [set forth on the Schedule of Exchanges of Interests in the Global Note attached hereto] [of ________________________ Dollars] ($_________________) on [ ]
Interest Payment Dates: [ ]
Record Dates: [ ]
IN WITNESS HEREOF, the Issuer has caused this instrument to be duly executed.
Dated: [ ]
|
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
By:
|
|
|
|
|
Name:
|
|
|
|
|
Title:
|
|
|
This is one of the Notes referred to in the within-mentioned Indenture:
Dated: _______________
[ ]
as Trustee
By:
Authorized Signatory
[Back of Note]
13% Senior First Lien Note due 2030
Capitalized terms used herein shall have the meanings assigned to them in the Indenture referred to below unless otherwise indicated.
1.
Interest
. Washington Mutual, Inc., a Washington corporation (the “
Issuer
”), promises to pay, subject to the terms of the Indenture, interest on the principal amount of this Note at a rate per annum set forth below from the Issue Date until paid in full. The Issuer will pay interest on this Note quarterly in arrears on [ ], [ ], [ ] and [ ] of each year, commencing on [ ], or if any such day is not a Business Day, on the next succeeding Business Day (each, an “
Interest Payment Date
”), and no interest shall accrue on such payment for the intervening period. The Issuer will make each interest payment to the Holder of record of this Note on the immediately preceding [ ], [ ], [ ] and [ ] (each, a “
Record Date
”). Interest on this Note will accrue from the most recent date to which interest has been paid or, if no interest has been paid, from and including the Issue Date. The Notes will mature on [ ], 2030. The Issuer will pay interest (including post-petition interest in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law whether or not allowed) on overdue principal at the rate that is 2% higher than the rate then applicable to this Note; it shall pay interest (including post-petition interest in any proceeding under any Bankruptcy Law) on overdue installments of interest (without regard to any applicable grace periods) at the rate then applicable to this Note to the extent lawful. Interest will be computed on the basis of a 360-day year comprised of twelve 30-day months.
To the extent there are sufficient Runoff Proceeds Distributions on any Interest Payment Date to pay interest on the Notes in accordance with Section 4.02 of the Indenture, interest on this Note shall be paid entirely in cash (“Cash Interest”); provided to the extent there are insufficient Runoff Proceeds Distributions to pay interest on the Notes in accordance with Section 4.02 of the Indenture, interest shall be payable on such Interest Payment Date in cash to the extent of funds available for payment of cash payments and any excess interest payable shall be paid by increasing the principal amount of this Note or by issuing PIK Notes in an amount equal to such excess. The Issuer must notify the Trustee at least five (5) Business Days prior to any Interest Payment Date whether Cash Interest and/or a PIK Payment will be paid on such Interest Payment Date to the Holders of the Notes. The Trustee shall promptly deliver a corresponding notice to the Holder of this Note. The Trustee will, at the request of the Issuer, authenticate and deliver such PIK Notes for original issuance to such Holder of this Note on the relevant record date, as shown by the records of the Note Register. Following an increase in the principal amount of this Note as a result of a PIK Payment, this Note will bear interest on such increased principal amount from and after the date of such PIK Payment. Any PIK Notes will be dated as of the applicable interest payment date and will bear interest from and after such date. All PIK Notes issued pursuant to a PIK Payment will mature on [ ], 2030 and will be governed by, and subject to the terms, provisions and conditions of, the Indenture and shall have the same rights and benefits as the Notes issued on the Issue Date. Any PIK Notes will be issued with the description “PIK” on the face of such PIK Note.
Interest on this Note and any PIK Notes will accrue at the rate of 13% per annum.
2.
Method of Payment
. The Issuer or the Trustee will pay interest on this Note to the Person who is the registered Holder of this Note at the close of business on the Record Date (whether or not a Business Day) next preceding the Interest Payment Date, even if this Note is canceled after such record date and on or before such Interest Payment Date, except as provided in Section 2.12 of the Indenture with respect to defaulted interest. Cash payment of interest may be made by check mailed to the Holders at their addresses set forth in the Register,
provided
that all cash payments of principal, premium,
if any, and interest on, this Note will be made by wire transfer to a U.S. dollar account maintained by the payee with a bank in the United States if such Holder elects payment by wire transfer by giving written notice to the Trustee or the Paying Agent to such effect designating such account no later than 30 days immediately preceding the relevant due date for payment (or such other date as the Trustee may accept in its discretion). Such payment shall be in such coin or currency of the United States of America as at the time of payment is legal tender for payment of public and private debts.
3.
Paying Agent and Registrar
. Initially, Wilmington Trust, National Association, the Trustee under the Indenture, will act as Paying Agent and Registrar. The Issuer may change any Paying Agent or Registrar without notice to the Holders.
4.
Indenture
. The Issuer issued the Notes under a Senior First Lien Notes Indenture, dated as of [ ] (the “
Indenture
”), among Washington Mutual, Inc. and the Trustee. This Note is one of a duly authorized issue of notes of the Issuer designated as its 13% Senior First Lien Notes due 2030. The Notes and any PIK Notes issued under the Indenture shall be treated as a single class of securities under the Indenture. The terms of the Notes include those stated in the Indenture and those incorporated by reference into the Indenture from the Trust Indenture Act of 1939, as amended (the “
Trust Indenture Act
”). The Notes are subject to all such terms, and Holders are referred to the Indenture and such Act for a statement of such terms. To the extent any provision of this Note conflicts with the express provisions of the Indenture, the provisions of the Indenture shall govern and be controlling. Upon the Trustee’s entry into the Indenture, the Holders of the Notes and the Trustee will be bound by the terms of the Indenture.
5.
Optional Redemption
. At any time the Notes may be redeemed or purchased (by the Issuer or any other Person), in whole or in part, at a redemption price equal to 100% of the principal amount of Notes redeemed plus, and, without duplication, accrued and unpaid interest, if any, to the date of redemption (the “
Redemption Date
”), subject to the rights of Holders of Notes on the relevant Record Date to receive interest due on the relevant Interest Payment Date. Any redemption pursuant to this paragraph 5 shall be made pursuant to the provisions of Sections 3.01 through 3.06 of the Indenture.
6.
Notice of Redemption
. Subject to Section 3.03 of the Indenture, notice of redemption will be mailed by first-class mail at least 30 days but not more than 60 days before the Redemption Date to each Holder whose Notes are to be redeemed at its registered address. Notes and portions of the Notes in whole dollar ($1.00) denominations may be redeemed. On and after the Redemption Date, interest ceases to accrue on this Note or portions thereof called for redemption.
8.
Collateral and Intercreditor Agreement
. These Notes are secured by a security interest in the Collateral pursuant to certain Security Documents. The Liens securing the Notes are subject to the terms of the Intercreditor Agreement.
9.
Limitation on the Issuer’s Obligations
. Notwithstanding any other provision of the Indenture, the Intercreditor Agreement, the Notes and the Security Documents to the contrary, the Holder of this Note agrees that it shall not have or take recourse (other than actions for specific performance under Section 7.04 of the Indenture) with respect to the Notes Documentation against the Issuer or its assets and property, or against WMMRC or the Owner or their respective assets and property (other than assets that were required to be transferred to the protected cell pursuant to the Insurance Book Closing), except (i) to the Collateral Account, (ii) if the Issuer fails to comply with its obligations pursuant to Sections 4.02(a), 4.02(b), 5.02 or 5.08, to the assets of the Issuer in an amount equal to the aggregate amount of any Runoff Proceeds or Runoff Proceeds Distributions that were not deposited into the Collateral Account, (iii) to the equity interests in the Owner to the extent a Lien has been granted therein in fa-
vor of the Collateral Agent and (iv) to the Owner or the Issuer for costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney’s fees, related to the enforcement of Sections 4.01, 4.02, 4.03, 5.02, 5.03, 5.07, 5.08, 5.10 and 5.13 of the Indenture, if the Holders or the Trustee, as applicable, are the prevailing party in such enforcement action.
10.
Denominations, Transfer, Exchange
. The Notes are in registered form without coupons in whole dollar ($1.00) denominations and integral multiples of $1.00 rounded up to the nearest whole dollar. The transfer of Notes may be registered and Notes may be exchanged as provided in the Indenture. The Registrar and the Trustee may require a Holder, among other things, to furnish appropriate endorsements and transfer documents and the Issuer may require a Holder to pay any taxes and fees required by law or permitted by the Indenture. The Issuer need not exchange or register the transfer of any Note or portion of a Note selected for redemption, except for the unredeemed portion of any Note being redeemed in part. Also, the Issuer need not exchange or register the transfer of any Notes for a period of 15 days before a selection of Notes to be redeemed.
11.
Persons Deemed Owners
. The registered Holder of a Note may be treated as its owner for all purposes.
12.
Amendment, Supplement and Waiver
. The Indenture, the Notes, the Security Documents and the Intercreditor Agreement may be amended or supplemented as provided in the Indenture.
13.
Defaults and Remedies
. The Events of Default relating to the Notes are defined in Section 7.01 of the Indenture. If any Event of Default occurs and is continuing, the Trustee or the Holders of at least 25% in principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may declare the principal, premium, if any, interest and any other monetary obligations on all the then outstanding Notes to be due and payable immediately. Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the case of an Event of Default arising from certain events of bankruptcy or insolvency, all outstanding Notes will become due and payable immediately without further action or notice. Holders may not enforce the Indenture or the Notes except as provided in the Indenture. Subject to certain limitations, Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the then outstanding Notes may direct the Trustee in its exercise of any trust or power. The Trustee may withhold from Holders of the Notes notice of any continuing Default (except a Default relating to the payment of principal, premium, if any, or interest) if it determines that withholding notice is in their interest. The Holders of a majority in aggregate principal amount of the Notes then outstanding by notice to the Trustee may on behalf of the Holders of all of the Notes waive any existing Default or and its consequences under the Indenture except a continuing Default in payment of the principal of, premium, if any, or interest on, any of the Notes held by a non-consenting Holder. The Issuer is required to deliver to the Trustee annually a statement regarding compliance with the Indenture, and the Issuer is required within five (5) Business Days after becoming aware of any Default, to deliver to the Trustee a statement specifying such Default and what action the Issuer is taking or proposes to take with respect thereto.
14.
Authentication
. This Note shall not be entitled to any benefit under the Indenture or be valid or obligatory for any purpose until authenticated by the manual signature of the Trustee.
15.
GOVERNING LAW
. THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SHALL GOVERN AND BE USED TO CONSTRUE THE INDENTURE AND THE NOTES.
16.
CUSIP and ISIN Numbers
. Pursuant to a recommendation promulgated by the Committee on Uniform Security Identification Procedures, the Issuer has caused CUSIP and ISIN numbers to be printed on the Notes and the Trustee may use CUSIP and ISIN numbers in notices of redemp-
tion as a convenience to Holders. No representation is made as to the accuracy of such numbers either as printed on the Notes or as contained in any notice of redemption and reliance may be placed only on the other identification numbers placed thereon.
The Issuer will furnish to any Holder upon written request and without charge a copy of the Indenture. Requests may be made to the Issuer at the following address:
Washington Mutual, Inc.
1201 Third Avenue
Seattle, Washington 98101
Attention: General Counsel
ASSIGNMENT FORM
To assign this Note, fill in the form below:
(I) or (we) assign and transfer this Note to:
(Insert assignee’s legal name)
|
(Insert assignee’s soc. sec. or tax I.D. no.)
|
|
|
|
(Print or type assignee’s name, address and zip code)
|
and irrevocably appoint
to transfer this Note on the books of the Issuer. The agent may substitute another to act for him.
Date: _____________________
|
(Sign exactly as your name appears
|
|
on the face of this Note)
|
Signature Guarantee*:
*
|
Participant in a recognized Signature Guarantee Medallion Program (or other signature guarantor acceptable to the Trustee).
|
SCHEDULE OF EXCHANGES OF INTERESTS IN THE GLOBAL NOTE*
The following exchanges of a part of this Global Note for an interest in another Global Note or for a Definitive Note, or exchanges of a part of another Global or Definitive Note for an interest in this Global Note, or increased for a PIK Payment, have been made:
Date of Exchange/Transfer
|
Amount of decrease in
Principal Amount
|
Amount of increase in Principal Amount of this Global Note
|
Principal Amount of this Global Note following such decrease or increase
|
Signature of authorized officer of Trustee or Custodian
|
|
|
|
|
|
_______________________
*
|
This schedule should be included only if the Note is issued in global form.
|
EX. T3E.2
UNITED STATES BANKRUPTCY COURT
DISTRICT OF DELAWARE
|
:
|
|
In re
|
:
|
Chapter 11
|
|
:
|
|
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.,
et al. ,
|
:
|
|
|
:
|
Case No. 08-12229 (MFW)
|
|
:
|
|
Debtors.
|
:
|
(Jointly Administered)
|
|
:
|
|
|
:
|
|
SEVENTH AMENDED JOINT PLAN OF AFFILIATED DEBTORS
|
WEIL, GOTSHAL & MANGES LLP
767 Fifth Avenue
New York, New York 10153
(212) 310-8000
|
|
|
|
- and -
|
|
|
|
RICHARDS, LAYTON & FINGER, P.A.
One Rodney Square
920 North King Street
Wilmington, Delaware 19801
(302) 651-7700
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Dated: December 12, 2011
|
|
|
|
DEFINITIONS
|
|
1
|
1.1
|
|
AAOC
|
|
1
|
1.2
|
|
AAOC Releasees
|
|
1
|
1.3
|
|
Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder
|
|
1
|
1.4
|
|
Acquisition JPMC Entities
|
|
1
|
1.5
|
|
Actions
|
|
1
|
1.6
|
|
Admin Account
|
|
1
|
1.7
|
|
Administrative Claim Bar Date
|
|
1
|
1.8
|
|
Administrative Expense Claim
|
|
2
|
1.9
|
|
Affiliate
|
|
2
|
1.10
|
|
Affiliated Banks
|
|
2
|
1.11
|
|
Allowed Administrative Expense Claim
|
|
2
|
1.12
|
|
Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim
|
|
2
|
1.13
|
|
Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim
|
|
2
|
1.14
|
|
Allowed Claim
|
|
2
|
1.15
|
|
Allowed Convenience Claim
|
|
3
|
1.16
|
|
Allowed General Unsecured Claim
|
|
3
|
1.17
|
|
Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim
|
|
3
|
1.18
|
|
Allowed Late-Filed Claim
|
|
3
|
1.19
|
|
Allowed PIERS Claim
|
|
3
|
1.20
|
|
Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim
|
|
3
|
1.21
|
|
Allowed Priority Tax Claim
|
|
3
|
1.22
|
|
Allowed Senior Notes Claim
|
|
3
|
1.23
|
|
Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim
|
|
3
|
1.24
|
|
Allowed Subordinated Claim
|
|
4
|
1.25
|
|
Allowed Trustee Claim
|
|
4
|
1.26
|
|
Allowed Unsecured Claim
|
|
4
|
1.27
|
|
Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim
|
|
4
|
1.28
|
|
Allowed WMB Vendor Claim
|
|
4
|
1.29
|
|
Allowed WMI Vendor Claim
|
|
4
|
1.30
|
|
American Savings Escrow Funds
|
|
4
|
1.31
|
|
American Savings Litigation
|
|
4
|
1.32
|
|
Anchor Litigation
|
|
4
|
1.33
|
|
Assets
|
|
4
|
1.34
|
|
Avoidance Actions
|
|
4
|
1.35
|
|
Ballot
|
|
5
|
1.36
|
|
Ballot Date
|
|
5
|
1.37
|
|
Bankruptcy Code
|
|
5
|
1.38
|
|
Bankruptcy Court
|
|
5
|
1.39
|
|
Bankruptcy Rules
|
|
5
|
1.40
|
|
Bankruptcy Stay Motions
|
|
5
|
1.41
|
|
BB Liquidating Trust Interests
|
|
5
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.42
|
|
Benefit Plan
|
|
5
|
1.43
|
|
BKK Group
|
|
5
|
1.44
|
|
BKK Liabilities
|
|
5
|
1.45
|
|
BKK Litigation
|
|
6
|
1.46
|
|
BKK Proofs of Claim
|
|
6
|
1.47
|
|
BKK Settlement Agreement
|
|
6
|
1.48
|
|
Bond Claim
|
|
6
|
1.49
|
|
Bond Indemnity
|
|
6
|
1.50
|
|
Bonding Companies
|
|
6
|
1.51
|
|
Bonds
|
|
6
|
1.52
|
|
Business Day
|
|
6
|
1.53
|
|
Cash
|
|
6
|
1.54
|
|
Cash Equivalents
|
|
6
|
1.55
|
|
Causes of Action
|
|
7
|
1.56
|
|
CCB-1 Common Securities
|
|
7
|
1.57
|
|
CCB-1 Guarantees
|
|
7
|
1.58
|
|
CCB-1 Guarantees Claim
|
|
7
|
1.59
|
|
CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements
|
|
7
|
1.60
|
|
CCB-1 Preferred Securities
|
|
7
|
1.61
|
|
CCB-1 Trustee
|
|
7
|
1.62
|
|
CCB-2 Common Securities
|
|
7
|
1.63
|
|
CCB-2 Guarantees
|
|
8
|
1.64
|
|
CCB-2 Guarantees Claim
|
|
8
|
1.65
|
|
CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements
|
|
8
|
1.66
|
|
CCB-2 Preferred Securities
|
|
8
|
1.67
|
|
CCB-2 Trustees
|
|
8
|
1.68
|
|
CCB Releasees
|
|
8
|
1.69
|
|
CDTSC
|
|
8
|
1.70
|
|
Chapter 11 Cases
|
|
8
|
1.71
|
|
Claim
|
|
8
|
1.72
|
|
Class
|
|
8
|
1.73
|
|
Common Equity Interest
|
|
9
|
1.74
|
|
Common Stock Allotment
|
|
9
|
1.75
|
|
Confirmation Date
|
|
9
|
1.76
|
|
Confirmation Hearing
|
|
9
|
1.77
|
|
Confirmation Order
|
|
9
|
1.78
|
|
Convenience Claim
|
|
9
|
1.79
|
|
Credit Facility
|
|
9
|
1.80
|
|
Creditor
|
|
10
|
1.81
|
|
Creditor Cash
|
|
10
|
1.82
|
|
Creditors’ Committee
|
|
10
|
1.83
|
|
Debtors
|
|
10
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.84
|
|
Debtors’ Claims
|
|
10
|
1.85
|
|
Debtors in Possession
|
|
10
|
1.86
|
|
Dime Inc.
|
|
10
|
1.87
|
|
Dime Warrant Litigation
|
|
10
|
1.88
|
|
Dime Warrants
|
|
11
|
1.89
|
|
Disbursing Agent
|
|
11
|
1.90
|
|
Disclosure Statement
|
|
11
|
1.91
|
|
Disclosure Statement Order
|
|
11
|
1.92
|
|
Disputed Accounts
|
|
11
|
1.93
|
|
Disputed Claim
|
|
11
|
1.94
|
|
Disputed Equity Escrow
|
|
11
|
1.95
|
|
Disputed Equity Interest
|
|
11
|
1.96
|
|
Distribution Record Date
|
|
12
|
1.97
|
|
Effective Date
|
|
12
|
1.98
|
|
Entity
|
|
12
|
1.99
|
|
Equity Committee
|
|
12
|
1.100
|
|
Equity Committee Adversary Proceeding
|
|
12
|
1.101
|
|
Equity Committee Action to Compel
|
|
12
|
1.102
|
|
Equity Release Election Date
|
|
12
|
1.103
|
|
Equity Interest
|
|
12
|
1.104
|
|
Estate Claims
|
|
13
|
1.105
|
|
FDIC Claim
|
|
13
|
1.106
|
|
FDIC Corporate
|
|
13
|
1.107
|
|
FDIC Receiver
|
|
13
|
1.108
|
|
FDIC Stay Relief Motion
|
|
13
|
1.109
|
|
Final Order
|
|
13
|
1.110
|
|
Fixed Rate Notes
|
|
14
|
1.111
|
|
Floating Rate Notes
|
|
14
|
1.112
|
|
FSB
|
|
14
|
1.113
|
|
General Unsecured Claim
|
|
14
|
1.114
|
|
Global Settlement Agreement
|
|
14
|
1.115
|
|
Guarantee Agreements
|
|
14
|
1.116
|
|
Indentures
|
|
14
|
1.117
|
|
Information Demands
|
|
14
|
1.118
|
|
Intercompany Claim
|
|
15
|
1.119
|
|
Intercompany Notes
|
|
15
|
1.120
|
|
IRC
|
|
15
|
1.121
|
|
Intercreditor Interest Claim
|
|
15
|
1.122
|
|
IRS
|
|
15
|
1.123
|
|
January Opinion
|
|
15
|
1.124
|
|
JPMC
|
|
15
|
1.125
|
|
JPMC Action
|
|
15
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.126
|
|
JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim
|
|
15
|
1.127
|
|
JPMC Assumed Liabilities
|
|
15
|
1.128
|
|
JPMC Assumed Liability Claim
|
|
16
|
1.129
|
|
JPMC Claims
|
|
16
|
1.130
|
|
JPMC Entities
|
|
16
|
1.131
|
|
JPMC Policies
|
|
16
|
1.132
|
|
JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claim
|
|
16
|
1.133
|
|
JPMC Rabbi Trusts
|
|
16
|
1.134
|
|
Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture
|
|
16
|
1.135
|
|
Lakeview Plan
|
|
16
|
1.136
|
|
Late-Filed Claim
|
|
17
|
1.137
|
|
Lien
|
|
17
|
1.138
|
|
Liquidating Trust
|
|
17
|
1.139
|
|
Liquidating Trust Agreement
|
|
17
|
1.140
|
|
Liquidating Trust Assets
|
|
17
|
1.141
|
|
Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries
|
|
17
|
1.142
|
|
Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve
|
|
18
|
1.143
|
|
Liquidating Trustee
|
|
18
|
1.144
|
|
Liquidating Trust Interests
|
|
18
|
1.145
|
|
Litigation Proceeds
|
|
18
|
1.146
|
|
Litigation Proceeds Interest
|
|
18
|
1.147
|
|
Local Bankruptcy Rules
|
|
18
|
1.148
|
|
Modified Plan
|
|
18
|
1.149
|
|
Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder
|
|
18
|
1.150
|
|
Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders Election Form
|
|
18
|
1.151
|
|
Original Disclosure Statement Order
|
|
19
|
1.152
|
|
Other Benefit Plan Claim
|
|
19
|
1.153
|
|
Other Subordinated Claim
|
|
19
|
1.154
|
|
Penalty Claim
|
|
19
|
1.155
|
|
Pension Plans
|
|
19
|
1.156
|
|
Person
|
|
19
|
1.157
|
|
Petition Date
|
|
19
|
1.158
|
|
PIERS Claim
|
|
19
|
1.159
|
|
PIERS Claims Releasees
|
|
19
|
1.160
|
|
PIERS Common Securities
|
|
20
|
1.161
|
|
PIERS Guarantee Agreement
|
|
20
|
1.162
|
|
PIERS Preferred Securities
|
|
20
|
1.163
|
|
PIERS Trust Agreement
|
|
20
|
1.164
|
|
PIERS Trustee:
|
|
20
|
1.165
|
|
Plan
|
|
20
|
1.166
|
|
Plan Contribution Assets
|
|
20
|
1.167
|
|
Plan Supplement
|
|
20
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.168
|
|
Plan Support Agreement
|
|
21
|
1.169
|
|
Postpetition Interest Claim
|
|
21
|
1.170
|
|
Preferred Equity Interest
|
|
21
|
1.171
|
|
Preserved Avoidance Actions
|
|
21
|
1.172
|
|
Priority Non-Tax Claim
|
|
21
|
1.173
|
|
Priority Tax Claim
|
|
21
|
1.174
|
|
Privileges
|
|
21
|
1.175
|
|
Pro Rata Share
|
|
21
|
1.176
|
|
Purchase and Assumption Agreement
|
|
22
|
1.177
|
|
Qualified Plan Claim
|
|
22
|
1.178
|
|
Receivership
|
|
22
|
1.179
|
|
Registry Funds
|
|
22
|
1.180
|
|
REIT Series
|
|
22
|
1.181
|
|
Related Actions
|
|
23
|
1.182
|
|
Related Persons
|
|
23
|
1.183
|
|
Released Claims
|
|
23
|
1.184
|
|
Released Parties
|
|
24
|
1.185
|
|
Released Third Party Causes of Action
|
|
24
|
1.186
|
|
Releasing REIT Trust Holder
|
|
24
|
1.187
|
|
Remaining Postpetition Interest Claim
|
|
24
|
1.188
|
|
Reorganized Common Stock
|
|
24
|
1.189
|
|
Reorganized Debtors
|
|
25
|
1.190
|
|
Reorganized Debtors By-Laws
|
|
25
|
1.191
|
|
Reorganized Debtors Certificates of Incorporation
|
|
25
|
1.192
|
|
Reorganized WMI
|
|
25
|
1.193
|
|
Rule 2004 Inquiry
|
|
25
|
1.194
|
|
Rule 2019 Appeal
|
|
25
|
1.195
|
|
Runoff Indenture
|
|
25
|
1.196
|
|
Runoff Notes
|
|
25
|
1.197
|
|
Runoff Proceeds
|
|
26
|
1.198
|
|
Runoff Threshold
|
|
26
|
1.199
|
|
Schedules
|
|
26
|
1.200
|
|
Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claim
|
|
26
|
1.201
|
|
Securities Litigations
|
|
26
|
1.202
|
|
Senior Notes
|
|
27
|
1.203
|
|
Senior Notes Claim
|
|
27
|
1.204
|
|
Senior Notes Claims Releasees
|
|
27
|
1.205
|
|
Senior Notes Indenture
|
|
27
|
1.206
|
|
Senior Notes Indenture Trustee
|
|
27
|
1.207
|
|
Senior Notes Release Consideration
|
|
27
|
1.208
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes
|
|
27
|
1.209
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes Claim
|
|
27
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.210
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees
|
|
27
|
1.211
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture
|
|
28
|
1.212
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee
|
|
28
|
1.213
|
|
Senior Subordinated Notes Release Consideration
|
|
28
|
1.214
|
|
September Opinion
|
|
28
|
1.215
|
|
September Order
|
|
28
|
1.216
|
|
Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders
|
|
28
|
1.217
|
|
Sixth Amended Plan
|
|
28
|
1.218
|
|
Standing Motion
|
|
28
|
1.219
|
|
Stock Trading Order
|
|
28
|
1.220
|
|
Subordinated Claim
|
|
28
|
1.221
|
|
Subordination Model
|
|
29
|
1.222
|
|
Tax Authority
|
|
29
|
1.223
|
|
Taxes
|
|
29
|
1.224
|
|
Tax Refunds
|
|
29
|
1.225
|
|
Tax Return
|
|
29
|
1.226
|
|
Texas Litigation
|
|
29
|
1.227
|
|
Tranquility
|
|
29
|
1.228
|
|
Tranquility Claim
|
|
29
|
1.229
|
|
Transferred Intellectual Property
|
|
29
|
1.230
|
|
Treasury Regulations
|
|
29
|
1.231
|
|
Trust Advisory Board
|
|
29
|
1.232
|
|
Trustee Claims
|
|
30
|
1.233
|
|
Trustee Distribution Expenses
|
|
30
|
1.234
|
|
Trustees
|
|
30
|
1.235
|
|
Trust Preferred Securities
|
|
30
|
1.236
|
|
Trust Preferred Trustees
|
|
30
|
1.237
|
|
Trusts
|
|
30
|
1.238
|
|
Turnover Action
|
|
31
|
1.239
|
|
Unidentified Intellectual Property
|
|
31
|
1.240
|
|
Unsecured Claim
|
|
31
|
1.241
|
|
Vendor Escrow
|
|
31
|
1.242
|
|
Visa Claims
|
|
31
|
1.243
|
|
Visa Shares
|
|
31
|
1.244
|
|
Voting Record Date
|
|
31
|
1.245
|
|
WaMu Pension Plan
|
|
31
|
1.246
|
|
WMB
|
|
31
|
1.247
|
|
WMB Intellectual Property
|
|
32
|
1.248
|
|
WMB Global Note Program
|
|
32
|
1.249
|
|
WMB Notes Claim
|
|
32
|
1.250
|
|
WMB Senior Notes
|
|
32
|
1.251
|
|
WMB Senior Notes Claim
|
|
32
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
1.252
|
|
WMB Subordinated Notes
|
|
32
|
1.253
|
|
WMB Subordinated Notes Claim
|
|
32
|
1.254
|
|
WMB Vendor Claim
|
|
32
|
1.255
|
|
WMI
|
|
32
|
1.256
|
|
WMI Accounts
|
|
32
|
1.257
|
|
WMI Action
|
|
32
|
1.258
|
|
WMI Entities
|
|
32
|
1.259
|
|
WMI Intellectual Property
|
|
32
|
1.260
|
|
WMI Investment
|
|
33
|
1.261
|
|
WMI Medical Plan
|
|
33
|
1.262
|
|
WMI Medical Plan Claim
|
|
33
|
1.263
|
|
WMI Policies
|
|
33
|
1.264
|
|
WMI Rabbi Trust
|
|
33
|
1.265
|
|
WMI Vendor Claim
|
|
33
|
1.266
|
|
WMI/WMB Intercompany Claim
|
|
33
|
1.267
|
|
WMMRC
|
|
33
|
1.268
|
|
Other Definitions
|
|
33
|
ARTICLE II
|
|
COMPROMISE AND SETTLEMENT OF DISPUTES
|
|
33
|
2.1
|
|
Compromise, Settlement and Sale
|
|
33
|
ARTICLE III
|
|
PROVISIONS FOR PAYMENT OF ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSE CLAIMS AND PRIORITY TAX CLAIMS
|
|
38
|
3.1
|
|
Administrative Expense Claims
|
|
38
|
3.2
|
|
Professional Compensation and Reimbursement Claims
|
|
38
|
3.3
|
|
Priority Tax Claims
|
|
38
|
3.4
|
|
Statutory Fees
|
|
39
|
3.5
|
|
Administrative Tax Claims
|
|
39
|
ARTICLE IV
|
|
CLASSIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND EQUITY INTERESTS
|
|
39
|
4.1
|
|
Class 1 Priority Non-Tax Claims
|
|
39
|
4.2
|
|
Class 2 Senior Notes Claims
|
|
39
|
4.3
|
|
Class 3 Senior Subordinated Notes Claims
|
|
39
|
4.4
|
|
Class 4 WMI Medical Plan Claims
|
|
39
|
4.5
|
|
Class 5 JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims
|
|
39
|
4.6
|
|
Class 6 Other Benefit Plan Claims
|
|
39
|
4.7
|
|
Class 7 Qualified Plan Claims
|
|
39
|
4.8
|
|
Class 8 WMB Vendor Claims
|
|
39
|
4.9
|
|
Class 9 Visa Claims
|
|
39
|
4.10
|
|
Class 10 Bond Claims
|
|
39
|
4.11
|
|
Class 11 WMI Vendor Claims
|
|
39
|
4.12
|
|
Class 12 General Unsecured Claims Class 12A Late-Filed Claims
|
|
39
|
4.13
|
|
Class 13 Convenience Claims
|
|
39
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
4.14
|
|
Class 14 CCB-1 Guarantees Claims
|
|
39
|
4.15
|
|
Class 15 CCB-2 Guarantees Claims
|
|
39
|
4.16
|
|
Class 16 PIERS Claims
|
|
39
|
4.17
|
|
Class 17A WMB Senior Notes Claims Class 17B WMB Subordinated Notes Claims
|
|
39
|
4.18
|
|
Class 18 Subordinated Claims
|
|
39
|
4.19
|
|
Class 19 Preferred Equity Interests
|
|
39
|
4.20
|
|
Class 20 Intentionally Left Blank
|
|
39
|
4.21
|
|
Class 21 Dime Warrants
|
|
39
|
4.22
|
|
Class 22 Common Equity Interests
|
|
39
|
ARTICLE V
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PRIORITY NON-TAX CLAIMS (CLASS 1)
|
|
40
|
5.1
|
|
Payment of Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims
|
|
40
|
ARTICLE VI
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF SENIOR NOTES CLAIMS (CLASS 2)
|
|
40
|
6.1
|
|
Treatment of Senior Notes Claims
|
|
40
|
6.2
|
|
Rights of Election
|
|
41
|
6.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
42
|
ARTICLE VII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES CLAIMS (CLASS 3)
|
|
42
|
7.1
|
|
Treatment of Senior Subordinated Notes Claims
|
|
42
|
7.2
|
|
Rights of Election
|
|
43
|
7.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
44
|
ARTICLE VIII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMI MEDICAL PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 4)
|
|
45
|
8.1
|
|
Treatment of WMI Medical Plan Claims
|
|
45
|
ARTICLE IX
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF JPMC RABBI TRUST/POLICY CLAIMS (CLASS 5)
|
|
45
|
9.1
|
|
Treatment of JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims
|
|
45
|
ARTICLE X
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF OTHER BENEFIT PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 6)
|
|
45
|
10.1
|
|
Treatment of Other Benefit Plan Claims
|
|
45
|
ARTICLE XI
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF QUALIFIED PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 7)
|
|
45
|
11.1
|
|
Treatment of Qualified Plan Claims
|
|
45
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
ARTICLE XII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMB VENDOR CLAIMS (CLASS 8)
|
|
45
|
12.1
|
|
Treatment of WMB Vendor Claims
|
|
45
|
ARTICLE XIII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF VISA CLAIMS (CLASS 9)
|
|
46
|
13.1
|
|
Treatment of Visa Claims
|
|
46
|
ARTICLE XIV
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF BOND CLAIMS (CLASS 10)
|
|
46
|
14.1
|
|
Treatment of Bond Claims
|
|
46
|
ARTICLE XV
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMI VENDOR CLAIMS (CLASS 11)
|
|
46
|
15.1
|
|
Treatment of WMI Vendor Claims
|
|
46
|
ARTICLE XVI
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF GENERAL UNSECURED CLAIMS (CLASS 12)
|
|
46
|
16.1
|
|
Class 12 – General Unsecured Claims
|
|
46
|
16.2
|
|
Class 12A – Late-Filed Claims
|
|
48
|
16.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
48
|
ARTICLE XVII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF CONVENIENCE CLAIMS (CLASS 13)
|
|
48
|
17.1
|
|
Treatment of Convenience Claims
|
|
48
|
ARTICLE XVIII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF CCB-1 GUARANTEES CLAIMS (CLASS 14)
|
|
49
|
18.1
|
|
Treatment of CCB-1 Guarantees Claims
|
|
49
|
18.2
|
|
Rights of Election
|
|
50
|
18.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
50
|
ARTICLE XIX
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF CCB-2 GUARANTEES CLAIMS (CLASS 15)
|
|
51
|
19.1
|
|
Treatment of CCB-2 Guarantees Claims
|
|
51
|
19.2
|
|
Rights of Election
|
|
52
|
19.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
53
|
ARTICLE XX
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PIERS CLAIMS (CLASS 16)
|
|
53
|
20.1
|
|
Treatment of PIERS Claims
|
|
53
|
20.2
|
|
Reorganized Common Stock Election
|
|
54
|
20.3
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
55
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
ARTICLE XXI
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMB NOTES CLAIMS AND NON-FILING WMB SENIOR NOTE HOLDERS (CLASS 17)
|
|
55
|
21.1
|
|
Treatment of WMB Notes Claims
|
|
55
|
ARTICLE XXII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF SUBORDINATED CLAIMS (CLASS 18)
|
|
58
|
22.1
|
|
Treatment of Subordinated Claims
|
|
58
|
22.2
|
|
Limitation on Recovery
|
|
58
|
ARTICLE XXIII
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PREFERRED EQUITY INTEREST (CLASS 19)
|
|
58
|
23.1
|
|
Treatment of Preferred Equity Interests
|
|
58
|
23.2
|
|
Cancellation of REIT Series
|
|
59
|
23.3
|
|
Cancellation of Preferred Equity Interests
|
|
59
|
ARTICLE XXIV
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF DIME WARRANTS (CLASS 21)
|
|
59
|
24.1
|
|
Treatment of Dime Warrants
|
|
59
|
24.2
|
|
Cancellation of Dime Warrants
|
|
60
|
ARTICLE XXV
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF COMMON EQUITY INTERESTS (CLASS 22)
|
|
60
|
25.1
|
|
Treatment of Common Equity Interests
|
|
60
|
25.2
|
|
Cancellation of Common Equity Interests
|
|
60
|
ARTICLE XXVI
|
|
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF DISPUTED CLAIMS AND DISPUTED EQUITY INTERESTS
|
|
60
|
26.1
|
|
Objections to Claims; Prosecution of Disputed Claims and Disputed Equity Interests
|
|
60
|
26.2
|
|
Estimation of Claims
|
|
61
|
26.3
|
|
Payments and Distributions on Disputed Claims and Disputed Equity Interests
|
|
61
|
ARTICLE XXVII
|
|
THE LIQUIDATING TRUST
|
|
64
|
27.1
|
|
Execution of Liquidating Trust Agreement
|
|
64
|
27.2
|
|
Purpose of the Liquidating Trust
|
|
65
|
27.3
|
|
Liquidating Trust Assets
|
|
65
|
27.4
|
|
Administration of the Liquidating Trust
|
|
65
|
27.5
|
|
The Liquidating Trustee
|
|
65
|
27.6
|
|
Role of the Liquidating Trustee
|
|
65
|
27.7
|
|
Liquidating Trustee’s Tax Power for Debtors
|
|
66
|
27.8
|
|
Transferability of Liquidating Trust Interests
|
|
66
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
27.9
|
|
Cash
|
|
67
|
27.10
|
|
Distribution of Liquidating Trust Assets
|
|
67
|
27.11
|
|
Costs and Expenses of the Liquidating Trust
|
|
67
|
27.12
|
|
Compensation of the Liquidating Trustee
|
|
67
|
27.13
|
|
Retention of Professionals/Employees by the Liquidating Trustee
|
|
67
|
27.14
|
|
Federal Income Tax Treatment of the Liquidating Trust
|
|
68
|
27.15
|
|
Indemnification of Liquidating Trustee
|
|
71
|
27.16
|
|
Privileges and Obligation to Respond to Ongoing Investigations
|
|
71
|
ARTICLE XXVIII
|
|
PROSECUTION AND EXTINGUISHMENT OF CLAIMS HELD BY THE DEBTORS
|
|
72
|
28.1
|
|
Prosecution of Claims
|
|
72
|
ARTICLE XXIX
|
|
ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN; EFFECT OF REJECTION BY ONE OR MORE CLASSES OF CLAIMS OR EQUITY INTERESTS
|
|
73
|
29.1
|
|
Impaired Classes to Vote
|
|
73
|
29.2
|
|
Acceptance by Class of Creditors
|
|
73
|
29.3
|
|
Cramdown
|
|
73
|
ARTICLE XXX
|
|
IDENTIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND EQUITY INTERESTS IMPAIRED AND NOT IMPAIRED BY THE PLAN
|
|
73
|
30.1
|
|
Impaired and Unimpaired Classes
|
|
73
|
30.2
|
|
Impaired Classes Entitled to Vote on Plan
|
|
73
|
30.3
|
|
Claims and Equity Interests Deemed to Reject
|
|
73
|
30.4
|
|
Claims Deemed to Accept
|
|
74
|
30.5
|
|
Controversy Concerning Impairment
|
|
74
|
ARTICLE XXXI
|
|
PROVISIONS GOVERNING DISTRIBUTIONS
|
|
74
|
31.1
|
|
Time and Manner of Distributions
|
|
74
|
31.2
|
|
Timeliness of Payments
|
|
75
|
31.3
|
|
Distributions by the Disbursing Agent
|
|
75
|
31.4
|
|
Manner of Payment under the Plan
|
|
75
|
31.5
|
|
Delivery of Distributions
|
|
75
|
31.6
|
|
Undeliverable/Reserved Distributions
|
|
76
|
31.7
|
|
Withholding and Reporting Requirements
|
|
78
|
31.8
|
|
Time Bar to Cash Payments
|
|
78
|
31.9
|
|
Distributions After Effective Date
|
|
79
|
31.10
|
|
Setoffs
|
|
79
|
31.11
|
|
Allocation of Plan Distributions Between Principal and Interest
|
|
79
|
31.12
|
|
Payment of Trustee Fees and Expenses
|
|
79
|
31.13
|
|
Distribution Record Date
|
|
80
|
31.14
|
|
Runoff Notes
|
|
80
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
ARTICLE XXXII
|
|
MEANS OF IMPLEMENTATION
|
|
81
|
32.1
|
|
Incorporation and Enforcement of the Settlement Agreement
|
|
81
|
32.2
|
|
Intercompany Claims
|
|
82
|
32.3
|
|
Merger/Dissolution/Consolidation
|
|
82
|
32.4
|
|
Cancellation of Existing Securities and Agreements
|
|
82
|
32.5
|
|
Claims of Subordination
|
|
83
|
32.6
|
|
Surrender of Instruments
|
|
83
|
32.7
|
|
Issuance of Runoff Notes, Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock
|
|
83
|
32.8
|
|
Exemption from Securities Laws
|
|
83
|
32.9
|
|
Hart-Scott-Rodino Compliance
|
|
84
|
32.10
|
|
Fractional Stock or Other Distributions
|
|
84
|
32.11
|
|
Credit Facility
|
|
84
|
ARTICLE XXXIII
|
|
CREDITORS’ COMMITTEE/EQUITY COMMITTEE
|
|
84
|
33.1
|
|
Dissolution of the Creditors’ Committee
|
|
84
|
33.2
|
|
Dissolution of the Equity Committee
|
|
85
|
ARTICLE XXXIV
|
|
EXECUTORY CONTRACTS AND UNEXPIRED LEASES
|
|
86
|
34.1
|
|
Rejection or Assumption of Remaining Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases
|
|
86
|
34.2
|
|
Approval of Rejection or Assumption of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases
|
|
86
|
34.3
|
|
Inclusiveness
|
|
86
|
34.4
|
|
Cure of Defaults
|
|
86
|
34.5
|
|
Rejection Damage Claims
|
|
87
|
34.6
|
|
Indemnification and Reimbursement Obligations
|
|
87
|
34.7
|
|
Termination of Benefit Plans
|
|
87
|
34.8
|
|
Termination of Vendor Stipulation
|
|
88
|
ARTICLE XXXV
|
|
RIGHTS AND POWERS OF DISBURSING AGENT
|
|
88
|
35.1
|
|
Exculpation
|
|
88
|
35.2
|
|
Powers of the Disbursing Agent
|
|
88
|
35.3
|
|
Fees and Expenses Incurred From and After the Effective Date
|
|
88
|
ARTICLE XXXVI
|
|
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CONFIRMATION OF THE PLAN
|
|
89
|
36.1
|
|
Conditions Precedent to Confirmation of the Plan
|
|
89
|
36.2
|
|
Waiver of Conditions Precedent to Confirmation
|
|
90
|
ARTICLE XXXVII
|
|
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO EFFECTIVE DATE OF THE PLAN
|
|
90
|
37.1
|
|
Conditions Precedent to Effective Date of the Plan
|
|
90
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
37.2
|
|
Waiver of Conditions Precedent
|
|
91
|
ARTICLE XXXVIII
|
|
RETENTION OF JURISDICTION
|
|
91
|
38.1
|
|
Retention of Jurisdiction
|
|
91
|
ARTICLE XXXIX
|
|
MODIFICATION, REVOCATION, OR WITHDRAWAL OF THE PLAN
|
|
93
|
39.1
|
|
Modification of Plan
|
|
93
|
39.2
|
|
Revocation or Withdrawal
|
|
93
|
39.3
|
|
Amendment of Plan Documents
|
|
93
|
39.4
|
|
No Admission of Liability
|
|
93
|
ARTICLE XL
|
|
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE AND MANAGEMENT OF THE REORGANIZED DEBTORS
|
|
94
|
40.1
|
|
Corporate Action
|
|
94
|
40.2
|
|
Reincorporation
|
|
95
|
40.3
|
|
Amendment of Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws
|
|
95
|
40.4
|
|
Directors of the Reorganized Debtors
|
|
95
|
40.5
|
|
Officers of the Reorganized Debtors
|
|
95
|
ARTICLE XLI
|
|
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
|
|
95
|
41.1
|
|
Title to Assets
|
|
95
|
41.2
|
|
Discharge and Release of Claims and Termination of Equity Interests
|
|
96
|
41.3
|
|
Injunction on Claims
|
|
97
|
41.4
|
|
Integral to Plan
|
|
98
|
41.5
|
|
Releases by the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee and the Equity Committee
|
|
98
|
41.6
|
|
Releases by Holders of Claims and Equity Interests
|
|
99
|
41.7
|
|
Injunction Related to Releases
|
|
102
|
41.8
|
|
Exculpation
|
|
102
|
41.9
|
|
Bar Order
|
|
103
|
41.10
|
|
Deemed Consent
|
|
103
|
41.11
|
|
No Waiver
|
|
103
|
41.12
|
|
Supplemental Injunction
|
|
103
|
41.13
|
|
Term of Existing Injunctions or Stays
|
|
104
|
41.14
|
|
Payment of Statutory Fees
|
|
104
|
41.15
|
|
Post-Effective Date Fees and Expenses
|
|
105
|
41.16
|
|
Exemption from Transfer Taxes
|
|
105
|
41.17
|
|
Withdrawal of Equity Committee Proceedings
|
|
105
|
41.18
|
|
Payment of Fees and Expenses of Certain Creditors
|
|
105
|
41.19
|
|
Securities Litigations Documents
|
|
105
|
41.20
|
|
Severability
|
|
106
|
41.21
|
|
Governing Law
|
|
106
|
TABLE OF CONTENTS
(continued)
|
|
Page
|
41.22
|
|
Notices
|
|
106
|
41.23
|
|
Closing of Case
|
|
107
|
41.24
|
|
Section Headings
|
|
107
|
41.25
|
|
Inconsistencies
|
|
107
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. and WMI Investment Corp. hereby propose the following joint chapter 11 plan pursuant to section 1121(a) of the Bankruptcy Code:
ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS
As used in the Plan, the following terms shall have the respective meanings specified below and be equally applicable to the singular and plural of the terms defined:
1.1
AAOC
: Each of (a) Appaloosa Management L.P., Appaloosa Investment L.P. I, Palomino Fund Ltd., Thoroughbred Fund, L.P., and Thoroughbred Master Ltd., (b) Aurelius Capital Management, LP, Aurelius Capital Partners, LP, Aurelius Convergence Master, Ltd., ACP Master, Ltd., Aurelius Capital Master, Ltd. and Aurelius Investment, LLC, (c) Owl Creek Asset Management, L.P., Owl Creek I, L.P., Owl Creek II, L.P., Owl Creek Overseas Fund, Ltd., Owl Creek Socially Responsible Investment Fund, Ltd., Owl Creek Asia I, L.P., Owl Creek Asia II, L.P., and Owl Creek Asia Master Fund, Ltd. and (d) Centerbridge Partners, L.P., Centerbridge Special Credit Partners, L.P., Centerbridge Credit Partners, L.P., and Centerbridge Credit Partners Master, L.P. and any other Affiliates of the funds listed in (a) through (d) above which own or, during the Chapter 11 Cases, owned securities issued by and/or have direct or indirect Claims against WMI.
1.2
AAOC Releasees
:
AAOC, any Entities or funds managed by AAOC and each of their respective officers, directors, partners, general partners, limited partners, equity investors, investment managers, management companies, members, employees and, solely in their capacity as counsel to AAOC with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
1.3
Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder
:
A Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder that checked the box on the Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder Election Form labeled “Grant Plan Section 43.6 Release”, tendered in connection with the solicitation of acceptances and releases with respect to the Sixth Amended Plan.
1.4
Acquisition JPMC Entities
:
JPMC in its capacity as the “Acquiring Bank” pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreement and each former subsidiary of WMB acquired pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreement (including each entity into which such former subsidiary may have been merged, consolidated or liquidated), together with JPMC in its capacity as the “Purchaser” pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreement.
1.5
Actions
:
The “Actions,” as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.6
Admin Account
:
That certain account identified as Account No. xxxxxx1206, identified by WMI as having a balance as of the Petition Date in the approximate amount of Fifty Two Million Six Hundred Thousand Dollars ($52,600,000.00).
1.7
Administrative Claim Bar Date
:
Unless otherwise ordered by the Bankruptcy Court, the date established by the Bankruptcy Court and set forth in the Confirmation Order as the last day to file proof of Administrative Expense Claims, which date shall be no more than ninety (90) days after the Effective Date, after which date, any proof of
Administrative Expense Claim not filed shall be deemed forever barred, and the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors and the Liquidating Trust shall have no obligation with respect thereto;
provided
,
however
, that no proof of Administrative Expense Claim shall be required to be filed if such Administrative Expense Claim shall have been incurred (i) in accordance with an order of the Bankruptcy Court or (ii) with the consent of the Debtors and in the ordinary course of the Debtors’ operations.
1.8
Administrative Expense Claim
:
A Claim constituting a cost or expense of administration of the Chapter 11 Cases asserted or authorized to be asserted, on or prior to the Administrative Claim Bar Date, in accordance with sections 503(b) and 507(a)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code arising during the period up to and including the Effective Date, including, without limitation, (i) any actual and necessary cost and expense of preserving the estates of the Debtors, (ii) any actual and necessary cost and expense of operating the businesses of the Debtors in Possession, (iii) any post-Petition Date loan or advance extended by one Debtor to the other Debtor, (iv) any cost and expense of the Debtors in Possession for the management, maintenance, preservation, sale, or other disposition of any assets, (v) the administration and implementation of the Plan, (vi) the administration, prosecution, or defense of Claims by or against the Debtors and for distributions under the Plan, (vii) any guarantee or indemnification obligation extended by the Debtors in Possession, (viii) any Claim for compensation and reimbursement of expenses arising during the period from and after the Petition Date and prior to the Effective Date and awarded by the Bankruptcy Court in accordance with section 328, 330, 331, or 503(b) of the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise in accordance with the provisions of the Plan, whether fixed before or after the Effective Date, (ix) any fee or charge assessed against the Debtors’ estates pursuant to section 1930, chapter 123, title 28, United States Code, and (x) any tort or extracontractual claims against the Debtors in Possession.
1.9
Affiliate
:
With respect to any specified Entity, any other Person that directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with, such specified entity.
1.10
Affiliated Banks
:
WMB and FSB.
1.11
Allowed Administrative Expense Claim
:
An Administrative Expense Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.12
Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim
:
A CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, to the extent set forth on Exhibit “A” hereto.
1.13
Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim
:
A CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, to the extent set forth on Exhibit “B” hereto.
1.14
Allowed Claim
:
A Claim against any of the Debtors or the Debtors’ estates, (i) proof of which was filed on or before the date designated by the Bankruptcy Court as the last date for filing such proof of claim against any such Debtor or such Debtor’s estate, or (ii) if no proof of Claim has been timely filed, which has been or hereafter is listed by such Debtor in its Schedules as liquidated in amount and not disputed or contingent, in each such case in clauses (i) and (ii) above, a Claim as to which no objection to the allowance thereof, or action to
equitably subordinate or otherwise limit recovery with respect thereto, has been interposed within the applicable period of limitation fixed by the Plan, the Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules, or a Final Order, or as to which an objection has been interposed and such Claim has been allowed in whole or in part by a Final Order. For purposes of determining the amount of an “Allowed Claim,” there shall be deducted therefrom an amount equal to the amount of any claim that the Debtors may hold against the holder thereof, to the extent such claim may be set off pursuant to applicable bankruptcy and non-bankruptcy law. Without in any way limiting the foregoing, “Allowed Claim” shall include any Claim arising from the recovery of property in accordance with sections 550 and 553 of the Bankruptcy Code and allowed in accordance with section 502(h) of the Bankruptcy Code, any Claim allowed under or pursuant to the terms of the Plan, or any Claim to the extent that it has been allowed pursuant to a Final Order;
provided
,
however
, that (i) Claims allowed solely for the purpose of voting to accept or reject the Plan pursuant to an order of the Bankruptcy Court shall not be considered “Allowed Claims” hereunder unless otherwise specified herein or by order of the Bankruptcy Court, (ii) for any purpose under the Plan, “Allowed Claim” shall not include interest, penalties, or late charges arising from or relating to the period from and after the Petition Date, and (iii) “Allowed Claim” shall not include any Claim subject to disallowance in accordance with section 502(d) of the Bankruptcy Code. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a WMB Senior Notes Claim may become an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim (in an amount equal to the principal balance thereof plus all interest accrued thereunder as of the Petition Date) in the manner provided for in Section 21.1(a) hereof.
1.15
Allowed Convenience Claim
: A Convenience Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.16
Allowed General Unsecured Claim
:
A General Unsecured Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.17
Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim
:
A JPMC Assumed Liability Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.18
Allowed Late-Filed Claim
:
A Late-Filed Claim to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.19
Allowed PIERS Claim
:
A PIERS Claim, to the extent set forth on Exhibit “D” hereto.
1.20
Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim
:
A Priority Non-Tax Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.21
Allowed Priority Tax Claim
:
A Priority Tax Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.22
Allowed Senior Notes Claim
:
A Senior Notes Claim, to the extent set forth on Exhibit “E” hereto.
1.23
Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim
:
A Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, to the extent set forth on Exhibit “F” hereto.
1.24
Allowed Subordinated Claim
:
A Subordinated Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.25
Allowed Trustee Claim
:
A Trustee Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.26
Allowed Unsecured Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.27
Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim
:
A WMB Senior Notes Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.28
Allowed WMB Vendor Claim
:
A WMB Vendor Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.29
Allowed WMI Vendor Claim
:
A WMI Vendor Claim, to the extent it is or has become an Allowed Claim.
1.30
American Savings Escrow Funds
:
All funds held in escrow in connection with the American Savings Litigation, pursuant to that certain Escrow Agreement, dated December 20, 1996, by and among WMI, Keystone Holdings Partners, L.P., Escrow Partners, L.P. and The Bank of New York.
1.31
American Savings Litigation
:
That certain litigation styled
American Savings Bank, F.A.
v.
United States
, No. 92-872C, currently pending in the United States Court of Federal Claims.
1.32
Anchor Litigation
:
That certain litigation styled
Anchor Savings Bank, FSB
v.
United States
, No. 95-39C, currently pending in the United States Court of Federal Claims, and on appeal in the United States Court of Appeals for the Federal Circuit, as
Anchor Savings Bank, FSB
v.
United States
, No. 2008-5175, -5182.
1.33
Assets
:
With respect to a Debtor, (i) all “property” of such Debtor’s estate, as defined in section 541 of the Bankruptcy Code, including, without limitation, such property as is reflected on such Debtor’s books and records as of the date of the Disclosure Statement Order (including, without limitation, received and anticipated “Net Tax Refunds,” as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement) and certain Plan Contribution Assets transferred to such Debtor pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement, unless modified pursuant to the Plan or a Final Order, and except as transferred pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement and (ii) all claims and causes of action, and any subsequent proceeds thereof, that have been or may be commenced by such Debtor in Possession or other authorized representative for the benefit of such Debtor’s estate, unless modified pursuant to the Plan or a Final Order, including, without limitation, any claim or cause of action pursuant to chapter 5 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.34
Avoidance Actions
:
Any and all avoidance, recovery, subordination or other actions or remedies against Entities that may be brought by or on behalf of a Debtor or its estate under the Bankruptcy Code or applicable non-bankruptcy law under sections 510, 542, 543, 544, 545, 547, 548, 549, 550, 551, 552 and 553 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.35
Ballot
:
The form distributed to each holder of an impaired Claim or Equity Interest entitled to vote on the plan (as set forth herein), on which is to be indicated, among other things, acceptance or rejection of the Plan.
1.36
Ballot Date
:
The date(s) established by the Bankruptcy Court and set forth in the Disclosure Statement Order for the submission of Ballots and the election of alternative treatments pursuant to the terms and provisions of the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that with respect to holders of an Equity Interest, such holders may execute and deliver a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan up to and including the Equity Release Election Date.
1.37
Bankruptcy Code
:
The Bankruptcy Reform Act of 1978, as amended, to the extent codified in title 11, United States Code, as applicable to the Chapter 11 Cases.
1.38
Bankruptcy Court
:
The United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware or such other court having jurisdiction over the Chapter 11 Cases.
1.39
Bankruptcy Rules
:
The Federal Rules of Bankruptcy Procedure, as promulgated by the United States Supreme Court under section 2075 of title 28 of the United States Code, as applicable to the Chapter 11 Cases.
1.40
Bankruptcy Stay Motions
:
The motions by the FDIC Receiver and JPMC to stay or dismiss the Turnover Action and the JPMC Action in favor of proceedings before the United States District Court for the District of Columbia in the WMI Action.
1.41
BB Liquidating Trust Interests
:
Those certain Liquidating Trust Interests that are to be distributed to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, which interests, in the aggregate, shall represent an undivided interest in WMI’s share of the Homeownership Carryback Refund Amount, as defined and set forth in Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement, in an amount equal to Three Hundred Thirty-Five Million Dollars ($335,000,000.00).
1.42
Benefit Plan
:
Any employee welfare benefit plan, employee pension benefit plan, or a plan that is both an employee welfare benefit plan and an employee pension benefit plan within the meaning of Section 3(3) of ERISA, including, without limitation, those benefit plans listed on Exhibit “G” hereto, or any such similar employee benefit plan or arrangement that any of the Debtors maintained prior to the Petition Date;
provided
,
however
, that the term “Benefit Plan” does not include the WaMu Savings Plan (#002) and does not include any plan policy, or arrangement transferred to JPMC pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.43
BKK Group
:
Collectively, the BKK Joint Defense Group, as defined in the BKK Settlement Agreement, Atlantic Richfield Corporation, THUMS Long Beach Company, Shell Exploration & Production Company, Shell Oil Company and Bayer CropScience Inc.
1.44
BKK Liabilities
:
Any and all liabilities and obligations of the WMI Entities (other than WMI Rainier LLC) for remediation or clean-up costs and expenses (and
excluding tort and tort related liabilities, if any) in excess of applicable and available insurance arising from or relating to (i) the BKK Litigation, (ii) the Amended Consent Decree, dated March 6, 2006, entered in connection therewith, and (iii) that certain Amended and Restated Joint Defense, Privilege and Confidentiality Agreement, dated as of February 28, 2005, by and among the BKK Joint Defense Group, as defined therein.
1.45
BKK Litigation
:
That certain litigation styled
California Department of Toxic Substances Control, et al.
v.
American Honda Motor Co., Inc., et al.
, No. CV05-7746 CAS (JWJx), currently pending in the United States District Court for the Central District of California.
1.46
BKK Proofs of Claim
:
The BKK Liabilities-related proofs of claim filed against the Debtors and the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates numbered 2138, 2213, 2233, 2405, 2467, 2693 and 3148.
1.47
BKK Settlement Agreement
:
That certain Settlement Agreement, dated as of December 3, 2010, by and among the Debtors, JPMC, the CDTSC and the BKK Group, setting forth the compromise and settlement between the parties.
1.48
Bond Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors set forth on Schedule 2.23 to the Global Settlement Agreement filed by any of the Bonding Companies, to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
1.49
Bond Indemnity
:
That certain General Agreement of Indemnity, as amended, dated as of June 14, 1999, executed and delivered by WMI, pursuant to which, among other things, the Bonds were to be issued and WMI agreed to pay all losses and expenses of the Bonding Companies associated therewith.
1.50
Bonding Companies
:
Safeco Insurance Company, its successor in interest, and such other insurance or bonding companies that issued Bonds pursuant to the Bond Indemnity.
1.51
Bonds
:
The bonds issued by the Bonding Companies on behalf of one or more of the Affiliated Banks or their Affiliates, each as identified on Exhibit “D”
to the Global Settlement Agreement, together with the numbers of the respective proofs of Claim that have been filed with the Bankruptcy Court in connection therewith.
1.52
Business Day
:
A day other than a Saturday, Sunday, or any other day on which commercial banking institutions in New York, New York are required or authorized to close by law or executive order.
1.53
Cash
:
Lawful currency of the United States, including, but not limited to, bank deposits, checks representing good funds, and other similar items.
1.54
Cash Equivalents
:
Equivalents of Cash in the form of readily marketable securities or instruments issued by a person other than the Debtors, including, without limitation, readily marketable direct obligations of, or obligations guaranteed by, the United States of America, commercial paper of domestic corporations carrying a Moody’s Rating of “A” or
better, or equivalent rating of any other nationally recognized rating service, or interest-bearing certificates of deposit or other similar obligations of domestic banks or other financial institutions having a shareholders’ equity or equivalent capital of not less than One Hundred Million Dollars ($100,000,000.00), having maturities of not more than one (1) year, at the then best generally available rates of interest for like amounts and like periods.
1.55
Causes of Action
:
All Claims, actions, causes of action, rights to payment, choses in action, suits, debts, dues, sums of money, accounts, reckonings, bonds, bills, specialties, covenants, contracts, controversies, agreements, promises, variances, trespasses, damages, judgments, remedies, rights of set-off, third-party claims, subrogation claims, contribution claims, reimbursement claims, indemnity claims, counterclaims, and cross claims (including, but not limited to, all claims for breach of fiduciary duty, negligence, malpractice, breach of contract, aiding and abetting, fraud, inducement, avoidance, recovery, subordination, and all Avoidance Actions) of any of the Debtors and/or their estates that are pending or may be asserted against any Entity on or after the date hereof, based in law or equity, including, but not limited to, under the Bankruptcy Code, whether known, unknown, reduced to judgment, not reduced to judgment, liquidated, unliquidated, fixed, contingent, matured, unmatured, disputed, undisputed, secured or unsecured and whether asserted or assertable directly or derivatively, in law, equity or otherwise and whether asserted or unasserted as of the date of entry of the Confirmation Order.
1.56
CCB-1 Common Securities
:
The common securities set forth on Exhibit “A” hereto.
1.57
CCB-1 Guarantees
:
The guarantees issued and delivered by WMI in accordance with the terms and conditions of the CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements, and set forth on Exhibit “A” hereto.
1.58
CCB-1 Guarantees Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to the CCB-1 Guarantees.
1.59
CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements
:
Those certain agreements titled “Guarantee of Washington Mutual, Inc.,” dated as of November 1, 2007, pursuant to which WMI guaranteed payment of the obligations and liabilities of WMB under certain agreements and related securities issued by the CCB Capital Trust IV, CCB Capital Trust V, CCB Capital Trust VII, and CCB Capital Trust VIII.
1.60
CCB-1 Preferred Securities
:
The preferred securities set forth on Exhibit “A” hereto.
1.61
CCB-1 Trustee
:
Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, or its duly appointed successor, solely in its capacity as trustee with regard to each of the CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements.
1.62
CCB-2 Common Securities
:
The common securities set forth on Exhibit “B” hereto.
1.63
CCB-2 Guarantees
:
The guarantees issued and delivered by WMI in accordance with the terms and conditions of the CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements, and set forth on Exhibit “B” hereto.
1.64
CCB-2 Guarantees Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to the CCB-2 Guarantees.
1.65
CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements
:
Those certain agreements titled “Guarantee of Washington Mutual, Inc.,” dated as of November 1, 2007, pursuant to which WMI guaranteed payment of the obligations and liabilities of WMB under certain agreements and related securities issued by the HFC Capital Trust I, CCB Capital Trust VI, and CCB Capital Trust IX.
1.66
CCB-2 Preferred Securities
:
The preferred securities set forth on Exhibit “B” hereto.
1.67
CCB-2 Trustees
:
Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, and Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, as Trustee, or their duly appointed successors, solely in their capacities as trustees with regard to each of the CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements.
1.68
CCB Releasees:
Collectively, and in the event that CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, CCB-2 Guarantees Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims with respect to each of the foregoing Claims are not paid in full in accordance with the provisions of the Plan, each holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim or an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, and any Affiliate of such Entities which, during the Chapter 11 Cases, owned, invested or acquired a CCB-1 Guarantees Claim or a CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, and each of their respective officers, directors, partners, equity investors, investment managers, management companies, members, employees and, solely to the extent as counsel to a holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim or an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
1.69
CDTSC
:
California Department of Toxic Substances Control.
1.70
Chapter 11 Cases
:
The jointly administered cases commenced by the Debtors styled as
In re Washington Mutual, Inc., et al.
and being jointly administered in the Bankruptcy Court, Case No. 08-12229 (MFW), under chapter 11 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.71
Claim
:
Any right to payment or performance, whether or not such right is reduced to judgment, liquidated, unliquidated, fixed, contingent, matured, unmatured, disputed, undisputed, legal, equitable, secured, or unsecured, known or unknown or asserted or unasserted; or any right to an equitable remedy for breach or enforcement of performance, whether or not such right to an equitable remedy is reduced to judgment, fixed, contingent, matured, unmatured, disputed, undisputed, secured, or unsecured, and all debts, suits, damages, rights, remedies, losses, liabilities, obligations, judgments, actions, causes of action, demands, or claims of every kind or nature whatsoever, in law, at equity, or otherwise.
1.72
Class
:
A category of holders of Claims or Equity Interests set forth in Article IV of the Plan.
1.73
Common Equity Interest
:
Collectively, (a) an Equity Interest represented by the 3,000,000,000 authorized shares of common stock of WMI, including, without limitation, one of the 1,704,958,913 shares of common stock of WMI issued and outstanding as of the Petition Date, or any interest or right to convert into such an Equity Interest or acquire any Equity Interest of WMI that was in existence immediately prior to or on the Petition Date or (b) a Claim, other than with respect to the Dime Warrants, which pursuant to a Final Order, has been subordinated to the level of Equity Interest in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise.
1.74
Common Stock Allotment
:
Ten Million (10,000,000) shares of Reorganized Common Stock, representing five percent (5%) of the issued and outstanding Reorganized Common Stock as of the Effective Date.
1.75
Confirmation Date
:
The date on which the Clerk of the Bankruptcy Court enters the Confirmation Order on the docket.
1.76
Confirmation Hearing
:
The hearing conducted by the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to section 1128(a) of the Bankruptcy Code to consider confirmation of the Plan, as such hearing may be adjourned or continued from time to time.
1.77
Confirmation Order
:
The order of the Bankruptcy Court confirming the Plan in accordance with section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, approving the compromise and settlement set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and directing the consummation of the transactions contemplated therein, which order shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Debtors, JPMC, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC;
provided
,
however
, that, with respect to provisions of the Confirmation Order that affect or otherwise relate to (a) the economic substance of the Plan, (b) the withdrawal and vacatur of the September Order, to the extent relating to the Standing Motion, and certain portions of the September Opinion, as set forth in Section 36.1(a)(11) of the Plan, and (c) the releases provided in Sections 41.5 and 41.6 the Plan, such order shall be in form and substance satisfactory to the foregoing parties and the WMI Noteholder Group as represented by White & Case LLP.
1.78
Convenience Claim
:
A Claim equal to or less than Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00) or greater than Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00) but, with respect to which, the holder thereof voluntarily reduces such Claim to Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00) on the Ballot;
provided
,
however
, that, for purposes of the Plan and the distributions to be made hereunder, “Convenience Claim” shall not include (i) an Administrative Expense Claim, (ii) a Priority Tax Claim, (iii) a Priority Non-Tax Claim, (iv) a Senior Notes Claim, (v) a Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, (vi) any JPMC Assumed Liability Claim, (vii) a WMB Vendor Claim, (viii) a WMI Vendor Claim, (ix) a CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, (x) a CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, (xi) a PIERS Claim, (xii) a WMB Notes Claim, (xiii) a Subordinated Claim, (xiv) a Trustee Claim, (xv) a Late-Filed Claim, and (xvi) any other Claim that is a component of a larger Claim, portions of which may be held by one or more holders of Allowed Claims.
1.79
Credit Facility
: The credit facility to be entered into by Reorganized WMI on the Effective Date providing for the funding of, among other things, working capital,
permitted acquisitions and permitted originations by Reorganized WMI, as referenced in Section 32.11 of the Plan and fully set forth in the Credit Agreement annexed hereto as Exhibit “C”.
1.80
Creditor
:
Any Entity holding a Claim against one or more of the Debtors or the Debtors’ estates or, pursuant to section 102(2) of the Bankruptcy Code, against property of the Debtors, including, without limitation, a Claim against either one of the Debtors or Debtors in Possession of a kind specified in section 502(g), 502(h), or 502(i) of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.81
Creditor Cash
:
On the Effective Date (or as soon as practicable thereafter when the Disbursing Agent is prepared to make its initial distribution pursuant to Section 31.1 of the Plan), the excess, if any, of (i) all Cash and Cash Equivalents to be distributed by the Disbursing Agent in accordance with the Plan over (ii) such amounts of Cash (a) reasonably determined by the Disbursing Agent as necessary to satisfy, in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Plan, Allowed Administrative Expense Claims, Allowed Priority Tax Claims (to the extent necessary), Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims, Allowed Convenience Claims, Trustee Claims, the fees and expenses owed to certain Creditors’ professionals pursuant to Section 41.18 herein, and fees and expenses of the Disbursing Agent as of the Effective Date, (b) necessary to fund the Liquidating Trust in accordance with Article XXVII of the Plan, as reasonably determined by the Debtors, (c) necessary to make pro rata distributions to holders of Disputed Claims as if such Disputed Claims were, at such time, Allowed Claims, (d) necessary to make pro rata distributions to holders of Administrative Expense Claims that have not yet been filed or Allowed as of the Effective Date, and (e) such other amounts reasonably determined by the Disbursing Agent (in consultation with the Liquidating Trustee) as necessary to fund the ongoing operations of the Liquidating Trust during the period from the Effective Date up to and including such later date as the Disbursing Agent shall reasonably determine;
provided
,
however
, that “Creditor Cash” shall include Cash in the Vendor Escrow only to the extent of WMI’s share of Cash remaining in such escrow after payment of Allowed WMI Vendor Claims.
1.82
Creditors’ Committee
:
The official committee of unsecured creditors appointed in the Chapter 11 Cases pursuant to section 1102(a) of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.83
Debtors
:
WMI and WMI Investment.
1.84
Debtors’ Claims
:
The proof of claim filed by the Debtors and each of WMI’s direct and indirect non-banking subsidiaries, on December 30, 2008, with the FDIC Receiver in connection with WMB’s receivership, asserting claims on behalf of the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates, and as asserted in the WMI Action.
1.85
Debtors in Possession
:
The Debtors as debtors in possession pursuant to sections 1101(1), 1107(a), and 1108 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.86
Dime Inc.
:
Dime Bancorp, Inc.
1.87
Dime Warrant Litigation
:
That certain litigation styled
Broadbill Investment Corp., et al.
v.
Washington Mutual, Inc.
, Adversary Pro. No. 10-50911 (MFW), currently pending in the Bankruptcy Court.
1.88
Dime Warrants
:
Those certain Litigation Tracking Warrants™ for shares of Dime Inc. common stock based on the value of the recovery in the Anchor Litigation, which warrants, as a result of the merger of Dime Inc. into WMI, are exchangeable for and into shares of Common Equity Interests in WMI upon certain conditions.
1.89
Disbursing Agent
:
With respect to (a) the initial distribution of (i) Cash pursuant to Article III of the Plan to holders of Allowed Administrative Expense Claims and, to the extent applicable, Allowed Priority Tax Claims as of the Effective Date, (ii) Cash to holders of Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims as of the Effective Date, (iii) Cash to holders of Allowed Convenience Claims, Allowed WMI Claims, Allowed Trustee Claims, and the fees and expenses owed to certain Creditors’ professionals pursuant to Section 41.18 hereof, in each case as of the Effective Date, (iv) Creditor Cash pursuant to Section 31.1 hereof, and (v) Runoff Notes, Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock to or for the benefit of holders of Allowed Claims and Equity Interests, as applicable, the Reorganized Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors’ designee and (b) with respect to all other distributions, the Liquidating Trustee or any Entity in its capacity as a disbursing agent. The Disbursing Agent also shall, at the election of JPMC, make the distribution to each Releasing REIT Trust Holder set forth in Article XXIII of the Plan from Cash or stock transferred by JPMC to the Disbursing Agent for that purpose. In their role as Disbursing Agent, the Reorganized Debtors shall hold Cash, Creditor Cash, Runoff Notes, Reorganized Common Stock and Liquidating Trust Interests as agent only, and shall not have any ownership interest in such cash, stock or interests.
1.90
Disclosure Statement
:
The disclosure statement relating to the Plan and approved by the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.91
Disclosure Statement Order
:
The Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court approving the Disclosure Statement in accordance with section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.92
Disputed Accounts
:
The amounts and intercompany balances identified with the account numbers set forth on Exhibit “E”
to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.93
Disputed Claim
:
A Claim against the Debtors, to the extent the allowance of such Claim is the subject of a timely objection or request for estimation in accordance with the Plan, the Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules, or the Confirmation Order, or is otherwise disputed by the Debtors in accordance with applicable law, and which objection, request for estimation, or dispute has not been withdrawn, with prejudice, or determined by a Final Order.
1.94
Disputed Equity Escrow
:
The escrow created on the Effective Date to hold such shares of Reorganized Common Stock allocable to any Disputed Equity Interest, including, but not limited to, Dime Warrants until such time as the Dime Warrant Litigation is determined, pursuant to a Final Order, or a compromise and settlement is approved by the Bankruptcy Court.
1.95
Disputed Equity Interest
:
An Equity Interest in or Claim against the Debtors (which Claim is or has been determined by the Bankruptcy Court to be subject to subordination to the level of Common Equity Interest in accordance with section 510 of the
Bankruptcy Code), including, without limitation, holders of restricted shares of Common Equity Interests, to the extent the allowance of such Equity Interest is the subject of a timely objection in accordance with the Plan, the Bankruptcy Code, the Bankruptcy Rules, or the Confirmation Order, or as otherwise disputed by the Debtors in accordance with applicable law, and which objection or dispute has not been withdrawn, with prejudice, or determined by a Final Order.
1.96
Distribution Record Date
:
The Effective Date.
1.97
Effective Date
:
The first (1st) Business Day on which (i) all of the conditions precedent to confirmation of the Plan specified in Section 36.1 of the Plan shall have been satisfied or waived, as provided in Section 36.2 of the Plan, and (ii) all the conditions precedent to the effectiveness of the Plan specified in Section 37.1 of the Plan shall have been satisfied or waived as provided in Section 37.2 of the Plan.
1.98
Entity
:
A Person, a corporation, a general partnership, a limited partnership, a limited liability company, a limited liability partnership, an association, a joint stock company, a joint venture, an estate, a trust, an unincorporated organization, a governmental unit or any subdivision thereof, including, without limitation, the office of the United States Trustee, or any other entity.
1.99
Equity Committee
:
The official committee of equity security holders appointed in the Chapter 11 Cases.
1.100
Equity Committee Adversary Proceeding
:
The adversary proceeding commenced in the Chapter 11 Cases by the Equity Committee, styled
Official Committee of Equity Security Holders
v.
Washington Mutual, Inc.
, Adversary Pro. No. 10-50731 (MFW).
1.101
Equity Committee Action to Compel
:
The action commenced by the Equity Committee on April 26, 2010 in the Thurston County Superior Court in the state of Washington seeking to compel WMI to convene and hold an annual shareholders’ meeting for the nomination and election of directors in accordance with Washington state law, which action was (i) removed to the United States Bankruptcy Court for the Western District of Washington on May 13, 2010, and (ii) transferred to the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to an order, dated June 21, 2010.
1.102
Equity Release Election Date
:
The date established by the Bankruptcy Court and set forth in the Disclosure Statement Order for the submission by holders of Preferred Equity Interests and Common Equity Interests of executed releases in accordance with Section 41.6 of the Plan in order to be entitled to receive distributions pursuant to the Plan.
1.103
Equity Interest
:
The
interest of any holder of one or more equity securities of WMI (including, without limitation, voting rights, if any, related to such equity securities) represented by issued and outstanding shares of common or preferred stock or other instrument evidencing a present ownership interest in WMI, whether or not transferable, or any option, warrant, or right, contractual or otherwise, to acquire any such interest, including, without limitation, unvested restricted stock.
1.104
Estate Claims
:
Any Claims and causes of action, regardless of whether asserted by the Debtors, the Liquidating Trust, the Creditors’ Committee or the Equity Committee, whether known, unknown, reduced to judgment, not reduced to judgment, liquidated or unliquidated, fixed, contingent, matured, unmatured, disputed, undisputed, secured or unsecured, and whether asserted or assertable directly or derivatively, in law, equity or otherwise, and whether asserted or unasserted as of the date of entry of the Confirmation Order, that (a) are based upon, relate to, or arise out of or in connection with, in whole or in part any act, omission, transaction, event or other circumstance relating to the Debtors and the Chapter 11 Cases, (b) exist on or prior to the Effective Date, and (c) are or may be asserted against (i) the AAOC Releasees with respect to any conduct or, (ii) any of (1) the PIERS Claims Releasees, (2) the Senior Notes Claims Releasees, (3) the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees and (4) the CCB Releasees with respect to (A) any and all Claims for equitable disallowance and equitable subordination, (B) any and all Claims with respect to any conduct undertaken during the period from and after the Petition Date and (C) any and all Claims with respect to conduct undertaken during the period prior to the Petition Date solely in their capacity as holders of any securities issued by the Debtors or their subsidiaries, including, without limitation, any claims for insider trading or violations of securities laws;
provided
,
however
, that, solely with respect to clause (ii) above, under no circumstances shall Estate Claims include (y) any Claims related to trading in the securities issued by the Debtors or their subsidiaries that are based on an allegation that such trading contributed to the failure of WMB or the commencement of the Chapter 11 Cases, including, without limitation, any Claims discussed on pages 330-338 of that certain Final Report of the Examiner, dated November 1, 2010, issued by Joshua R. Hochberg, appointed as Examiner in these Chapter 11 Cases, and (z) Preserved Avoidance Actions. For the avoidance of doubt, “Estate Claims” shall include, without limitation, (1) any claim relating to the trading of the Debtors’ securities during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the Effective Date and (2) any claim for equitable subordination or equitable disallowance.
1.105
FDIC Claim
:
The proof of Claim filed by the FDIC Receiver against the Debtors and the Debtors’ estates, in an unliquidated amount, which was assigned claim number 2140.
1.106
FDIC Corporate
:
The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, in its corporate capacity.
1.107
FDIC Receiver
:
The Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, in its capacity as receiver for WMB.
1.108
FDIC Stay Relief Motion
:
That certain Motion of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, as Receiver for Washington Mutual Bank, for an Order Modifying the Automatic Stay, filed by the FDIC Receiver in the Chapter 11 Cases, dated November 4, 2009 [Docket No. 1834], seeking relief from the automatic stay pursuant to section 362 of the Bankruptcy Code in order to exercise rights pursuant to Section 9.5 of the Purchase and Assumption Agreement.
1.109
Final Order
:
An order or judgment of a court of competent jurisdiction that has been entered on
the docket maintained by the clerk of such court and has not been reversed, vacated, or stayed and as to which (i) the time to appeal, petition for certiorari, or move
for a new trial, reargument, or rehearing has expired and as to which no appeal, petition for certiorari, or other proceedings for a new trial, reargument, or rehearing shall then be pending or, (ii) if an appeal, writ of certiorari, new trial, reargument, or rehearing thereof has been sought, (a) such order or judgment shall have been affirmed by the highest court to which such order was appealed, certiorari shall have been denied, or a new trial, reargument, or rehearing shall have been denied or resulted in no modification of such order and (b) the time to take any further appeal, petition for certiorari, or move for a new trial, reargument, or rehearing shall have expired;
provided
,
however
, that the possibility that a motion under Rule 60 of the Federal Rules of Civil Procedure, or any analogous rule under the Bankruptcy Rules or the Local Bankruptcy Rules, may be filed relating to such order shall not prevent such order from being a Final Order, except as provided in the Federal Rules of Appellate Procedure, the Bankruptcy Rules, or the Local Bankruptcy Rules.
1.110
Fixed Rate Notes
:
Those Senior Notes issued pursuant to the Senior Notes Indenture having a fixed rate of interest.
1.111
Floating Rate Notes
:
Those Senior Notes issued pursuant to the Senior Notes Indenture having a floating rate of interest.
1.112
FSB
:
Washington Mutual Bank fsb.
1.113
General Unsecured Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim against the Debtors other than a Senior Notes Claim, a Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, a JPMC Assumed Liability Claim, a WMB Vendor Claim, a WMI Vendor Claim, a CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, a CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, a PIERS Claim, a WMB Notes Claim, a Convenience Claim, a Subordinated Claim, a Late-Filed Claim, or a Trustee Claim, including, without limitation, any portion of a larger claim to the extent such portion does not relate to JPMC Assumed Liabilities.
1.114
Global Settlement Agreement
:
That certain Second Amended and Restated Settlement Agreement, dated as of February 7, 2011, by and among the Debtors, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate, and the Creditors’ Committee, as it has been and may be further amended, together with all exhibits annexed thereto, setting forth the compromise and settlement between the parties of, among other things, (i) the WMI Action, (ii) the JPMC Action, (iii) the Turnover Action, (iv) the Rule 2004 Inquiry, (v) the Debtors’ Claims, (vi) the JPMC Claims, (vii) the Bankruptcy Stay Motions and the appeals therefrom, (viii) the FDIC Claim, and (ix) the transfer of the Trust Preferred Securities and the consequent issuance of the REIT Series, and the sale, free and clear of all Liens, Claims and encumbrances, of the Plan Contribution Assets, a copy of which is annexed hereto as Exhibit “I”.
1.115
Guarantee Agreements
:
The CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements, CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements, and PIERS Guarantee Agreement.
1.116
Indentures
:
The Senior Notes Indenture, the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture, and the Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture.
1.117
Information Demands
:
Any and all subpoenas and other demands for documents, testimony and other information issued in connection with any current or future
pending or threatened legal proceedings (whether judicial, regulatory, administrative, arbitral, investigative, criminal, civil, or otherwise).
1.118
Intercompany Claim
:
A Claim against any of the WMI Entities held by another of the WMI Entities;
provided
,
however
, that “Intercompany Claim” does not include any PIERS Claim.
1.119
Intercompany Notes
:
Those certain intercompany notes set forth on Exhibit “V” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.120
IRC
:
The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended from time to time.
1.121
Intercreditor Interest Claim
:
A Claim for interest accrued in respect of an outstanding obligation or liability during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the date of final payment in full of such Claim, arising from contractual subordination rights and payable in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, as required by section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, calculated at the contract rate set forth in any agreement related to such Claim, compounded as provided in such agreement, provided that interest shall continue to accrue only on the then outstanding and unpaid obligation or liability that is the subject of such Claim.
1.122
IRS
:
The Internal Revenue Service, an agency of the United States Department of Treasury.
1.123
January Opinion
:
That certain Opinion, dated January 7, 2011, issued by the Bankruptcy Court with respect to, among other things, the confirmability of the Sixth Amended Plan and the solicitation of acceptances and releases in connection with the Sixth Amended Plan [Docket No. 6528].
1.124
JPMC
:
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
1.125
JPMC Action
:
The adversary proceeding commenced in the Chapter 11 Cases by JPMC, styled
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
v.
Washington Mutual, Inc., et al.
, Adversary Pro. No. 09-50551 (MFW).
1.126
JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim
:
Collectively, the JPMC Claims, which shall be deemed an Allowed Claim against WMI and shall be classified with and treated in the same manner as other Allowed General Unsecured Claims pursuant to the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that, in the sole and absolute discretion of the Debtors, for purposes of the Global Settlement Agreement, each Allowed Claim constituting the JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim may be counted as a separate claim for purposes of voting to accept or reject the Plan.
1.127
JPMC Assumed Liabilities
:
Collectively, and except as otherwise set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement, the obligations, undertakings and liabilities expressly assumed by JPMC and the Acquisition JPMC Entities in the Global Settlement Agreement, as follows: (a) to the extent payment or performance of such liability or obligation arising from or relating to the period from and after the effective date of the Global Settlement Agreement, all obligations, undertakings and liabilities relating to such payment or performance, and (b) to the
extent payment or performance of such liability or obligation was due during the period prior to the effective date of the Global Settlement Agreement, all obligations, undertakings and liabilities relating to such payment or performance to the extent of, and in the amounts of, the contractual obligations, undertakings and liabilities arising from or relating to such obligations, undertakings and liabilities;
provided
,
however
, that, for purposes of clause (b) above, or to the extent that the delay in payment or performance thereof was due to the actions or inactions, as the case may be, of the WMI Entities, “JPMC Assumed Liabilities” shall not include (i) any damages or compensation for any default, failure to perform or delay in the performance or payment of any obligations, undertakings, or liabilities in connection with such assets or agreements, whether or not provided for in any agreement, document, applicable provision of law or otherwise, (ii) any damages, losses, liabilities, claims or causes of action that are based in tort or on any statute, regulation, rule or principle of applicable or common law or promulgated by governmental or regulatory authority or agency, or that otherwise are extra contractual, (iii) any special, exemplary, consequential or punitive damages, or (iv) Taxes other than Taxes that JPMC has specifically agreed to pay pursuant to Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.128
JPMC Assumed Liability Claim
:
A Claim arising from or relating to a JPMC Assumed Liability.
1.129
JPMC Claims
:
The proofs of Claim filed by JPMC against the Debtors and the Debtors’ estates, as listed in Exhibit “A” to the Global Settlement Agreement and as resolved in accordance with Section 2.22
of the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.130
JPMC Entities
:
JPMC, collectively with those of its Affiliates that have filed proofs of Claims against the Debtors or that are Acquisition JPMC Entities.
1.131
JPMC Policies
:
All BOLI/COLI policies and the proceeds thereof set forth on Exhibit “N” to the Global Settlement Agreement, and all CCBI split dollar policies set forth on Exhibit “O” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.132
JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors and their chapter 11 estates set forth on Schedule 2.9(a) to the Global Settlement Agreement filed by a beneficiary of the JPMC Rabbi Trusts or the JPMC Policies, to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim and to the extent payable, in whole or in part, by the Debtors or the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates.
1.133
JPMC Rabbi Trusts
:
The “rabbi trusts” set forth on Exhibit “M” to the Global Settlement Agreement, including all assets therein.
1.134
Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture
:
That certain Indenture, dated as of April 30, 2001, as supplemented by that certain First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of April 30, 2001, between WMI and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
1.135
Lakeview Plan
:
That certain Retirement Income Plan for the Salaried Employees of Lakeview Savings Bank, which plan is intended to satisfy the tax requirements of Section 401 of the IRC and is sponsored by WMI.
1.136
Late-Filed Claim
:
A Claim against any of the Debtors or the Debtors’ estates, (i) proof of which was filed subsequent to the date designated by the Bankruptcy Court as the last date for filing such proof of claim against any such Debtor or such Debtors’ estate, but prior to the commencement of the Confirmation Hearing, and which is not merely amending or superseding a Claim that was filed prior to such date, and (ii) which has not been listed by such Debtor in its Schedules as liquidated in amount and not disputed or contingent.
1.137
Lien
:
Any charge against or interest in property to secure payment of a debt or performance of an obligation.
1.138
Liquidating Trust
:
The Entity to be created on or after the Confirmation Date in accordance with the provisions of Article XXVII hereof and the Liquidating Trust Agreement, for the benefit of (i) holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and Allowed Subordinated Claims, (ii) Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, and (iii) in certain circumstances, holders of Preferred Equity Interests, Dime Warrants and Common Equity Interests, in accordance with the terms and provisions of the Plan.
1.139
Liquidating Trust Agreement
:
The Liquidating Trust Agreement, substantially in the form contained in the Plan Supplement, pursuant to which the Liquidating Trustee shall manage and administer the Liquidating Trust Assets and distribute the proceeds thereof, if any.
1.140
Liquidating Trust Assets
:
From and after the Effective Date, all Assets of the Debtors (including, without limitation, certain Plan Contribution Assets and such Runoff Notes which are either (a) not distributed on the Effective Date or (b) placed into the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve) except (i) Cash to be distributed by the Reorganized Debtors as Disbursing Agent to holders of Allowed Administrative Expense Claims, Allowed Priority Tax Claims (to the extent applicable), Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims, Allowed Convenience Claims, Allowed WMI Vendor Claims, Allowed Trustee Claims, and the fees and expenses owed to certain Creditors’ professionals pursuant to Section 41.18 herein, in each case as of the Effective Date, (ii) Cash necessary to reimburse the Reorganized Debtors for fees and expenses incurred in connection with initial distributions made by the Reorganized Debtors as Disbursing Agent, (iii) the economic interest retained by the Debtors in any Litigation Proceeds pursuant to the respective elections for Reorganized Common Stock, and (iv) Creditor Cash on the Effective Date and the equity interests in each of WMI Investment (all the assets of which, for the avoidance of doubt, shall be contributed to the Liquidating Trust, including any Intercompany Claims), WMMRC and WMB.
1.141
Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries
:
The (i) holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims, (ii) Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, and (iii) in certain circumstances, holders of Allowed Subordinated Claims, Preferred Equity Interests, Dime Warrants and Common Equity Interests,
to the extent such holders have received Liquidating Trust Interests under the Plan (and any transferee thereof, and any subsequent transferee of any transferor of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Section 27.8 of the Plan).
1.142
Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve
:
Any Liquidating Trust Assets allocable to, or retained on account of, Disputed Claims, even if held in commingled accounts.
1.143
Liquidating Trustee
:
William C. Kosturos, as “Managing Trustee,” CSC Trust Company of Delaware, as “Resident Trustee,” and such additional trustee(s) as may be appointed by the Trust Advisory Board in accordance with applicable law.
1.144
Liquidating Trust Interests
:
The beneficial interests in the Liquidating Trust allocable to certain holders of Allowed Claims and Equity Interests (and any transferee thereof, and any subsequent transferee of any transferor of Liquidating Trust Interests) in accordance with the terms and conditions of Article XXVII of the Plan, including, without limitation, the BB Liquidating Trust Interests;
provided
,
however
, that (i) the BB Liquidating Trust Interests shall only be distributed to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non Filing WMB Senior Note Holders and (ii) for purposes of distributing Liquidating Trust Interests, “Pro Rata Share” shall not include the BB Liquidating Trust Interests.
1.145
Litigation Proceeds
: Recoveries, net of related legal fees and other expenses, on account of Causes of Action against third parties, including, without limitation, and subject to the release and exculpation provisions herein, professionals and other advisors engaged by the Debtors on or prior to the Petition Date, officers, directors and employees and relating to actions taken or inactions, as the case may be, during the period prior to the Petition Date,
but
, expressly excluding recoveries on account of any Avoidance Actions.
1.146
Litigation Proceeds Interest
: The interest of a holder of a Claim or Equity Interest in the Litigation Proceeds by virtue of such holder’s right to receive Liquidating Trust Interests pursuant to the Plan.
1.147
Local Bankruptcy Rules
:
The Local Rules of Bankruptcy Practice and Procedure of the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware, as amended from time to time.
1.148
Modified Plan
:
The Modified Sixth Amended Joint Plan of Affiliated Debtors Pursuant to Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, dated February 7, 2011, as amended.
1.149
Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder
:
A holder of a WMB Senior Note who did not timely file a proof of Claim against the Debtors.
1.150
Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders Election Form
:
The form distributed to each Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder in connection with the solicitation of acceptances with respect to the Sixth Amended Plan on which each such holder indicated, among other things, whether or not such holder elects to grant certain releases (as described therein and
in the Plan) in order to share in their Pro Rata Share of BB Liquidating Trust Interests, as set forth in Section 21.1(b) of the Plan.
1.151
Original Disclosure Statement Order
:
The Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court, dated October 21, 2010, (a) approving the adequacy of the information contained in the disclosure statement associated with the Sixth Amended Plan and (b) establishing, among other things, the solicitation procedures with respect to the Sixth Amended Plan, including, without limitation, procedures for holders of REIT Series to elect to receive distributions pursuant to the Sixth Amended Plan.
1.152
Other Benefit Plan Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors set forth on Schedule 2.9(c) to the Global Settlement Agreement filed by a beneficiary of a benefit plan listed on Exhibit “P” to the Global Settlement Agreement, to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
1.153
Other Subordinated Claim
:
A Claim determined pursuant to a Final Order to be subordinated in accordance with section 510(b), to the extent that such Claim related to the purchase or sale of a debt security (rather than an equity security), or 510(c) of the Bankruptcy Code;
provided
,
however
, that “Other Subordinated Claim” shall not include Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claims, Allowed WMB Vendor Claims, Allowed WMI Vendor Claims, Allowed Convenience Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Trustee Claims; and,
provided
,
further
, that, any Claim related to the purchase or sale of an equity security that is subordinated in accordance with section 510(b) of the Bankruptcy Code shall be classified with and receive the treatment provided for the Preferred Equity Interests or Common Equity Interests, as appropriate.
1.154
Penalty Claim
:
A Claim for a fine, penalty, forfeiture, or for multiple, exemplary, or punitive damages, or otherwise not predicated upon compensatory damages, that is subject to subordination in accordance with section 726(a)(4) of the Bankruptcy Code or otherwise, as determined pursuant to a Final Order.
1.155
Pension Plans
:
The WaMu Pension Plan and the Lakeview Plan.
1.156
Person
:
An
individual, partnership, corporation, limited liability company, cooperative, trust, unincorporated organization, association, joint venture, government, or agency or political subdivision thereof, or any other form of legal entity.
1.157
Petition Date
:
September 26, 2008, the date on which each of the respective Debtors filed its voluntary petition for relief commencing the Chapter 11 Cases.
1.158
PIERS Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or related to the PIERS Trust Agreement, the PIERS Guarantee Agreement and the Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture, on account of the PIERS Common Securities or the PIERS Preferred Securities.
1.159
PIERS Claims Releasees
:
Each holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed PIERS Claim, and any Affiliate of such Entities which, during the Chapter 11 Cases, owned, invested or acquired PIERS Claims, and each of their respective officers, directors,
partners, equity investors, investment managers, management companies, members, employees and, solely to the extent as counsel to a holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed PIERS Claim with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
1.160
PIERS Common Securities
:
The common securities set forth on Exhibit “D” hereto.
1.161
PIERS Guarantee Agreement
:
That certain Guarantee Agreement, dated as of April 30, 2001, as amended by that certain Amendment No. 1 to the Guarantee Agreement, dated as of May 16, 2001, between WMI, as Guarantor, and The Bank of New York, as Guarantee Trustee.
1.162
PIERS Preferred Securities
:
The preferred securities set forth on Exhibit “D” hereto.
1.163
PIERS Trust Agreement
:
That certain Amended and Restated Declaration of Trust, Washington Mutual Capital Trust 2001, dated as of April 30, 2001.
1.164
PIERS Trustee:
Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, solely in its capacity as successor in interest to The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., solely in its capacity as successor in interest to The Bank of New York, or its duly appointed successor, as Trustee and as Guarantee Trustee, solely in its capacity as trustee with regard to the Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture and the PIERS Guarantee Agreement.
1.165
Plan
:
This Seventh Amended Joint Plan of Affiliated Debtors Pursuant to Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, including, without limitation, the exhibits and schedules hereto, as the same may be amended, supplemented, or modified from time to time in accordance with the provisions of the Bankruptcy Code and the terms hereof.
1.166
Plan Contribution Assets
:
All right, title and interest of the WMI Entities, the JPMC Entities, and the FDIC Receiver and FDIC Corporate in and to the assets set forth on Exhibit “G” to the Global Settlement Agreement, which shall be sold, pursuant to the Plan and as required by the Global Settlement Agreement, free and clear of all Liens, Claims and encumbrances.
1.167
Plan Supplement
:
A separate volume, to be filed with the clerk of the Bankruptcy Court, including, among other documents, forms of (i) the Liquidating Trust Agreement, (ii) the Reorganized Debtors By-laws, if applicable, (iii) (A) the Reorganized Debtors’ Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation and (B) the Reorganized Debtors’ Certificates of Incorporation, if applicable, (iv) a schedule of executory contracts and unexpired leases to be assumed or assumed and assigned pursuant to Section 34.1 of the Plan, (v) a registration rights agreement (if any) with respect to the Reorganized Common Stock, (vi) the documents governing the Runoff Notes and (vii) the documents associated with the Credit Facility (other than the Credit Agreement annexed hereto as Exhibit “C”), which, in each case, shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC;
provided
,
however
, that, with respect to documents associated with the Credit Facility, such documents shall be in form and substance satisfactory to all such parties. The Plan Supplement (containing drafts or final versions of the foregoing documents)
shall be filed with the clerk of the Bankruptcy Court as soon as practicable (but in no event later than fifteen (15) days) prior to the Ballot Date, or on such other date as the Bankruptcy Court establishes. The Plan Supplement shall be deemed incorporated into and part of the Plan as if set forth herein in full.
1.168
Plan Support Agreement
:
That certain Plan Support Agreement, dated as of October 6, 2010, by and among the Debtors and the Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders.
1.169
Postpetition Interest Claim
:
A Claim against any of the Debtors or the Debtors’ estates for interest accrued in respect of an outstanding obligation or liability that is the subject of an Allowed Claim during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the date of final payment in full of such Allowed Claim, calculated at the federal judgment rate of 1.95%, the rate as in effect on the Petition Date, compounded annually, provided that interest shall continue to accrue only on the then outstanding and unpaid obligation or liability, including any postpetition interest compounded thereon, that is the subject of an Allowed Claim.
1.170
Preferred Equity Interest
:
An Equity Interest represented by an issued and outstanding share of preferred stock of WMI prior to or on the Petition Date, including, without limitation, those certain (i) Series K Perpetual Non-Cumulative Floating Rate Preferred Stock, (ii) Series R Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock, and (iii) the REIT Series.
1.171
Preserved Avoidance Actions
:
An Avoidance Action that is, as of December 12, 2011, preserved by (a) a tolling agreement between the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and/or the Debtors, on the one hand, and the target of such Avoidance Action, on the other hand, or (b) the litigation commenced by the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and/or the Debtors against the target of any such Avoidance Action.
1.172
Priority Non-Tax Claim
:
A Claim entitled to priority in payment pursuant to section 507(a)(4), 507(a)(5), 507(a)(7), or 507(a)(9) of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.173
Priority Tax Claim
:
A Claim of a governmental unit against the Debtors of the kind entitled to priority in payment pursuant to sections 502(i) and 507(a)(8) of the Bankruptcy Code.
1.174
Privileges
:
All attorney-client privileges, work product protections, and other immunities or protections from disclosure held by the Debtors.
1.175
Pro Rata Share
:
With respect to Allowed Claims (i) within the same Class, the proportion that an Allowed Claim bears to the sum of all Allowed Claims within such Class, and (ii) among all Classes, the proportion that a Class of Allowed Claims bears to the sum of all Allowed Claims, without regard to subordination;
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, for purposes of distributing Creditor Cash and Liquidating Trust Interests, “Pro Rata Share” shall not include Administrative Expense Claims, Priority Tax Claims, Priority Non-Tax Claims, JPMC Assumed Liability Claims, WMB Vendor Claims, WMI Vendor Claims, WMB Senior Notes Claims,
Convenience Claims, Subordinated Claims and Trustee Claims. With respect to redistributions of Liquidating Trust Interests to holders of Allowed Subordinated Claims, the proportion that an Allowed Subordinated Claim bears to the sum of all Allowed
Subordinated Claims; and,
provided
,
further
, that, with respect to distribution of BB Liquidating Trust Interests to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, “Pro Rata Share” shall mean the proportion that an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim or the aggregate face amount of WMB Senior Notes, plus interest accrued to the Petition Date, held by an Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder bears to the aggregate of (i) all Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and (ii) the aggregate face amount of WMB Senior Notes, plus interest accrued to the Petition Date, held by Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders; and,
provided
,
further
, that, with respect to any elections to receive Reorganized Common Stock, “Pro Rata Share” shall mean the proportion of the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes which a holder may be entitled to receive and for which such holder elected to be tendered bears to the sum of the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes which all holders may be entitled to receive and for which all holders elected to be tendered pursuant to Sections 6.2(b), 7.2(b), 16.1(b(ii), 18.2(b), 19.2(b) and 20.2 of the Plan. With respect to Equity Interests, “Pro Rata Share” shall mean (i) within the same Class, the proportion that an Equity Interest bears to the sum of all Equity Interests within such Class, and (ii) among all Classes, the proportion that a Class of Equity Interests bears to the sum of all Equity Interests;
provided
,
however
, that, with respect to distributions of Reorganized Common Stock, “Pro Rata Share” shall mean (i) the proportion that an Equity Interest within the Class of Preferred Equity Interest, entitled to receive distributions in accordance with the provisions of Sections 23.1 and 41.6 of the Plan, bears to the sum of all Equity Interests in such Class which are entitled to receive distributions in accordance with the provisions of Sections 23.1 and 41.6 of the Plan
or (ii) the proportion that an Equity Interest within the Class of either the Dime Warrants (if determined pursuant to a Final Order to be an Equity Interest or a Claim subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests pursuant to section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code) or Common Equity Interests, entitled to receive distributions in accordance with the provisions of Sections 24.1, 25.1 and 41.6 of the Plan bears to the sum of all Equity Interests in such classes which are entitled to receive distributions in accordance with the provisions of Sections 24.1, 25.1 and 41.6 of the Plan.
1.176
Purchase and Assumption Agreement
:
That certain Purchase and Assumption Agreement, Whole Bank, dated September 25, 2008, between the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate, and JPMC, as amended, modified or supplemented prior to the date hereof.
1.177
Qualified Plan Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors and their chapter 11 estates set forth on Schedule 2.10 to the Global Settlement Agreement filed by any Person arising from or relating to the WaMu Pension Plan or the Lakeview Plan, to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
1.178
Receivership
:
WMB’s receivership.
1.179
Registry Funds
:
The funds deposited into the registry of the Bankruptcy Court with respect to the American Savings Litigation.
1.180
REIT Series
:
Those certain (i) Series I Perpetual Non-Cumulative Fixed-to-Floating Preferred Stock, (ii) Series J Perpetual Non-Cumulative Fixed Rate Preferred Stock, (iii) Series L Perpetual Non-Cumulative Fixed-to-Floating Rate Preferred Stock, (iv) Series M
Perpetual Non- Cumulative Fixed-to-Floating Rate Preferred Stock, and (v) Series N Perpetual Non-Cumulative Fixed-to-Floating Rate Preferred Stock.
1.181
Related Actions
:
The “Related Actions,” as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.182
Related Persons
:
With respect to any Entity, its predecessors, successors and assigns (whether by operation of law or otherwise) and their respective present Affiliates and each of their respective current and former members, partners, equity holders, officers, directors, employees, managers, shareholders (other than holders of Equity Interests of WMI), partners, financial advisors, attorneys, accountants, investment bankers, consultants, agents and professionals (including, without limitation, any and all professionals retained by WMI or the Creditors’ Committee in the Chapter 11 Cases either (a) pursuant to an order of the Bankruptcy Court other than ordinary course professionals or (b) as set forth on Schedule 3.1(a) to the Global Settlement Agreement), or other representatives, nominees or investment managers, each acting in such capacity, and any Entity claiming by or through any of them (including their respective officers, directors, managers, shareholders, partners, employees, members and professionals), but, under all circumstances, excluding the “Excluded Parties,” as such term is defined in the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.183
Released Claims
:
Collectively, (a) with respect to those Entities party to the Global Settlement Agreement, claims and causes of action released thereunder, (b) claims or causes of action that arise in, relate to or have been or could have been asserted (i) in the Chapter 11 Cases, the Receivership or the Related Actions, or (ii) by the Debtors (with respect to releases given by the Debtors) and by Creditors relating to Claims or holders of Equity Interests relating to Equity Interests, as the case may be, they have against the Debtors (with respect to releases given by Creditors or holders of Equity Interests, as the case may be), and (c) claims that otherwise arise from or relate to the Receivership, the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, the 363 Sale and Settlement, as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement, the Plan, the Global Settlement Agreement, and the negotiations and compromises set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and the Plan, including, without limitation, in connection with or related to any of the Debtors, the Affiliated Banks, and their respective subsidiaries, assets, liabilities, operations, property or estates, the assets to be received by JPMC pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement, the Debtors’ Claims, the JPMC Claims, the FDIC Claim, the WMI/WMB Intercompany Claims, any intercompany claims on the books of WMI or WMB related to the WaMu Pension Plan or the Lakeview Plan, or the Trust Preferred Securities (including, without limitation, the creation of the Trust Preferred Securities, the financing associated therewith, the requested assignment of the Trust Preferred Securities by the Office of Thrift Supervision and the transfer and the asserted assignment of the Trust Preferred Securities subsequent thereto);
provided
,
however
, that “Released Claims” does not include (1) any and all claims that the JPMC Entities, the Receivership, the FDIC Receiver and the FDIC Corporate are entitled to assert against each other or any other defenses thereto pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, which claims and defenses shall continue to be governed by the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, (2) any and all claims held by Entities against WMB, the Receivership and the FDIC Receiver solely with respect to the Receivership, and (3) subject to the exculpation provisions set forth in the Plan, any avoidance action or claim objection regarding an Excluded Party or the WMI Entities, WMB, each of the Debtors’ estates, the Reorganized Debtors and
their respective Related Persons; and,
provided
,
further
, that “Released Claims” is not intended to release, nor shall it have the effect of releasing, any party from the performance of its obligations in accordance with the Confirmation Order or the Plan.
1.184
Released Parties
:
Collectively, each of the Debtors, WMB, each of the Debtors’ estates, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver and FDIC Corporate, and the Related Persons of each of the JPMC Entities, FDIC Corporate and the FDIC Receiver.
1.185
Released Third Party Causes of Action
:
Any Claims and causes of action, regardless of whether asserted by any of the parties executing and delivering a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan, whether known, unknown, reduced to judgment, not reduced to judgment, liquidated or unliquidated, fixed, contingent, matured, unmatured, disputed, undisputed, secured or unsecured, and whether asserted or assertable directly or derivatively, in law, equity or otherwise, and whether asserted or unasserted as of the date of entry of the Confirmation Order, that are based upon, relate to, or arise out of or in connection with, in whole or in part any act, omission, transaction, event or other circumstance relating to the Debtors and the Chapter 11 Cases and taking place or existing on or prior to the Effective Date, including, without limitation, (a) any such claim relating to the trading of the Debtors’ securities during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the Effective Date and (b) any claim for equitable subordination or equitable disallowance with respect to any Claims held by (i) the AAOC Releasees, (ii) the Senior Notes Claims Releasees, (iii) the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees, (iv) the PIERS Claims Releasees, and (v) the CCB Releasees against the Debtors or the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates.
1.186
Releasing REIT Trust Holder
:
A holder of REIT Series that (i) voted to accept the Sixth Amended Plan and, to the extent such holder is a holder of REIT Series as of the Voting Record Date with respect to solicitation of acceptances to the Plan, votes to accept the Plan and grants the releases set forth in Section 41.6 of the Plan, (ii) did not interpose an objection to confirmation of the Sixth Amended Plan as it related to the REIT Series or the Trust Preferred Securities, (iii) with respect to the Plan, does not otherwise interpose an objection to confirmation of the Plan as it relates to the REIT Series or the Trust Preferred Securities, (iv) acknowledges that JPMC or its designee is the sole legal, equitable and beneficial owner of the Trust Preferred Securities for all purposes and that such REIT Series holder has no legal, equitable or beneficial interest in the Trust Preferred Securities, and (v) in connection with the solicitation of acceptances to the Sixth Amended Plan, executed and delivered the release of claims against the “Releasees”, as set forth in Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement and as incorporated into the Ballots distributed to holders of REIT Series.
1.187
Remaining Postpetition Interest Claim
:
A Claim by a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim with respect to Floating Rate Notes against any of the Debtors or the Debtors’ estates for interest accrued during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the date of final payment of such Claim, in an amount equal to (a) such holder’s Postpetition Interest Claim
minus
(b) such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim, all as set forth in the Subordination Model annexed hereto as Exhibit “H”.
1.188
Reorganized Common Stock
:
Subject to the provisions of Section 31.1(d) hereof, the Two Hundred Million (200,000,000) shares of duly authorized common stock
of Reorganized WMI to be issued as of the Effective Date, with a par value of $0.00001 per share.
1.189
Reorganized Debtors
:
The Debtors from and after the Effective Date.
1.190
Reorganized Debtors By-Laws
:
The respective by-laws of the Reorganized Debtors, which by-laws shall be in substantially the form included in the Plan Supplement and shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC.
1.191
Reorganized Debtors Certificates of Incorporation
:
The respective Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation and Certificates of Incorporation, if applicable, of the Reorganized Debtors, which certificates shall be in substantially the form included in the Plan Supplement and shall be in form and substance reasonably satisfactory to the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC.
1.192
Reorganized WMI
:
WMI, on and after the Effective Date, which shall include One Hundred Percent (100%) of the equity interests of WMI Investment, WMMRC and, subject to the abandonment of the equity interests of WMB, WMB.
1.193
Rule 2004 Inquiry
:
That certain discovery authorized by the Bankruptcy Court and conducted by the Debtors, pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 2004, in order to facilitate the Debtors’ inquiry into the existence of potential additional claims and causes of action of the Debtors and the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates against JPMC.
1.194
Rule 2019 Appeal
:
The appeal filed on December 14, 2009 by the WMI Noteholders Group from the Bankruptcy Court order, dated December 2, 2009, granting JPMC’s Motion to Compel the Washington Mutual, Inc. Noteholders Group to Comply with Rule 2019 of the Federal Rules of Bankruptcy.
1.195
Runoff Indenture
:
That certain Senior First Lien Notes Indenture, dated as of the Effective Date, to be executed and delivered in connection with the issuance of the Runoff Notes, substantially in the form annexed hereto as Exhibit “J”.
1.196
Runoff Notes
:
The two series of non-recourse promissory notes to be issued on the Effective Date by Reorganized WMI and either (a) distributed to Entities electing distributions of Runoff Notes in lieu of Creditor Cash on the Effective Date or (b) to the extent unavailable for distribution to Entities in accordance with such elections, constituting Liquidating Trust Assets, in the aggregate original principal amount of One Hundred Forty Million Dollars ($140,000,000.00), subject to the elections and reductions set forth in the Plan, maturing on the eighteenth (18th) anniversary of the Effective Date, bearing interest at the rate of thirteen percent (13%) per annum (payable in cash to the extent available and payable in kind through capitalization of accrued interest at the rate of thirteen percent (13%) per annum to the extent cash is unavailable), and, to the extent permitted by applicable law and upon regulatory approval with respect thereto, the repayment thereof secured by, and having a specified priority in right of payment in, as and to (1) a securities or deposit account into which Reorganized WMI shall deposit distributions of Runoff Proceeds and (2) the equity interest in either WMMRC or
such other Entity as holds the Trusts and their assets, to the extent a valid and perfected lien has been granted therein, all as more fully described in the Runoff Indenture.
1.197
Runoff Proceeds
:
Collectively, (a) all net premiums, reinsurance recoverables, net revenue resulting from commutation of insurance contracts, net interest income, reserve releases and other revenues derived from the reinsurance contracts, investments and other assets of the Trusts,
minus
, without duplication, (y) the reasonable and necessary costs and expenses of the Trusts and WMMRC (or its successor in interest upon closure of WMMRC’s book of insurance) (including, but not limited to, general and administrative expenses, audit fees, required regulatory capital contributions (which capital contributions will be added back to the Runoff Proceeds if applicable regulations permit such distribution thereof), expenses of regulatory compliance, including all costs associated with the closure of WMMRC’s book of insurance, expenses of administering the Runoff Indenture and Taxes) attributable to the administration of the Trusts or the assets thereof, and the collection of premiums and/or management of investments in connection therewith, which expenses shall include reasonable and customary expenses attributable to the foregoing paid under any administrative services agreement, investment management agreement or similar agreement, and (z) the claims paid for covered losses,
plus
(b) the proceeds from the foregoing received by WMMRC (or its successor in interest upon closure of WMMRC’s book of insurance) or Reorganized WMI in cash, securities and/or other property from any sale, liquidation, merger or other disposition in respect of WMMRC (or its successor in interest upon closure of WMMRC’s book of insurance) or its interests in the Trusts or the assets thereof. The inclusion of clause (b) of this Section 1.197 shall not be construed as a consent to any sale, liquidation, merger or other disposition or waiver of compliance with any covenant related thereto. For the avoidance of doubt, to the extent that WMI or WMMRC pays any such cost, capital contribution or expense described in clause (y), payment by WMI or WMMRC will be deemed a cost or expense of the Trusts.
1.198
Runoff Threshold
:
Runoff Notes in the original principal amount of Ten Million Dollars ($10,000,000.00).
1.199
Schedules
:
Collectively, the schedules of assets and liabilities, schedules of current income and expenditures, schedules of executory contracts and unexpired leases, and statements of financial affairs filed by the Debtors pursuant to section 521 of the Bankruptcy Code, Bankruptcy Rule 1007, and the Official Bankruptcy Forms in the Chapter 11 Cases, as may have been amended or supplemented through the Confirmation Date pursuant to Bankruptcy Rule 1007.
1.200
Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claim
:
A WMB Notes Claim, to the extent determined pursuant to a Final Order to be subordinated in accordance with section 510(b) of the Bankruptcy Code;
provided
,
however
, that, for all purposes, and for the avoidance of doubt, to the extent that a holder of an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim receives a distribution pursuant to the Plan, such holder shall be deemed to have released any and all Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims that such holder may have.
1.201
Securities Litigations
:
Collectively, the litigations styled (i) South Ferry LP #2, Individually and on Behalf of All Others Similarly Situated v. Killinger, Case No. C04-1599 (MJP), and (ii) Boilermakers National Annuity Trust Fund, on Behalf of Itself and All
Others Similarly Situated v. WAMU Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series AR1, et al., Case No. C09-0051 (MJP), each pending in the United States District Court for the Western District of Washington.
1.202
Senior Notes
:
The promissory notes and debentures issued and delivered by WMI in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Senior Notes Indenture and set forth on Exhibit “E” hereto.
1.203
Senior Notes Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to the Senior Notes.
1.204
Senior Notes Claims Releasees
:
Each holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim, and any Affiliate of such Entities which, during the Chapter 11 Cases, owned, invested or acquired Senior Notes Claims, and each of their respective officers, directors, partners, equity investors, investment managers, management companies, members, employees and, solely to the extent as counsel to a holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
1.205
Senior Notes Indenture
:
That certain Senior Debt Securities Indenture, dated as of August 10, 1999, as supplemented by that certain First Supplemental Indenture and Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 1, 2002 and November 20, 2002, respectively, between WMI and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
1.206
Senior Notes Indenture Trustee
:
The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., solely in its capacity as successor in interest to The Bank of New York, solely in its capacity as successor in interest to Harris Trust and Savings Bank, as Trustee, or its duly appointed successor, solely in its capacity as indenture trustee with regard to the Senior Notes Indenture.
1.207
Senior Notes Release Consideration
:
The consideration to be contributed by holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims from distributions received, in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.1 and 31.1 of the Plan, to Reorganized WMI in exchange for the releases executed and delivered to the Senior Notes Claims Releasees in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan.
1.208
Senior Subordinated Notes
:
The promissory notes and debentures issued and delivered by WMI in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture and set forth on Exhibit “F” hereto.
1.209
Senior Subordinated Notes Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to the Senior Subordinated Notes.
1.210
Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees
:
Each holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, and any Affiliate of such Entities which, during the Chapter 11 Cases, owned, invested or acquired a Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, and each of their respective officers, directors, partners, equity investors,
investment managers, management companies, members, employees and, solely to the extent as counsel to a holder of record or beneficial owner of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
1.211
Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture
:
That certain Subordinated Debt Securities Indenture, dated as of April 4, 2000, as supplemented by that certain First Supplemental Indenture and Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of August 1, 2002 and March 16, 2004, respectively, between WMI and The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., as Trustee.
1.212
Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee
:
Law Debenture Trust Company of New York, solely in its capacity as successor in interest to The Bank of New York Mellon Trust Company, N.A., solely in its capacity as successor in interest to The Bank of New York, solely in its capacity as successor in interest to Harris Trust and Savings Bank, as Trustee, or its duly appointed successor, solely in its capacity as indenture trustee with regard to the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture.
1.213
Senior Subordinated Notes Release Consideration
:
The consideration to be contributed by holders of Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims from distributions received, in accordance with the provisions of Sections 7.1 and 31.1 of the Plan, to Reorganized WMI in exchange for the releases executed and delivered to the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releases in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan.
1.214
September Opinion
:
That certain Opinion, dated September 13, 2011, issued by the Bankruptcy Court with respect to, among other things, the confirmability of the Modified Plan [Docket No. 8612].
1.215
September Order
:
That certain order, dated September 13, 2011, issued by the Bankruptcy Court in connection with the September Opinion [Docket No. 8613].
1.216
Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders
:
Each of the signatories, other than the Debtors, to the Plan Support Agreement.
1.217
Sixth Amended Plan
: The Sixth Amended Joint Plan of Affiliated Debtors Pursuant to Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code, dated October 6, 2010, as amended.
1.218
Standing Motion
:
That certain Motion for an Order Authorizing the Official Committee of Equity Security Holders to Commence and Prosecute Certain Claims of Debtors’ Estates, dated July 12, 2011 [Docket. No. 8179].
1.219
Stock Trading Order
:
That certain Final Order Pursuant to Sections 105(a) and 362 of the Bankruptcy Code Establishing Notification Procedures and Approving Restrictions on Certain Transfers of Interests in the Debtors’ Estates, dated November 18, 2008, entered by the Bankruptcy Court in the Chapter 11 Cases [Docket No. 315].
1.220
Subordinated Claim
:
A Penalty Claim, an Other Subordinated Claim, or a Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claim.
1.221
Subordination Model
:
The model developed by Alvarez & Marsal LLC for the Debtors, a copy of which is attached hereto as Exhibit “H,” which implements the Debtors’ interpretation of the respective subordination provisions in the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture, CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements, CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements, Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture and PIERS Guarantee Agreement.
1.222
Tax Authority
:
A federal, state, local, or foreign government, or agency, instrumentality, or employee thereof, court, or other body (if any) charged with the administration of any law relating to Taxes.
1.223
Taxes
:
All (i) federal, state, local, or foreign taxes, including, without limitation, all net income, alternative minimum, net worth or gross receipts, capital, value added, franchise, profits, and estimated taxes, and (ii) interest, penalties, fines, additions to tax or additional amounts imposed by any Tax Authority or paid in connection with any item described in clause (i) hereof.
1.224
Tax Refunds
:
To the extent of the Debtors’ rights, title and interest therein in whatever capacity, all refunds of Taxes of the Debtors and any consolidated, combined or unitary tax group of which the Debtors are members for taxable periods ended on or before December 31, 2009, including all of the Debtors’ rights, title and interest in and with respect to any “Net Tax Refunds” as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement, including, without limitation, any interest received with respect to such refunds.
1.225
Tax Return
:
A
return, declaration, form, election letter, report, statement, estimate, information return, or other information filed or required to be filed with respect to any Taxes, including any schedule or attachment thereto or amendment thereof, including any claim for a Tax Refund.
1.226
Texas Litigation
:
That certain litigation styled
American National Insurance Company
v.
FDIC
, Case No. 09-1743 (RMC), with respect to which the United States District Court for the District of Columbia entered an order granting motions to dismiss filed by JPMC and the FDIC Receiver.
1.227
Tranquility
:
Tranquility Master Fund, Ltd.
1.228
Tranquility Claim
:
The proof of claim filed by Tranquility, assigned claim number 2206 by the Debtors’ claims agent, or any subsequent amendments or modifications thereto, including, but not limited to, the asserted proof of claim filed by Tranquility on November 30, 2010.
1.229
Transferred Intellectual Property
:
The intellectual property listed on Exhibit “W” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.230
Treasury Regulations
:
The United States Department of Treasury regulations promulgated under the IRC.
1.231
Trust Advisory Board
:
The trust advisory board provided for in the Liquidating Trust Agreement, which board shall (i) be initially comprised of seven (7) members:
three (3) members selected solely by the Creditors’ Committee, three (3) members selected solely by the Equity Committee and one (1) member selected by the Creditors’ Committee and approved by the Equity Committee, which approval shall not be unreasonably withheld, and (ii) have an oversight function with respect to the Liquidating Trust, and the composition of which may change only in accordance with the provisions of the Liquidating Trust Agreement.
1.232
Trustee Claims
:
The Claims of the Senior Notes Indenture Trustee, Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee, CCB-1 Trustee, CCB-2 Trustees, PIERS Trustee, and Trust Preferred Trustees, pursuant to the Senior Notes Indenture, Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture, CCB-1 Guarantee Agreements, CCB-2 Guarantee Agreements, Junior Subordinated Notes Indenture and PIERS Guarantee Agreement, and Trust Preferred Securities documents, respectively, for indemnification and for reasonable fees and expenses, including, without limitation, reasonable attorneys’ fees and expenses, which claims shall be satisfied in accordance with Section 31.12 of the Plan or such other order of the Bankruptcy Court.
1.233
Trustee Distribution Expenses
:
The reasonable, direct, out-of-pocket costs and expenses incurred by the Trustees in connection with making distributions pursuant to the Plan.
1.234
Trustees
:
The Senior Notes Indenture Trustee, Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee, CCB-1 Trustee, CCB-2 Trustees, PIERS Trustee, and Trust Preferred Trustees.
1.235
Trust Preferred Securities
:
Collectively, those certain (i) Washington Mutual Preferred (Cayman) I Ltd. 7.25% Perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Securities, Series A-1, (ii) Washington Mutual Preferred (Cayman) I Ltd. 7.25% Perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Securities, Series A-2, (iii) Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust I Fixed-to-Floating Rate Perpetual Non-Cumulative Trust Securities, (iv) Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust II Fixed-to-Floating Rate Perpetual Non-Cumulative Trust Securities, (v) Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust III Fixed-to-Floating Rate Perpetual Non-Cumulative Trust Securities, and (vi) Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust IV Fixed-to-Floating Rate Perpetual Non-Cumulative Trust Securities.
1.236
Trust Preferred Trustees
:
Wilmington Trust Company, solely in its capacity as Property Trustee, Delaware Trustee, Transfer Agent and Registrar for Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust I, Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust II, Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust III and Washington Mutual Preferred Funding Trust IV, Wilmington Trust (Cayman) Ltd., solely in its capacity as Preferred Securities Paying Agent, Securities Registrar and Transfer Agent for Washington Mutual Preferred Funding (Cayman) I, Ltd. and Maples Finance Limited as Original Trustee for Washington Mutual Preferred Funding (Cayman) I Ltd.
1.237
Trusts
:
Collectively, (a) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. United Guaranty Residential Insurance Company Reinsurance Agreement (Acct. No. x6401); (b) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. Genworth Reinsurance Co. Trust Agreement (Acct. No. x6403); (c) Mortgage Guaranty Insurance Corporation/WM MTG Reinsurance Co. Trust; (Acct. No. x2400); (d) Reinsurance Escrow Agreement among WM Mortgage Reinsurance Co. PMI Mortgage
Insurance Company and US Bank (Acct. No. x6404); (e) Radian Guaranty Inc. and WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company Agreement, dated March 27, 2001 (Acct. No. x5700); (f) Home Loan Reinsurance Co. Republic Mortgage Co. Reinsurance Agreement, dated December 14, 1998 (Acct. No. x6402); (g) Washington Mutual Custody Account (Acct. No. x6406); and (h) WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company Inc. (Acct. No. x4202).
1.238
Turnover Action
:
The adversary proceeding commenced in the Chapter 11 Cases by the Debtors, styled
Washington Mutual, Inc., et al.
v.
JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.
, Adversary Pro. No. 09-50934 (MFW).
1.239
Unidentified Intellectual Property
:
The trademarks, patents, domain names and copyrighted materials (whether or not the subject of registration) that were used by WMB by license or otherwise, or were available for WMB’s use, prior to the Petition Date, but are not listed on Exhibits “W” or “Y” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.240
Unsecured Claim
:
A Claim against the Debtors, other than an Administrative Expense Claim, a Priority Tax Claim, a Priority Non-Tax Claim, a Convenience Claim, a Trustee Claim or a Subordinated Claim;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event that the Bankruptcy Court determines, pursuant to a Final Order, that the Dime Warrants constitute Claims, such Claims shall be considered to be Unsecured Claims and, pursuant to such Final Order, shall be treated as General Unsecured Claims in accordance with Class 12 of the Plan or as otherwise determined by the Bankruptcy Court.
1.241
Vendor Escrow
:
The escrow administered by WMI, or its successor in interest, containing Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00) paid by JPMC pursuant to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement, which funds shall be used in connection with the satisfaction of Allowed WMI Vendor Claims and, upon payment of all such Claims and all fees and expenses associated with such escrow, which remaining funds shall be distributed equally to WMI and JPMC.
1.242
Visa Claims
:
Any Claim against the Debtors set forth on Schedule 2.15(a) to the Global Settlement Agreement filed in connection with the Visa Shares or any litigation or agreement relating thereto, and the Claims asserted by VISA U.S.A. Inc. in its proof of claim filed against the Debtors and the Debtors’ chapter 11 cases, Claim No. 2483, pertaining to the VISA Strategic Agreement to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
1.243
Visa Shares
:
The 3.147 million Class B shares of Visa Inc. held by WMI and set forth on the Schedules and/or WMI’s books and records as of the Petition Date.
1.244
Voting Record Date
:
The date established by the Bankruptcy Court in the Disclosure Statement Order for the purpose of determining the holders of Allowed Claims and Equity Interests entitled to vote on the Plan.
1.245
WaMu Pension Plan
:
That certain WaMu Pension Plan, which plan is intended to satisfy the tax requirements of Section 401 of the IRC and is sponsored by WMI.
1.246
WMB
:
Washington Mutual Bank.
1.247
WMB Intellectual Property
:
The intellectual property listed on Exhibit “X” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.248
WMB Global Note Program
:
That certain program, established by WMB in 2005, providing for the issuance of up to $22 billion in debt financing, pursuant to which WMB issued Senior Global Notes and Subordinated Global Notes.
1.249
WMB Notes Claim
:
A WMB Senior Notes Claim or a WMB Subordinated Notes Claim.
1.250
WMB Senior Notes
:
The Senior Global Notes issued by WMB pursuant to the WMB Global Note Program.
1.251
WMB Senior Notes Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to WMB Senior Notes and with respect to which a proof of Claim was timely filed against the Debtors.
1.252
WMB Subordinated Notes
:
The Subordinated Global Notes issued by WMB pursuant to the WMB Global Note Program.
1.253
WMB Subordinated Notes Claim
:
An Unsecured Claim arising from or relating to WMB Subordinated Notes and with respect to which a proof of Claim was timely filed against the Debtors.
1.254
WMB Vendor Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors and their chapter 11 estates filed by a vendor with respect to services, software licenses or goods provided to WMB and its subsidiaries (whether prior or subsequent to JPMC’s acquisition of the assets of WMB) pursuant to a contract or written agreement between WMB and/or its subsidiaries and such vendor.
1.255
WMI
:
Washington Mutual, Inc., a Debtor in these Chapter 11 Cases.
1.256
WMI Accounts
:
The accounts as set forth on Exhibit “E” to the Global Settlement Agreement that are not Disputed Accounts.
1.257
WMI Action
:
The litigation commenced by the Debtors against the FDIC, styled
Washington Mutual, Inc. and WMI Investment Corp.
v.
FDIC
, Case No. 09-00533, in the United States District Court for the District of Columbia.
1.258
WMI Entities
:
WMI, WMI Investment, Ahmanson Obligation Company, H.S. Loan Corporation, WAMU 1031 Exchange, WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company, Inc., WM Citation Holdings, LLC, WMI Rainier LLC and Washington Mutual Capital Trust 2001.
1.259
WMI Intellectual Property
:
The intellectual property listed on Exhibit “Y” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.260
WMI Investment
:
WMI Investment Corp., a Debtor in these Chapter 11 Cases and, as applicable, WMI Investment Corp. as a reorganized entity from and after the Effective Date.
1.261
WMI Medical Plan
:
Washington Mutual, Inc. Flexible Benefits Plan.
1.262
WMI Medical Plan Claim
:
Any Claim against the Debtors and their chapter 11 estates filed by a beneficiary of the WMI Medical Plan, to the extent such Claim constitutes an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
1.263
WMI Policies
:
The BOLI/COLI policies and the proceeds thereof set forth on Exhibit “R” to the Global Settlement Agreement.
1.264
WMI Rabbi Trust
:
The “rabbi trust” listed on Exhibit “Q” to the Global Settlement Agreement, including all assets therein.
1.265
WMI Vendor Claim
:
Any Claim against WMI asserted by a vendor with respect to services, software licenses or goods asserted to have been provided by the counterparty to or for the benefit of WMB or any of its subsidiaries or minority investments operations prior to the Petition Date pursuant to an agreement between WMI and such vendor.
1.266
WMI/WMB Intercompany Claim
:
Any Claim against WMI, WMB, or one of WMB’s subsidiaries held by WMI, WMB, or one of WMB’s subsidiaries.
1.267
WMMRC
:
WM Mortgage Reinsurance Company, Inc., a Hawaiian domiciled corporation.
1.268
Other Definitions
:
Unless the context otherwise requires, any capitalized term used and not defined herein or elsewhere in the Plan that is defined in the Bankruptcy Code shall have the meaning assigned to that term in the Bankruptcy Code. Unless otherwise specified, (a) all section, schedule, or exhibit references in the Plan are to the respective section in, article of, or schedule or exhibit to, the Plan, as the same may be amended, waived, or modified from time to time and (b) all references to dollars are to the lawful currency of the United States of America. The words “herein,” “hereof,” “hereto,” “hereunder,” and other words of similar import refer to the Plan as a whole and not to any particular section, subsection, or clause contained in the Plan. The rules of construction contained in section 102 of the Bankruptcy Code shall apply to the construction of the Plan. In computing any period of time prescribed or allowed by the Plan, unless otherwise expressly provided, the provisions of Bankruptcy Rule 9006(a) shall apply.
ARTICLE II
COMPROMISE AND SETTLEMENT OF DISPUTES
2.1
Compromise, Settlement and Sale
:
Pursuant to sections 363, 365, 1123(a)(5) and 1123(b)(3) of the Bankruptcy Code and Bankruptcy Rule 9019, the Plan incorporates, and is expressly conditioned upon the approval and effectiveness of, the sale, free and clear of all Liens, Claims and encumbrances, of the Debtors’ rights to and interests in certain
of the Plan Contribution Assets and the compromise and settlement by and among the Debtors, JPMC, the FDIC Receiver, and FDIC Corporate, all as set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement. The Global Settlement Agreement is incorporated into this Plan by reference as if fully set forth herein and, subject to the occurrence of the Effective Date and execution of the Global Settlement Agreement, represents a full, final and complete compromise, settlement, and release of, among other matters, the issues in dispute among the Debtors, JPMC, the FDIC Receiver, and FDIC Corporate, including, among other issues, resolution of all Related Actions. Without limiting the foregoing, subsections (a) through (h) below describes certain of the principal provisions of the Global Settlement Agreement, but, except with respect to the releases provided in Section 41.6 hereof, nothing in this Plan shall be construed to, or is intended to, limit or diminish the benefits to be received by, or rights of, any of the parties pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement. In the event of any inconsistency between the Global Settlement Agreement, the Plan or the Confirmation Order, the documents shall control in the following order of priority: (i) Confirmation Order, (ii) Global Settlement Agreement, and (iii) Plan;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event of any inconsistency between these documents with respect to the releases provided in Section 41.6 herein, the documents shall control in the following order of priority: (i) Confirmation Order, (ii) Plan, and (iii) Global Settlement Agreement.
(a)
WMI Accounts and Disputed Accounts
. In partial consideration for the assets sold pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement and the releases and other benefits provided to the Released Parties pursuant to this Plan, (1) the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, and FDIC Corporate shall (i) waive any and all claims, rights and liabilities with respect to the WMI Accounts and the Disputed Accounts and (ii) take such actions, if any, as may be reasonably requested by WMI, including, without limitation, (A) filing with the Bankruptcy Court such notices or pleadings setting forth the waiver of any and all interest in the WMI Accounts and the Disputed Accounts and (B) seeking dismissals referred to in Section 2.6(b) of the Global Settlement Agreement, (2) the FDIC Receiver and FDIC Corporate shall waive and release any and all rights to seize or set off the WMI Accounts and the Disputed Accounts and any funds contained therein in accordance with Section 9.5 of the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, including, without limitation, by withdrawing, with prejudice, the FDIC Stay Relief Motion, and (3) JPMC shall pay to WMI or such other of the WMI Entities as WMI shall designate, the amounts contained in the Disputed Accounts and the WMI Accounts as of the effective date of the Global Settlement Agreement, net of eighty percent (80%) of the amounts received by WMI during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the date hereof attributable to refunds of Taxes deposited into the Disputed Accounts and the WMI Accounts (including the interest component of any such refunds and interest, if any, earned thereon), free and clear of all Liens, Claims, interests and encumbrances of any Person. In addition, JPMC, as successor to WMB, shall (i) release any security interest in or Lien upon the Admin Account and the monies contained therein and (ii) release and otherwise transfer the Admin Account and the funds contained therein in accordance with the direction of WMI.
(b)
Tax Matters
. In partial consideration for the releases and other benefits provided under the Plan, WMI, the FDIC Receiver, and JPMC shall jointly direct all Tax Authorities to pay refunds of “Pre-2009 Group Taxes” (as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement) to an escrow account, the custodian of which will distribute such Tax Refunds in accordance with the terms and procedures set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement. If any
such Pre-2009 Group Tax refund is paid directly to any party, such party will deposit such refund in the Refund Escrow Account (as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement).
(c)
Transfer of Assets to JPMC
. In further consideration for the satisfaction, settlement, release, and discharge of, and in exchange for, the JPMC Action and the JPMC Claims, and the payment by JPMC of the amounts specified in the Global Settlement Agreement, the WMI Entities, the FDIC Receiver and the Receivership shall sell, transfer, and assign to the JPMC Entities, and the JPMC Entities shall acquire, pursuant to the Plan and sections 363 and 365 of the Bankruptcy Code, any and all right, title and interest any of the WMI Entities, the FDIC Receiver and the Receivership may have in (i) the Trust Preferred Securities, (ii) the WMI Medical Plan, any outstanding checks made out to WMI, including pharmacy rebates in connection with contracts associated with or attributable to the WMI Medical Plan and an amount equal to the pharmacy rebates received by the WMI Entities from and after the Petition Date, currently estimated to be approximately Seven Hundred Seventy-Five Thousand Dollars ($775,000.00), (iii) the JPMC Rabbi Trusts and the JPMC Policies, (iv) the WaMu Pension Plan and the Lakeview Plan and all of the sponsor’s interest in the assets contained in any trusts or otherwise associated with such plans (subject to the correction and satisfaction of certain potential defects and remediation obligations, as set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement), (v) the Anchor Litigation, (vi) the Visa Shares and the VISA Strategic Agreement (as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement), (vii) the Transferred Intellectual Property, the WMB Intellectual Property and the Unidentified Intellectual Property, (viii) JPMC Wind Investment Portfolio LLC and (ix) the Bonds, in each case under clauses (i) through (ix) inclusively, free and clear of all Liens, Claims, interests and encumbrances of any Entity, except for any claim that is an Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claim.
(d)
JPMC Claims
. The JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim shall be deemed an Allowed Claim against WMI. The JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim shall be classified with and treated in the same manner as other Allowed General Unsecured Claims under the Plan, including, without limitation, with respect to distributions pursuant to the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that, in partial consideration for the releases and other benefits provided to JPMC pursuant to the Plan, JPMC shall waive any distribution JPMC otherwise would be entitled to receive on account of the JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim.
(e)
Transfer of Assets to the Debtors
. In further consideration for the satisfaction, settlement, release and discharge of, and in exchange for, the Turnover Action and the Rule 2004 Inquiry, and as further consideration for the releases and other benefits provided to JPMC pursuant to this Plan, and as set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement, the JPMC Entities shall sell, transfer, and assign to the WMI Entities, and the WMI Entities shall acquire, pursuant to the Plan and sections 363 and 365 of the Bankruptcy Code, any and all right, title and interest any of the JPMC Entities may have in, among other assets, (i) the WMI Rabbi Trust and the WMI Policies, (ii) the stock of H.S. Loan Corporation, (iii) the Registry Funds and the American Savings Escrow Funds, and (iv) the WMI Intellectual Property, in each case, free and clear of all Liens, Claims, interests and encumbrances of any Entity.
(f)
Additional Consideration to the Debtors
. As additional consideration for the asset sale and compromise and settlement embodied in the Global
Settlement Agreement, and as further consideration for the releases and other benefits provided to JPMC pursuant to this Plan:
(1)
JPMC shall pay WMI an additional Twenty-Five Million Dollars ($25,000,000.00) for the Visa Shares, WMI shall retain all dividends with respect thereto received prior to the effective date of the Global Settlement Agreement, and JPMC shall assume certain related litigation liabilities (as set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement);
(2)
JPMC shall pay all obligations under the Intercompany Notes in the amounts set forth in Exhibit “V” to the Global Settlement Agreement, and shall forgive all obligations of the WMI Entities to the extent set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement, which Intercompany Notes shall be cancelled upon payment thereof;
(3)
As set forth in more detail in the Global Settlement Agreement, JPMC shall cause its affiliates to continue providing loan servicing with respect to certain loans and the remittal of checks and payments received in connection therewith;
(4)
As set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and the BKK Settlement Agreement, JPMC shall assume the BKK Liabilities and shall defend the Debtors against and reimburse the Debtors for any distribution on account of remediation or clean-up costs and expenses contained in the BKK Proofs of Claims and not otherwise covered by the BKK-Related Policies and/or reimbursed by the BKK-Related Carriers, as defined in the Global Settlement Agreement;
(5)
JPMC shall assume the JPMC Assumed Liabilities in connection with the assets it receives pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement and, on or after the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of Allowed JPMC Assumed Liability Claims; and
(6)
JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of Allowed WMB Vendor Claims and shall pay the sum of Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00) to be placed by the Debtors in an escrow and used for satisfaction of Allowed WMI Vendor Claims.
(g)
Additional Consideration to the FDIC
. In further consideration for the satisfaction, settlement, release and discharge of, and in exchange for, the FDIC Claim:
(1)
The FDIC Receiver shall receive distributions in accordance with Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement; and
(2)
The FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and the Receivership shall receive the releases set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and Article XLI herein.
(h)
Settlement with REIT Series Holders
. In consideration for the releases by the REIT Series holders of any and all claims arising out of, related to, or resulting from, among other things, the issuance, sale or assignment of the Trust Preferred Securities, the commitments to or exchange event ordered by the Office of Thrift Supervision or any capital or other commitment, disclosure or non-disclosure with respect thereto, the assignment of the Trust Preferred Securities subsequent thereto, and any and all claims in any way related to the Trust Preferred Securities or the REIT Series, on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay, or transfer to the Disbursing Agent, for payment to each Releasing REIT Trust Holder its pro rata share of Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00), determined by multiplying (a) Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00) times (b) an amount equal to (i) the principal amount of REIT Series held by such Releasing REIT Trust Holder on the Voting Record Date divided by (ii) the outstanding principal amount of all REIT Series (which is Four Billion Dollars ($4,000,000,000.00));
provided
,
however
, that, at the election of JPMC, the amount payable to Releasing REIT Trust Holders pursuant to Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement may be paid in shares of common stock of JPMC, having an aggregate value equal to the amount of cash to be paid pursuant to Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement, valued at the average trading price during the thirty (30) day period immediately preceding the Effective Date. While JPMC’s maximum liability pursuant to Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement is Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00), JPMC’s liability shall be reduced to the extent the Releasing REIT Trust Holders comprise less than all of the outstanding REIT Series holders.
(i)
Settlement with WMB Senior Note Holders
. In consideration for the releases to be granted by holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders of, among other things, all direct and derivative claims arising from or related to such holders’ WMB Senior Notes, as well as any misrepresentation or other similar claim for damages arising from the purchase or sale of such holders’ WMB Senior Notes (including, without limitation, any Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims that such holders may have), the Debtors have agreed to provide such holders with those certain BB Liquidating Trust Interests, representing an undivided interest in WMI’s share of the Homeownership Carryback Refund Amount, as defined and set forth in Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement, in an amount equal to Three Hundred Thirty-Five Million Dollars ($335,000,000.00) in the aggregate. In connection therewith, certain holders of WMB Senior Notes Claims – the Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders – have executed an agreement with the Debtors, pursuant to which such holders have agreed, in exchange for the treatment and distributions to be provided pursuant to the Plan to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims, to not sell or otherwise transfer their note holdings without first binding such transferee or assignee to the Plan Support Agreement, to support confirmation of the Plan, and to provide certain releases, as set forth more fully in the Plan Support Agreement.
(j)
Releases
. The releases provided in Article XLI herein are integral to obtaining the value provided under the Global Settlement Agreement and the releases under this Plan constitute an essential component of the compromises reached and are not severable from the other provisions of this Plan.
ARTICLE III
PROVISIONS FOR PAYMENT OF
ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSE CLAIMS AND PRIORITY TAX CLAIMS
3.1
Administrative Expense Claims
:
On the later to occur of (i) the Effective Date and (ii) the date on which an Administrative Expense Claim shall become an Allowed Claim, the Disbursing Agent shall (a) pay to each holder of an Allowed Administrative Expense Claim, in Cash, the full amount of such Allowed Administrative Expense Claim or (b) satisfy and discharge such Allowed Administrative Expense Claim in accordance with such other terms no more favorable to the claimant than as may be agreed upon by and between the holder thereof and the Disbursing Agent;
provided
,
however
, that Allowed Administrative Expense Claims representing liabilities incurred in the ordinary course of business by the Debtors shall be paid in full and performed by the Disbursing Agent in the ordinary course of business in accordance with the terms and subject to the conditions of any agreement governing, instrument evidencing, or other document relating to such transactions; and
provided
,
further
, that, if any such ordinary course expense is not billed, or a request for payment is not made, within ninety (90) days after the Effective Date, such ordinary course expense shall be barred and the holder thereof shall not be entitled to a distribution pursuant to the Plan.
3.2
Professional Compensation and Reimbursement Claims
:
Except as otherwise provided in Section 41.18 hereof, all Entities awarded compensation or reimbursement of expenses by the Bankruptcy Court in accordance with section 328, 330, or 331 of the Bankruptcy Code or entitled to priorities established pursuant to section 503(b)(2), 503(b)(3), 503(b)(4), or 503(b)(5) of the Bankruptcy Code, shall be paid in full, in Cash, in the amounts allowed by the Bankruptcy Court (i) on or as soon as reasonably practicable following the later to occur of (a) the Effective Date and (b) the date upon which the Bankruptcy Court order allowing such Claim becomes a Final Order or (ii) upon such other terms no more favorable to the claimant than as may be mutually agreed upon between such claimant and the Disbursing Agent;
provided
,
however
, that, except as provided herein, each professional must file its application for final allowance of compensation for professional services rendered and reimbursement of expenses on or prior to the Administrative Claim Bar Date. The Disbursing Agent is authorized to pay compensation for professional services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred after the Effective Date in the ordinary course and without the need for Bankruptcy Court approval.
3.3
Priority Tax Claims
:
Each holder of an Allowed Priority Tax Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Priority Tax Claim, distributions in an amount equal to the full amount of such Allowed Priority Tax Claim. At the option and discretion of the Debtors, which option shall be exercised, in writing, on or prior to the commencement of the Confirmation Hearing, such payment shall be made (i) in full, in Cash, on or as soon as reasonably practicable following the later to occur of (a) the Effective Date and (b) the date on which such claim becomes an Allowed Claim, (ii) in accordance with section 1129(a)(9)(C) of the Bankruptcy Code, in full, in Cash, in equal quarterly installments commencing on the first (1st) Business Day following the Effective Date and continuing over a period not exceeding five (5) years from and after the Petition Date, together with interest accrued thereon at the applicable non-bankruptcy rate, subject to the sole option of the
Disbursing Agent to prepay the entire amount of the Allowed Priority Tax Claim, or (iii) by mutual agreement of the holder of such Allowed Priority Tax Claim and the Disbursing Agent.
3.4
Statutory Fees
:
All fees payable under section 1930 of chapter 123 of title 28 of the United States Code, as determined by the Bankruptcy Court at the Confirmation Hearing, shall be paid on or as soon as reasonably practicable following the Effective Date.
3.5
Administrative Tax Claims
:
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in the Plan or in the Confirmation Order, a governmental unit shall not be required to file, make or submit a request for payment (or any document, including, without limitation, a bill) of an expense described in section 503(b)(1)(B) or (C) of the Bankruptcy Code as a condition of its being an Allowed Administrative Expense Claim, and the Disbursing Agent shall pay in full all such Allowed Administrative Expense Claims, including any interest related thereto, when due.
ARTICLE IV
CLASSIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND EQUITY INTERESTS
Claims and Equity Interests are classified as follows:
4.1
Class 1 Priority Non-Tax Claims
4.2
Class 2 Senior Notes Claims
4.3
Class 3 Senior Subordinated Notes Claims
4.4
Class 4 WMI Medical Plan Claims
4.5
Class 5 JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims
4.6
Class 6 Other Benefit Plan Claims
4.7
Class 7 Qualified Plan Claims
4.8
Class 8 WMB Vendor Claims
4.9
Class 9 Visa Claims
4.10
Class 10 Bond Claims
4.11
Class 11 WMI Vendor Claims
4.12
Class 12 General Unsecured Claims
Class 12A Late-Filed Claims
4.13
Class 13 Convenience Claims
4.14
Class 14 CCB-1 Guarantees Claims
4.15
Class 15 CCB-2 Guarantees Claims
4.16
Class 16 PIERS Claims
4.17
Class 17A WMB Senior Notes Claims
Class 17B WMB Subordinated Notes Claims
4.18
Class 18 Subordinated Claims
4.19
Class 19 Preferred Equity Interests
4.20
Class 20 Intentionally Left Blank
4.21
Class 21 Dime Warrants
4.22
Class 22
Common Equity Interests
ARTICLE V
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PRIORITY NON-TAX CLAIMS (CLASS 1)
5.1
Payment of Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claims
:
Unless otherwise mutually agreed upon by the holder of an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim and the Debtors, on the later of the Effective Date and the date such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim becomes an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, or as soon thereafter as is practicable, the Disbursing Agent shall pay to each holder of an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, in Cash, the full amount of such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, in full satisfaction, settlement, release, and discharge of, and in exchange for such Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim.
ARTICLE VI
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF SENIOR NOTES CLAIMS (CLASS 2)
6.1
Treatment of Senior Notes Claims
:
(a)
Fixed Rate Notes
. Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the rights of election described in Section 6.2 below, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim relating to a Fixed Rate Note shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for the avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date, shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim, cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the Senior Notes Indenture Trustee, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim and Intercreditor Interest Claim.
(b)
Floating Rate Notes
. Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the rights of election described in Section 6.2 below, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim relating to a Floating Rate Note shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date, shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim, cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the Senior Notes Indenture Trustee, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Remaining Postpetition Interest Claim.
In consideration for, and subject in all respects to the grant and approval of, the third party release being granted by each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, Dime Warrant and Common Equity Interest executing and delivering a release in accordance with Section 41.6 hereof, on the Effective Date, from the initial distributions of Creditor Cash referred to above and to be made in
accordance with Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim, whether relating to a Fixed Rate Note or a Floating Rate Note, shall contribute Cash to Reorganized WMI, for and on behalf of each such holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, Dime Warrant and Common Equity Interest, in an amount equal to Nine Hundred Sixty-Eight Thousandths of one percent (0.968%) of such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim (in the aggregate amount for all Allowed Senior Notes Claim, Forty Million Dollars ($40,000,000.00)); and,
provided
,
further
, that, for the avoidance of doubt, with respect to the foregoing provision, “Allowed Senior Notes Claim” shall mean the principal amount of such Senior Notes Claim and interest accrued thereon, remaining unpaid and relating to the period up to and including the Petition Date; and,
provided
,
further
, that, for the avoidance of doubt, for the applicability of the contractual subordination provisions referred to below, such contributions shall not be recouped through the enforcement of any such contractual subordination provision. Subject to the foregoing sentence, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim shall be entitled to receive on account of such Allowed Senior Notes Claim and, irrespective of whether all Allowed Claims are paid in full, such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim and, if applicable, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claim, redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
6.2
Rights of Election
:
(a)
Runoff Notes Election
. On the Ballot, and subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive Runoff Notes, in lieu of some or all of the Creditor Cash that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive on the Effective Date pursuant to the provisions of Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, subject to the Lien or priority rights of the Senior Notes Indenture Trustee. To the extent that, on the Effective Date, a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim receives Runoff Notes, such holder’s distribution of Creditor Cash to be received on the Effective Date shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes received.
(b)
Reorganized Common Stock Election
. On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim that elected to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.2(a) of the Plan shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to and has elected to receive pursuant to Section 6.2(a) of the Plan. To the extent a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election,
such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of the Liquidating Trust Assets) equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds such holder otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 6.2 on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
6.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim in accordance with Section 6.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum of (i) distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 6.1 and 6.2 and (ii), redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests, and, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes, in accordance with the enforcement, pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, of contractual subordination provisions, as set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and, with respect to the Floating Rate Notes, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claim, (inclusive of monies tendered by holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims in connection with the Senior Notes Release Consideration), the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, for the avoidance of doubt, the subrogation rights with respect to Allowed Senior Notes Claims shall be preserved.
ARTICLE VII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF
SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES CLAIMS (CLASS 3)
7.1
Treatment of Senior Subordinated Notes Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the rights of election described in Section 7.2 below, each holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for the avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim,
cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such holder’s Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim and (b) such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim;
provided
,
however
, that any distribution to holders of Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims of (a) Creditor Cash, (b) Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and (c) Runoff Notes (to the extent elected pursuant to Section 7.2 of the Plan), shall be redistributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to any Lien or priority rights of the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee, in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”;
provided
,
however
, that, in consideration for, and subject in all respects to the grant and approval of, the third party release being granted by each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, Dime Warrant and Common Equity Interest executing and delivering a release in accordance with Section 41.6 hereof, on the Effective Date, from the initial distributions of Creditor Cash referred to above and to be made in accordance with Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim shall contribute Cash to Reorganized WMI, for and on behalf of each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, Dime Warrant and Common Equity Interest, in an amount equal to Two and One-Tenth percent of (2.1%) of such holder’s Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim (in the aggregate amount for all Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Thirty Five Million Dollars ($35,000,000.00)); and,
provided
,
further
, that, for the avoidance of doubt, with respect to the foregoing provision, “Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim” shall mean the principal amount of such Senior Notes Claim and interest accrued thereon, remaining unpaid and relating to the period up to and including the Petition Date; and,
provided
,
further
, that, notwithstanding the applicability of the contractual subordination provisions referred to below, such contributions shall not be recouped through the enforcement of any such contractual subordination provision. Subject to the foregoing sentence, each holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim shall be entitled to receive on account of such Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim and, irrespective of whether all Allowed Claims are paid in full, such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim, redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
7.2
Rights of Election
:
(a)
Runoff Notes Election
. On the Ballot, and subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive Runoff Notes (to the extent remaining after distributions to or reserves retained for holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims and General Unsecured Claims, whether an Allowed Claim or a Disputed Claim as of the Effective Date), in lieu of some or all of the Creditor Cash that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive on the Effective Date pursuant to the provisions of Section 31.14
of the Plan, subject to the Lien or priority rights of the Senior Subordinated Notes Indenture Trustee. To the extent that, on the Effective Date, a holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim receives Runoff Notes, such holder’s distribution of Creditor Cash to be received on the Effective Date shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes received.
(b)
Reorganized Common Stock Election
. On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim that elected to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 7.2(a) of the Plan shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to and has elected to receive pursuant to Section 7.2(a) of the Plan. To the extent that a holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election, such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of the Liquidating Trust Assets) equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds such holder otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 7.2 on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
7.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim in accordance with Section 7.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum of (i) distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 7.1 and 7.2 of the Plan, (ii) redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes, in accordance with the enforcement, pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, of contractual subordination provisions, as set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, and (iii) redistributions of Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Section 6.3 herein are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim and Intercreditor Interest Claim, (inclusive of monies tendered by holders of Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims in connection with the Senior Subordinated Notes Release Consideration), the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or
Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, for the avoidance of doubt, the subrogation rights with respect to Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims shall be preserved.
ARTICLE VIII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMI MEDICAL PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 4)
8.1
Treatment of WMI Medical Plan Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of all WMI Medical Plan Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE IX
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF
JPMC RABBI TRUST/POLICY CLAIMS (CLASS 5)
9.1
Treatment of JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims
:
On the Effective Date, JPMC shall commence to evaluate each of the JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims in accordance with the Global Settlement Agreement, the Plan and the Confirmation Order, and, upon determination thereof, shall pay or fund the payment of all JPMC Rabbi Trust/Policy Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE X
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF
OTHER BENEFIT PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 6)
10.1
Treatment of Other Benefit Plan Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of all Other Benefit Plan Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE XI
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF QUALIFIED PLAN CLAIMS (CLASS 7)
11.1
Treatment of Qualified Plan Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of all Qualified Plan Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE XII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMB VENDOR CLAIMS (CLASS 8)
12.1
Treatment of WMB Vendor Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or otherwise satisfy all Allowed WMB Vendor Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE XIII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF VISA CLAIMS (CLASS 9)
13.1
Treatment of Visa Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of all Visa Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE XIV
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF BOND CLAIMS (CLASS 10)
14.1
Treatment of Bond Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay or fund the payment of all Bond Claims, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such Claims.
ARTICLE XV
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMI VENDOR CLAIMS (CLASS 11)
15.1
Treatment of WMI Vendor Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, each holder of an Allowed WMI Vendor Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s WMI Vendor Claim, payment in Cash from the
Vendor Escrow.
ARTICLE XVI
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF GENERAL UNSECURED CLAIMS (CLASS 12)
16.1
Class 12 – General Unsecured Claims
:
(a)
Treatment of General Unsecured Claims
. Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the right of election described in Section 16.1(b) below, each holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed General Unsecured Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such holder’s Allowed General Unsecured Claim and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims (other than Subordinated Claims) are paid in full, such holder’s Postpetition Interest Claim;
provided
,
however
, that, pursuant to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement, and as partial consideration for the releases set forth in Article XLI herein, upon the Effective Date, JPMC shall be deemed to have waived its right to receive any distribution on account of the JPMC Allowed Unsecured Claim, including, without limitation, the right to elect to receive Runoff Notes, pursuant to Section 16.1(b) below. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation
provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”;
provided
,
however
, that such claims shall be subject to, among other things, reduction, offset or disallowance on account of counterclaims, to the extent applicable, including, but not limited to, the right of the Liquidating Trustee to pursue Avoidance Actions.
(b)
Rights of Election
.
(i)
Runoff Notes Election
. On the Ballot, and subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, each holder of a General Unsecured Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive Runoff Notes in lieu of some or all of the Creditor Cash that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive on the Effective Date pursuant to the provisions of Section 31.1(a) of the Plan. To the extent that, on the Effective Date, a holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim receives Runoff Notes, such holder’s distribution of Creditor Cash to be received on the Effective Date shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes received.
(ii)
Reorganized Common Stock Election
. On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim that elected to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 16.2(a) of the Plan shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment, collectively and not individually, in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to and has elected to receive pursuant to Section 16.2(a) of the Plan. To the extent a holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election, such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of the Liquidating Trust Assets) equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds such holder otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 16.1(b) on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
(c)
Allowed Claims of Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00) or More/Election to be Treated as a Convenience Claim
. Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 16.1 of the Plan, any holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim, other than a General Unsecured Claim that is a component of a larger General Unsecured Claim, portions of which may be held by such or any other holder of an Allowed Claim, whose Allowed General Unsecured Claim is more than Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00), and who elects to reduce
the amount of such Allowed General Unsecured Claim to Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000.00), shall, at such holder’s option, be entitled to receive, based on such Allowed General Unsecured Claim as so reduced, distributions pursuant to Section 17.1 hereof. Such election must be made on the Ballot and be received by the Debtors on or prior to the Ballot Date. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is expressly waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that, under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
16.2
Class 12A – Late-Filed Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model, each holder of an Allowed Late-Filed Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Late-Filed Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such holder’s Allowed Late-Filed Claim and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims (other than Subordinated Claims) are paid in full, such holder’s Postpetition Interest Claim, which interests shall entitle such holder to distributions from the Liquidating Trust after all Allowed Unsecured Claims are paid in full (but prior to payment of Subordinated Claims). The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Holders of Late-Filed Claims are not entitled to elect to have their Late-Filed Claims treated as Convenience Claims pursuant to Section 16.1(c) hereof.
16.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed General Unsecured Claim or an Allowed Late Filed Claim in accordance with Sections 16.1 and 16.2 of the Plan, as applicable, in the event that the sum of the distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 16.1 or 16.2 are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed General Unsecured Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim or Allowed Late-Filed Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, as the case may be, the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
ARTICLE XVII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF CONVENIENCE CLAIMS (CLASS 13)
17.1
Treatment of Convenience Claims
:
On the later of the Effective Date and the date such Allowed Convenience Claim becomes an Allowed Claim, or as soon thereafter as is practicable, the Disbursing Agent shall pay to each holder of an Allowed Convenience
Claim, in Cash, the full amount of such Allowed Convenience Claim, in full satisfaction, settlement, release, and discharge of, and in exchange for such Allowed Convenience Claim.
ARTICLE XVIII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF
CCB-1 GUARANTEES CLAIMS (CLASS 14)
18.1
Treatment of CCB-1 Guarantees Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the right of election described in Section 18.2 below, each holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for the avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim, cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-1 Trustee, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such holder’s Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim and (b) such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim;
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the contractual subordination and subrogation rights of Entities who hold CCB-1 Preferred Securities shall be preserved and enforced hereunder pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code and any proposed distribution on account of the CCB-1 Common Securities of (i) Runoff Notes, (ii) Creditor Cash and (iii) Cash on account of Liquidating Trust Interests shall be recalculated and then distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien and priority rights of the CCB-1 Trustee, to Entities who hold CCB-1 Preferred Securities, or Liquidating Trust Interests on account thereof, until such time as such Entities’ Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims have been satisfied in accordance with the terms and provisions of the trust agreements related to such securities; and,
provided
,
further
, that, following such distribution to holders of CCB-1 Common Securities, in accordance with the Global Settlement Agreement, the Receivership shall not retain any such distribution and the Liquidating Trust shall redistribute such distribution in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”; and,
provided
,
however
, that, following the distribution to CCB-1 Preferred Securities referred to above, any remaining distribution to holders of Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims of (a) Creditor Cash, (b) Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests, and (c) Runoff Notes (to the extent elected pursuant to Section 18.2) shall be distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-1 Trustee, in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. In addition, in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, each holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim shall be entitled to receive on account of such Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim and, irrespective of whether all Allowed Claims are paid in full, such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim, redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled
to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
18.2
Rights of Election
:
(a)
Runoff Notes Election
. On the Ballot, and subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive Runoff Notes (to the extent remaining after distribution to holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, General Unsecured Claims, and Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, subject to adjustment based upon the Runoff Notes elected by holders of Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims), in lieu of some or all of the Creditor Cash that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive on the Effective Date pursuant to the provisions of Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-1 Trustee. To the extent that, on the Effective Date, a holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim receives Runoff Notes such holder’s distribution of Cash to be received on the Effective Date shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes received.
(b)
Reorganized Common Stock Election
. On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim that elected to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 18.2(a) of the Plan shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment, collectively and not individually, in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to and has elected to receive pursuant to Section 18.2(a) of the Plan. To the extent a holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election, such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of the Liquidating Trust Assets) equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds such holder otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 18.2 on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
18.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim in accordance with Section 18.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum
of (i) distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 18.1 and 18.2, (ii) redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes, in accordance with the enforcement, pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, of contractual subordination provisions, as set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, (iii) redistributions of Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.3 or 7.3 herein and (iv) distributions from the Receivership are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim and Intercreditor Interest Claim, the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, for the avoidance of doubt, the subrogation rights with respect to Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims shall be preserved.
ARTICLE XIX
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF
CCB-2 GUARANTEES CLAIMS (CLASS 15)
19.1
Treatment of CCB-2 Guarantees Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the right of election described in Section 19.2 below, each holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, Intercreditor Interest Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for the avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim, cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-2 Trustees, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Creditor Cash and (ii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such holder’s Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim and (b) such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim;
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the contractual subordination and subrogation rights of Entities who hold CCB-2 Preferred Securities shall be preserved and enforced hereunder pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code and any proposed distribution on account of the CCB-2 Common Securities of (i) Runoff Notes, (ii) Creditor Cash and (iii) Cash on account of Liquidating Trust Interests shall be recalculated and then distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien and priority rights of the CCB-2 Trustees, to Entities who hold CCB-2 Preferred Securities, or Liquidating Trust Interests on account thereof, until such time as such Entities’ Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims have been satisfied in accordance with the terms and provisions of the trust agreements related to such securities; and,
provided
,
further
, that, following such distribution to holders of the CCB-2 Common Securities, in accordance with the Global Settlement Agreement, the Receivership shall not retain any such distribution and the Liquidating Trustee shall redistribute such distributions in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”; and
provided
,
further
, that, following
the distribution to CCB-2 Preferred Securities referred to above, any remaining distribution to holders of Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims of (a) Creditor Cash, (b) Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests, and (c) Runoff Notes (to the extent elected pursuant to Section 19.2), shall be distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-2 Trustees, in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. In addition, in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, each holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim shall be entitled to receive on account of such Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim and, irrespective of whether all Allowed Claims are paid in full, such holder’s Intercreditor Interest Claim, redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
19.2
Rights of Election
:
(a)
Runoff Notes Election
. On the Ballot, and subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, each holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive Runoff Notes (to the extent remaining after distributions to or reserved retained for holders of Senior Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, and Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, subject to adjustment based upon the Runoff Notes elected by holders of Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims), in lieu of some or all of the Creditor Cash that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive on the Effective Date pursuant to the provisions of Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, subject to the Lien or priority rights of the CCB-2 Trustees. To the extent that, on the Effective Date, a holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim receives Runoff Notes, such holder’s distribution of Cash to be received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the original principal amount of the Runoff Notes received.
(b)
Reorganized Common Stock Election
. On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim that elected to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with the provisions of Section 19.2(a) of the Plan shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment, collectively and not individually, in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to and has elected to receive pursuant to Section 19.2(a) of the Plan. To the extent a holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election, such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of Liquidating Trust Assets) equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds such holder
otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 19.2 on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
19.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim in accordance with Section 19.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum of (i) distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 19.1 and 19.2, (ii) redistributions of Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Runoff Notes, in accordance with the enforcement, pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, of contractual subordination provisions, as set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”, (iii) redistributions of Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.3 or 7.3 and (iv) distributions from the Receivership are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim and Intercreditor Interest Claim, the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, for the avoidance of doubt, the subrogation rights with respect to Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims shall be preserved.
ARTICLE XX
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PIERS CLAIMS (CLASS 16)
20.1
Treatment of PIERS Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, each holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed PIERS Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim (which, for the avoidance of doubt, on the Confirmation Date shall be finally determined to not be subject to any avoidance, reduction, setoff, offset, recharacterization, subordination (whether equitable, contractual or otherwise), counterclaim, cross claim, defense, disallowance, impairment, objection, or challenge under applicable law or regulation by any person), subject to the Lien or priority rights of the PIERS Trustee, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of (i) Runoff Notes (subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan and to the extent remaining after distribution to holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, and Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims), (ii) Creditor Cash and (iii) Liquidating Trust Interests, in an aggregate amount equal to (a) such
holder’s Allowed PIERS Claim and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims (other than Subordinated Claims) are paid in full, such holder’s Postpetition Interest Claim;
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, the contractual subordination and subrogation rights of Entities who hold PIERS Preferred Securities shall be preserved and enforced hereunder pursuant to section 510(a) of the Bankruptcy Code and any proposed distribution on account of the PIERS Common Securities of (i) Runoff Notes, (ii) Creditor Cash and (iii) Cash on account of Liquidating Trust Interests shall be recalculated and then distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien and priority rights of the PIERS Trustee, to Entities who hold PIERS Preferred Securities, or Liquidating Trust Interests on account thereof, until such time as such Entities’ Allowed PIERS Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims have been satisfied in accordance with the terms and provisions of the PIERS Trust Agreement; and,
provided
,
further
, that, following such distributions to holders of the PIERS Preferred Securities, WMI shall not retain any distribution on account of the PIERS Common Securities, including, without limitation, the Runoff Notes; and,
provided
,
further
, that, following the distribution to PIERS Preferred Securities referred to above, any remaining distribution of (a) Creditor Cash, (b) Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests, and (c) Runoff Notes, shall be distributed, subject to Bankruptcy Rule 3021 and subject to the Lien or priority rights of the PIERS Trustee, in accordance with the priorities set forth in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. The relative priorities among holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and Allowed Late-Filed Claims, and the order in which such holders are entitled to receive payment of their Allowed Claims, Intercreditor Interest Claims, Remaining Postpetition Interest Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims, including, without limitation, on account of contractual subordination and subrogation provisions, are set forth in more detail in the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”
20.2
Reorganized Common Stock Election
:
On the Ballot, each holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim shall be provided the right to elect, in its sole and absolute discretion, to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment in lieu of (i) fifty percent (50%) of such holder’s Litigation Proceeds Interest (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim) and (ii) subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, some or all of the Runoff Notes that such holder otherwise is entitled to receive pursuant to Section 20.1 of the Plan. To the extent a holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim receives Reorganized Common Stock pursuant to the foregoing election, such holder’s share of the Runoff Notes to which the election was effective shall not be issued and Reorganized WMI shall retain an economic interest in the Litigation Proceeds equal to fifty percent (50%) of the Litigation Proceeds (and such interest shall not constitute a component of the Liquidating Trust Assets) such holder otherwise would have received (solely in its capacity as a holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim) (and the holder’s rights in respect of distributions from the Liquidating Trust shall be adjusted to the extent such proceeds are received by Reorganized WMI).
Failure by any holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim to elect to exercise rights provided in this Section 20.2 on or before the Ballot Date shall constitute a deemed waiver and relinquishment of such rights by such holder. Any election made after the Ballot Date shall not be binding upon the Debtors unless the Ballot Date is waived, in writing, by the Debtors;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance may such waiver by the Debtors occur on or after the Effective Date.
20.3
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed PIERS Claim in accordance with Section 20.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum of (i) distributions of Runoff Notes, Creditor Cash, Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock in accordance with Sections 20.1 and 20.2 of the Plan and (ii) redistributions of Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Sections 6.3, 7.3, 18.3, or 19.3 are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed PIERS Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, the Cash or, subject to the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, Runoff Notes received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, for the avoidance of doubt, the subrogation rights of holders of Allowed PIERS Claims shall be preserved.
ARTICLE XXI
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF WMB NOTES CLAIMS
AND NON-FILING WMB SENIOR NOTE HOLDERS (CLASS 17)
21.1
Treatment of WMB Notes Claims
:
(a)
Class 17A – WMB Senior Notes Claims
. Class 17A shall consist of WMB Senior Notes Claims. Commencing on the Effective Date, each holder of an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of BB Liquidating Trust Interests (which interests, in the aggregate, represent an undivided interest in WMI’s share of the Homeownership Carryback Refund Amount, as defined and set forth in Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement, in an amount equal to Three Hundred Thirty-Five Million Dollars ($335,000,000.00));
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, but subject to the provisions of Section 41.18 hereof, the Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders shall have first priority to recover Cash distributions made on account of the BB Liquidating Trust Interests up to an aggregate amount of Ten Million Dollars ($10,000,000.00), to compensate for the legal fees and expenses incurred by the Settlement WMB Senior Note Holders’ and other WMB Senior Note Holders’ retention of Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP, Pachulski Stang Ziehl & Jones LLP, and Boies, Schiller & Flexner LLP in connection with the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases. Each holder of a WMB Senior Notes Claim that, in accordance with the Original Disclosure Statement Order, elected to check the box on the Class 17A Ballot labeled “Grant Plan Section 43.6 Release” in connection with the Sixth Amended Plan and, by having checked such box: (i) solely with respect to the Plan, such holder’s WMB Senior Notes Claim shall be deemed an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim in an amount equal to the aggregate face value and interest accrued as of the Petition Date with respect to all WMB Senior Notes held by such holder as of October 25, 2010;
provided
,
however
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, such amount shall be only for purposes of voting and calculating each holder’s “Pro Rata Share” of BB Liquidating Trust Interests, and shall not in any way increase the amount to be distributed to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note
Holders in excess of Three Hundred Thirty-Five Million Dollars ($335,000,000.00); (ii) the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and all other parties in interest shall be deemed to have waived and released any and all objections, defenses, rights to setoff or recoupment, and rights to subordinate or recharacterize with respect to such Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim; and (iii) the holder of such Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim shall consent to provide on its behalf and with respect to its Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim the releases provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan, including, without limitation, a release of the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, and the Liquidating Trustee from all direct and derivative claims arising from or related to such holder’s Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim, as well as any misrepresentation or other similar claim for damages arising from the purchase or sale of such holder’s Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim (including, without limitation, any Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims that such holder may have);
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing is not intended, nor shall it be construed, to release (i) the Debtors from their obligations pursuant to the Plan and (ii) the FDIC Receiver or the Receivership with respect to distributions to be made from the Receivership on account of WMB Senior Notes. In the event that, in accordance with the Original Disclosure Statement Order, the holder of a WMB Senior Notes Claim did not check the box on the Class 17A Ballot labeled “Grant Plan Section 43.6 Release” in connection with the Sixth Amended Plan, the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and all parties in interest shall reserve and maintain all of their respective rights to dispute such WMB Senior Notes Claim, including, without limitation, on the basis that the Debtors have no liability with respect thereto, the Claim is subject to other defenses, setoff, or recoupment, and/or the Claim is subject to equitable or mandatory subordination pursuant to section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code;
provided
,
however
, that, to the extent that such WMB Senior Notes Claim is determined pursuant to a Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court to be an Allowed Claim, (i) such Claim shall be deemed an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim, (ii) the holder of such Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim shall be entitled to receive its Pro Rata Share of the BB Liquidating Trust Interests, and (iii) such holder shall be deemed to have consented to the releases provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan, including, without limitation, a release of the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and each of their respective Related Persons from any and all direct and derivative claims arising from or related to such holder’s Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim, as well as any misrepresentation or other similar claim for damages arising from the purchase or sale of such holder’s Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim (including, without limitation, any Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims that such holder may have). Payments made by WMI pursuant to this Section 21.1(a) shall be treated as payments made on account of the WMB Senior Notes held by holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims, and shall reduce the principal amount of such notes (and thus the maximum recovery permitted against the Receivership). The FDIC Receiver acknowledges that amounts distributed to the holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims under the Plan shall not be credited against or otherwise reduce their claims against the Receivership solely for purposes of determining the holders’ relative participation in distributions (unless and until each holder has recovered, in the aggregate, through distributions pursuant to the Plan and from the Receivership, the full amount of its claim). For the avoidance of doubt, all of the $335 million allocated for payment to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, as provided in Sections 21.1(a) and (b) of the Plan, shall be paid either to counsel to or to holders of Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims and Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders,
and none of the foregoing amounts shall revert either to the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors, or be payable to creditors in any other Class under the Plan.
(b)
Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders
. Each Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder that, in accordance with the Original Disclosure Statement Order, elected to check the box on the Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder Election Form labeled “Grant Plan Section 43.6 Release” in connection with the Sixth Amended Plan and, by having checked such box: (i) such holder shall be deemed to be an Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder, (ii) such holder shall be entitled to receive its Pro Rata Share of BB Liquidating Trust Interests, and (iii) such holder shall consent to provide on its behalf and with respect to its WMB Senior Notes the releases provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan, including, without limitation, a release of the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, and the Liquidating Trustee from all direct and derivative claims arising from or related to such holder’s WMB Senior Notes, as well as any misrepresentation or other similar claim for damages arising from the purchase or sale of such holders (WMB Senior Notes);
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing is not intended, nor shall it be construed, to release (i) the Debtors from their obligations pursuant to the Plan and (ii) the FDIC Receiver or the Receivership with respect to distributions to be made from the Receivership on account of WMB Senior Notes. Payments made by WMI pursuant to this Section 21.1(b) shall be treated as payments made on account of the WMB Senior Notes held by Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, and shall reduce the principal amount of such notes (and thus the maximum recovery permitted against the Receivership). The FDIC Receiver acknowledges that amounts distributed to Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders under the Plan shall not be credited against or otherwise reduce their claims against the Receivership solely for purposes of determining the holders’ relative participation in distributions (unless and until each holder has recovered, in the aggregate, through distributions pursuant to the Plan and from the Receivership, the full amount of its claim). Notwithstanding the foregoing, and irrespective of whether a Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder receives a distribution of BB Liquidating Trust Interests pursuant to this Section (b), no Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder shall be deemed to hold a Claim against the Debtors with respect to such holder’s WMB Senior Notes.
(c)
Class 17B – WMB Subordinated Notes
. On the Effective Date, and in consideration for the distribution to be made to the FDIC Receiver pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement, all WMB Subordinated Notes Claims, to the extent that they are not Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims, shall be deemed disallowed, and holders thereof shall not receive any distribution from the Debtors.
(d)
Right to Recovery
. WMB Senior Notes Claims and WMB Subordinated Notes Claims are not superior in right of recovery to Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, or Allowed Late Filed Claims, and the holders of WMB Senior Notes Claims and WMB Subordinated Notes Claims may not seek recourse, payment, turnover, indemnity, damages, setoff, pay-over, or other compensation from holders of any Allowed Claims, including, without limitation, Senior Notes Claims, Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, PIERS Claims, General Unsecured Claims, or Late-Filed Claims, on account of WMB-issued obligations.
ARTICLE XXII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF SUBORDINATED CLAIMS (CLASS 18)
22.1
Treatment of Subordinated Claims
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and in the event that all Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims in respect of Allowed Claims are paid in full, each holder of an Allowed Subordinated Claim shall receive, in full satisfaction, release and exchange of such holder’s Allowed Subordinated Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, such holder’s Pro Rata Share of, Liquidating Trust Interests in an aggregate amount equal to such holder’s Allowed Subordinated Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim.
22.2
Limitation on Recovery
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, including, without limitation, the distributions to be made to a holder of an Allowed Subordinated Claim in accordance with Section 22.1 of the Plan, in the event that the sum of Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with Section 22.1 are equal to or in excess of one hundred percent (100%) of such holder’s Allowed Subordinated Claim and Postpetition Interest Claim, the Cash received on account of Liquidating Trust Interests that is distributable to such holder in excess of such one hundred percent (100%) shall be deemed redistributed to holders of the Equity Interests or the Disbursing Agent for and on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims in accordance with the Subordination Model attached hereto as Exhibit “H”.
ARTICLE XXIII
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF PREFERRED EQUITY INTEREST (CLASS 19)
23.1
Treatment of Preferred Equity Interests
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the execution and delivery of a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan, each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, including, without limitation, each holder of a REIT Series, shall be entitled to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of seventy percent (70%) of (a) subject to the right of election provided in Sections 6.2(b), 7.2(b), 16.1(b)(ii), 18.2(b), 19.2(b) and 20.2(b) of the Plan, the Reorganized Common Stock, and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims in respect of Allowed Claims are paid in full (including with respect to Allowed Subordinated Claims), any Liquidating Trust Interests to be redistributed;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event that, at the Confirmation Hearing and in the Confirmation Order, the Bankruptcy Court determines that a different percentage should apply, the foregoing percentage shall be adjusted in accordance with the determination of the Bankruptcy Court and be binding upon each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest. In addition, and separate and distinct from the distribution to be provided to holders of the Preferred Equity Interests from the Debtors, pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement, and in exchange for the releases set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and in Article XLI herein, on the Effective Date, JPMC shall pay, or transfer to the Disbursing Agent, for payment to each Releasing REIT Trust Holder its pro rata share of Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00), determined by multiplying (a) Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00) times (b) an amount equal to (i) the principal amount of REIT Series held by such Releasing REIT Trust Holder on the voting record date with respect to the Sixth Amended Plan divided by (ii) the
outstanding principal amount of all REIT Series (which is Four Billion Dollars ($4,000,000,000.00));
provided
,
however
, that the release of claims against the “Releasees” delivered in connection with the solicitation of acceptances and rejections to the Sixth Amended Plan shall be deemed binding and effective for each Releasing REIT Trust Holder; and,
provided
,
further
, that, at the election of JPMC, the amount payable to Releasing REIT Trust Holders pursuant to this Section 23.1 and Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement may be paid in shares of common stock of JPMC, having an aggregate value equal to the amount of cash to be paid pursuant to this Section 23.1 and Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement, valued at the average trading price during the thirty (30) day period immediately preceding the Effective Date. While JPMC’s maximum liability pursuant to this Section 23.1 and Section 2.24 of the Global Settlement Agreement is Fifty Million Dollars ($50,000,000.00), JPMC’s liability shall be reduced to the extent the Releasing REIT Trust Holders comprise less than all of the outstanding REIT Series holders.
23.2
Cancellation of REIT Series
:
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 23.1 hereof, on the Effective Date, all REIT Series shall be deemed extinguished and the certificates and all other documents representing such Equity Interests shall be deemed cancelled and of no force and effect. For the avoidance of doubt, this Section 23.2 shall have no effect on, and shall not result in the extinguishment or cancellation of, the Trust Preferred Securities and, in accordance with the Global Settlement Agreement, JPMC or its designee is the sole legal, equitable and beneficial owner of the Trust Preferred Securities for all purposes.
23.3
Cancellation of Preferred Equity Interests
:
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 23.1 hereof, on the Effective Date, all non-REIT Series Preferred Equity Interests shall be deemed extinguished and the certificates and all other documents representing such Equity Interests shall be deemed cancelled and of no force and effect.
ARTICLE XXIV
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF DIME WARRANTS (CLASS 21)
24.1
Treatment of Dime Warrants
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the execution and delivery of a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan, each holder of Dime Warrants shall be entitled to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of thirty percent (30%) of (a) subject to right of election provided in Sections 6.2(b), 7.2(b), 16.1(b)(ii), 18.2(b), 19.2(b) and 20.2(b) of the Plan, the Reorganized Common Stock and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims in respect of Allowed Claims are paid in full (including with respect to Allowed Subordinated Claims), any Liquidating Trust Interests to be redistributed, each to be shared on a pari passu basis with holders of Common Equity Interests;
provided
,
however
, that, to the extent that holders of Dime Warrants are determined, pursuant to a Final Order, to hold Allowed Claims, and such Allowed Claims are not otherwise subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code, such Allowed Claims shall be deemed to be Allowed General Unsecured Claims classified in Class 12 of the Plan and shall receive the treatment provided in Article XVI hereof; and,
provided
,
further
, that, in the event at the Confirmation Hearing and in the Confirmation Order, the Bankruptcy Court determines that a different percentage should
apply, the foregoing percentage shall be adjusted in accordance with the determination of the Bankruptcy Court and be binding upon each holder of a Dime Warrant.
24.2
Cancellation of Dime Warrants
:
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 24.1 hereof, on the Effective Date, all Dime Warrants shall be deemed extinguished and the certificates and all other documents representing such Equity Interests shall be deemed cancelled and of no force and effect.
ARTICLE XXV
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF COMMON EQUITY INTERESTS (CLASS 22)
25.1
Treatment of Common Equity Interests
:
Commencing on the Effective Date, and subject to the execution and delivery of a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan, each holder of Common Equity Interests shall be entitled to receive such holder’s Pro Rata Share of thirty percent (30%) of (a) subject to the right of election provided in Sections 6.2(b), 7.2(b), 16.1(b)(ii), 18.2(b), 19.2(b) and 20.2(b) of the Plan, the Reorganized Common Stock and (b) in the event that all Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims in respect of Allowed Claims are paid in full (including with respect to Allowed Subordinated Claims), any Liquidating Trust Interests to be redistributed, each to be shared on a pari passu basis with holders of the Dime Warrants to the extent that Dime Warrants are determined pursuant to a Final Order, to constitute Equity Interests or subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event at the Confirmation Hearing and in the Confirmation Order, the Bankruptcy Court determines that a different percentage should apply, the foregoing percentage shall be adjusted in accordance with the determination of the Bankruptcy Court and be binding upon each holder of a Common Equity Interest.
25.2
Cancellation of Common Equity Interests
:
Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 25.1 hereof, on the Effective Date, all Common Equity Interests shall be deemed extinguished and the certificates and all other documents representing such Equity Interests shall be deemed cancelled and of no force and effect.
ARTICLE XXVI
PROVISION FOR TREATMENT OF DISPUTED CLAIMS AND
DISPUTED EQUITY INTERESTS
26.1
Objections to Claims; Prosecution of Disputed Claims and Disputed Equity Interests
:
The Liquidating Trustee shall object to, and shall assume any pending objection filed by the Debtors to, the allowance of Claims and Equity Interests filed with the Bankruptcy Court with respect to which it disputes liability, priority or amount, including, without limitation, objections to Claims and Equity Interests that have been assigned and the assertion of the doctrine of equitable subordination with respect thereto. All objections, affirmative defenses and counterclaims shall be litigated to Final Order;
provided
,
however
, that the Liquidating Trustee shall have the authority to file, settle, compromise or withdraw any objections to Claims or Equity Interests. Unless otherwise ordered by the Bankruptcy Court, to
the extent not already objected to by the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee shall file and serve all objections to Claims and Equity Interests as soon as practicable, but, in each instance, not later than one hundred eighty (180) days following the Effective Date or such later date as may be approved by the Bankruptcy Court.
26.2
Estimation of Claims
:
On and after the Effective Date, and unless otherwise limited by an order of the Bankruptcy Court, the Liquidating Trustee may at any time request the Bankruptcy Court to estimate for final distribution purposes any contingent, unliquidated or Disputed Claim pursuant to section 502(c) of the Bankruptcy Code regardless of whether the Debtors previously objected to or sought to estimate such Claim, and the Bankruptcy Court will retain jurisdiction to consider any request to estimate any Claim at any time during litigation concerning any objection to any Claim, including, without limitation, during the pendency of any appeal relating to any such objection. Unless otherwise provided in an order of the Bankruptcy Court, in the event that the Bankruptcy Court estimates any contingent, unliquidated or Disputed Claim, the estimated amount shall constitute either the allowed amount of such Claim or a maximum limitation on such Claim, as determined by the Bankruptcy Court;
provided
,
however
, that, if the estimate constitutes the maximum limitation on such Claim, the Liquidating Trustee may elect to pursue supplemental proceedings to object to any ultimate allowance of such Claim; and,
provided
,
further
, that the foregoing is not intended to limit the rights granted by section 502(j) of the Bankruptcy Code. All of the aforementioned Claims objection, estimation and resolution procedures are cumulative and not necessarily exclusive of one another;
provided
,
however
, that in no event shall any such procedure increase or expand payment or performance from JPMC for any JPMC Assumed Liabilities.
26.3
Payments and Distributions on Disputed Claims and Disputed Equity Interests
:
(a)
Disputed Claims Holdback
. From and after the Effective Date, and until such time as each Disputed Claim has been compromised and settled, estimated by the Bankruptcy Court in an amount constituting the allowed amount, or allowed or disallowed by Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court, the Liquidating Trustee shall retain, for the benefit of each holder of a Disputed Claim, Creditor Cash (which the Disbursing Agent shall transfer to the Liquidating Trustee), Liquidating Trust Interests, and, to the extent elected by such holder, Runoff Notes and Reorganized Common Stock, and any dividends, gains or income attributable in respect of any of the foregoing, in an amount equal to the Pro Rata Share of distributions that would have been made to the holder of such Disputed Claim if it were an Allowed Claim in an amount equal to the lesser of (i) the liquidated amount set forth in the filed proof of Claim relating to such Disputed Claim, (ii) the amount in which the Disputed Claim shall be estimated by the Bankruptcy Court pursuant to section 502 of the Bankruptcy Code constitutes and represents the maximum amount in which such Claim may ultimately become an Allowed Claim, and (iii) such other amount as may be agreed upon by the holder of such Disputed Claim and the Liquidating Trustee;
provided
,
however
, that the recovery by any holder of a Disputed Claim shall not exceed the lesser of (i), (ii) and (iii) above. Any Creditor Cash, Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes and Reorganized Common Stock retained and held for the benefit of a holder of a Disputed Claim shall be treated as a payment and reduction on account of such Disputed Claim for purposes of computing any additional amounts to be paid in Cash or distributed in Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes or Reorganized Common Stock in the
event the Disputed Claim ultimately becomes an Allowed Claim. Such Creditor Cash and any dividends, gains or income paid on account of the Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes and the Reorganized Common Stock (if any) retained for the benefit of holders of Disputed Claims shall be retained by the Liquidating Trust for the benefit of such holders pending determination of their entitlement thereto under the terms of the Plan. To the extent that the Liquidating Trust retains Runoff Notes or Reorganized Common Stock on behalf of Disputed Claim holders, until such time as such stock is distributed, the Liquidating Trustee shall exercise voting or consent rights with respect to such stock;
provided
,
however
, that the Liquidating Trustee shall be obligated to vote or consent, as the case may be, as to such stock in the same proportion as all other holders of issued and distributed Reorganized Common Stock have voted or consented, in each case on an issue-by-issue basis.
(b)
Allowance of Disputed Claims
. At such time as a Disputed Claim becomes, in whole or in part, an Allowed Claim, the Liquidating Trustee shall distribute to the holder thereof the distributions, if any, to which such holder is then entitled under the Plan, together with any earnings that has accrued on the amount of Creditor Cash, Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes and Reorganized Common Stock so retained (net of any expenses, including any taxes, relating thereto), but only to the extent that such earnings are attributable to the amount of the Allowed Claim. Such distribution, if any, shall be made as soon as practicable after the date that the order or judgment of the Bankruptcy Court allowing such Disputed Claim becomes a Final Order, but in no event more than ninety (90) days thereafter. The balance of any Creditor Cash, Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes and Reorganized Common Stock previously retained but not distributed to a Disputed Claim holder shall be included in future calculations of Cash, Liquidating Trust Interests, Runoff Notes and Reorganized Common Stock, respectively, to holders of Allowed Claims.
(c)
Tax Treatment of Retained Assets on Account of Disputed Claims
. The Liquidating Trustee shall treat any Assets retained pursuant to this Section 26.3 as part of the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve.
(d)
Disputed Equity Escrow
. From and after the Effective Date, (i) until such time as the Dime Warrant Litigation is determined, pursuant to a Final Order, or a compromise and settlement is approved, pursuant to a Final Order, by the Bankruptcy Court with respect to the Dime Warrant Litigation, there shall be held in the Disputed Equity Escrow by the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, for the benefit of each holder of a Dime Warrant, Reorganized Common Stock, and any dividends, gains or income attributable in respect of such Reorganized Common Stock, in an amount equal to the Pro Rata Share of Reorganized Common Stock that would have been made to the holders of Dime Warrants if such Dime Warrants were Allowed Equity Interests in an amount equal to the lesser of (1) the amount estimated by the Bankruptcy Court as the maximum amount in which the Disputed Claims relating to the Dime Warrants may ultimately become Allowed Claims
times
the per share price of Common Equity Interests on a date established by the Bankruptcy Court bears to the market capitalization of all other Common Equity Interests (as determined by the Bankruptcy Court using such same per share price), (2) the liquidated amount determined, pursuant to an order of the Bankruptcy Court, as the amount in which the Disputed Claims relating to the Dime Warrants are Allowed Claims
times
the per share price of Common Equity Interests on a date established by the Bankruptcy Court bears to the market capitalization of all other Common Equity Interests (as determined by
the Bankruptcy Court using such same per share price), (3) the amount established by the United States Court of Federal Claims in the Anchor Litigation, pursuant to a Final Order, as applied in connection with the Dime Warrant Litigation,
times
the per share price of Common Equity Interests on a date established by the Bankruptcy Court bears to the market capitalization of all other Common Equity Interests (as determined by the Bankruptcy Court using such same per share price) and (4) such other amount as may be agreed upon by the plaintiffs in the Dime Warrant Litigation and the Liquidating Trustee;
provided
,
however
, the recovery in connection with the Dime Warrant Litigation shall not exceed the lesser of (1), (2), (3) and (4) above, and (ii) until such time, or from time to time, as each Disputed Equity Interest has been compromised and settled or allowed or disallowed by Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court, there shall be held in the Disputed Equity Escrow by the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, for the benefit of each holder of a Disputed Equity Interest, Reorganized Common Stock and any dividends, gains or income attributable in respect of such Reorganized Common Stock, in an amount equal to the Pro Rata Share of distributions that would have been made to the holder of such Disputed Equity Interest if it were an Allowed Equity Interest. To the extent that the Liquidating Trustee retains any such Reorganized Common Stock, until such time as such stock is distributed, the Liquidating Trustee shall exercise voting or consent rights with respect to such stock;
provided
,
however
, that the Liquidating Trustee shall be obligated to vote or consent, as the case may be, as to such stock in the same proportion as all other holders of issued and distributed Reorganized Common Stock have voted or consented, in each case on an issue-by-issue basis. Apart from the Liquidating Trustee serving as escrow agent, the Disputed Equity Escrow shall be separate and distinct from the Liquidating Trust (and the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve), and the assets therein shall not comprise part of the Liquidating Trust Assets.
(e)
Determinations With Respect to Disputed Equity Interests
. At such time as it is determined, pursuant to a Final Order, that (1) the holders of the Dime Warrants hold Allowed Claims, and such Allowed Claims are not otherwise subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code, the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, shall distribute to the holders of Common Equity Interests entitled to receive a distribution in accordance with the provisions of Section 25.1 hereof, on a pro rata basis, the shares of the Reorganized Common Stock, together with any dividends, gains or income attributable thereto, in the Disputed Equity Escrow and (2) the holders of Dime Warrants hold Equity Interests or Allowed Claims, and Allowed Claims are otherwise subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code, the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, shall distribute to the holders of Dime Warrants the shares of Reorganized Common Stock, together with any dividends, gains or income attributable thereto in the Disputed Equity Escrow. At such time as any other Disputed Equity Interest becomes, in whole or in part, an Allowed Equity Interest, the Liquidating Trustee shall distribute to the holder thereof the distributions, if any, to which such holder is then entitled under the Plan, together with any dividends, gains or income attributable thereto. To the extent a Disputed Equity Interest is disallowed, in whole or in part, the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, shall distribute to the holders of Common Equity Interests entitled to receive a distribution in accordance with the provisions of Sections 24.1 and 25.1 of the Plan, on a pro rata basis, the shares of Reorganized Common Stock, together with any dividends, gains or income attributable thereto, allocable to such Disputed Equity Interest. to the extent of such disallowance. Such distributions shall be made as soon as practicable after the date that the order or judgment of the
Bankruptcy Court with respect to the Dime Warrant Litigation becomes a Final Order, but in no event more than ninety (90) days thereafter.
(f)
Tax Treatment of Disputed Equity Escrow
.
(1)
Subject to definitive guidance from the IRS or a court of competent jurisdiction to the contrary (including the receipt by the Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, of a private letter ruling if the Liquidating Trustee so requests one, or the receipt of an adverse determination by the IRS upon audit if not contested by the Liquidating Trustee), the Liquidating Trustee shall (A) treat the Disputed Equity Escrow as “disputed ownership fund” governed by Treasury Regulation section 1.468B-9 (and make any appropriate elections), and (B) to the extent permitted by applicable law, report consistently wit the foregoing for state and local income tax purposes. All parties (including the Liquidating Trustee, the Debtors, and the holders of Dime Warrants and Disputed Equity Interests) shall report for United States federal, state and local income tax purposes consistently wit the foregoing.
(2)
The Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, shall be responsible for payment, out of the assets of the Disputed Equity Escrow, of any Taxes imposed on the escrow or its assets. In the event, and to the extent, any Cash in the Disputed Equity Escrow is insufficient to pay the portion of any such Taxes attributable to the taxable income arising from the assets of the escrow (including any income that may arise upon the distribution of the assets in the escrow), assets of the escrow may be sold to pay such Taxes.
(3)
The Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, may request an expedited determination of Taxes of the Disputed Equity Escrow under section 505(b) of the Bankruptcy Code for all Tax Returns for all taxable periods through the termination of the escrow.
(4)
The Liquidating Trustee, as escrow agent, shall have the same rights and powers, subject to the same limitations, with respect to withholding on distributions of the assets of the Disputed Equity Escrow as the Liquidating Trustee possesses with respect to the Liquidating Trust, as provided in Section 27.14(c) of the Plan.
ARTICLE XXVII
THE LIQUIDATING TRUST
27.1
Execution of Liquidating Trust Agreement
:
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors and the Liquidating Trustee shall execute the Liquidating Trust Agreement, and shall take all other necessary steps to establish the Liquidating Trust and the Liquidating Trust Interests therein, which shall be for the benefit of the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries, as
provided in Sections 6.1, 7.1, 16.1, 16.2, 18.1, 19.1, 20.1 and 22.1, and, in certain circumstances, 23.1, 24.1 and 25.1 of the Plan, whether their Claims are Allowed before, on or after the Effective Date. The Liquidating Trust Agreement may provide powers, duties, and authorities in addition to those explicitly stated herein, but only to the extent that such powers, duties, and authorities do not affect the status of the Liquidating Trust as a “liquidating trust” for United States federal income tax purposes.
27.2
Purpose of the Liquidating Trust
:
The Liquidating Trust shall be established for the sole purpose of liquidating and distributing its assets, in accordance with Treasury Regulation section 301.7701-4(d), with no objective to continue or engage in the conduct of a trade or business.
27.3
Liquidating Trust Assets
:
The Liquidating Trust shall consist of the Liquidating Trust Assets. On the Effective Date, the Debtors shall transfer all of the Liquidating Trust Assets to the Liquidating Trust. The Liquidating Trust Assets may be transferred subject to certain liabilities, as provided in the Plan or the Liquidating Trust Agreement. Such transfer shall be exempt from any stamp, real estate transfer, mortgage reporting, sales, use or other similar Tax, pursuant to section 1146(a) of the Bankruptcy Code. Upon delivery of the Liquidating Trust Assets to the Liquidating Trust, the Debtors and their predecessors, successors and assigns, and each other Entity released pursuant to Section 41.5 herein shall be discharged and released from all liability with respect to the delivery of such distributions. In addition, the Liquidating Trust shall assume all of WMI’s rights and obligations pursuant to Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement, and WMI shall have no further liability or obligations thereunder, to the extent that the transfer to the Liquidating Trust shall not impose any additional obligations or liabilities on JPMC.
27.4
Administration of the Liquidating Trust
:
The Liquidating Trust shall be administered by the Liquidating Trustee according to the Liquidating Trust Agreement and the Plan. In the event of any inconsistency between the Plan and the Liquidating Trust Agreement, the Liquidating Trust Agreement shall govern.
27.5
The Liquidating Trustee
:
In the event the Liquidating Trustee dies, is terminated, or resigns for any reason, the Trust Advisory Board shall designate a successor;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstance shall the Liquidating Trustee be a director or officer with respect to any Affiliate of the Liquidating Trust.
27.6
Role of the Liquidating Trustee
:
In furtherance of and consistent with the purpose of the Liquidating Trust and the Plan, and subject to the terms of the Confirmation Order, the Plan and the Liquidating Trust Agreement, and the oversight of the Trust Advisory Board, the Liquidating Trustee shall, among other things, have the following rights, powers and duties, in each case subject to the Global Settlement Agreement: (i) to hold, manage, convert to Cash, and distribute the Liquidating Trust Assets, including prosecuting and resolving the Claims belonging to the Liquidating Trust, (ii) to hold the Liquidating Trust Assets for the benefit of the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries, whether their Claims are Allowed on or after the Effective Date, (iii) in the Liquidating Trustee’s reasonable business judgment, to investigate, prosecute, settle and/or abandon rights, causes of action, or litigation of the Liquidating Trust, including, without limitation, Avoidance Actions, (iv) to monitor and enforce the implementation of the Plan, (v) to
file all tax and regulatory forms, returns, reports, and other documents required with respect to the Liquidating Trust, (vi) in the Liquidating Trustee’s reasonable business judgment, to object to Claims, and manage, control, prosecute, and/or settle on behalf of the Liquidating Trust, objections to Claims on account of which the Liquidating Trustee (as Disbursing Agent) will be responsible (if Allowed) for making distributions under the Plan, (vii) to take all actions necessary and create any document necessary to implement the Plan, (viii) to hold, manage, and distribute Cash or non-Cash Liquidating Trust Assets obtained through the exercise of its power and authority, (ix) to act as a signatory to the Debtors for all purposes, including those associated with the novation of contracts or other obligations arising out of the sales of the Debtors’ assets, and (x) to take all necessary actions and file all appropriate motions to obtain an order closing the Chapter 11 Cases. In all circumstances, the Liquidating Trustee shall comply with all of the Debtors’ obligations under the Global Settlement Agreement and in accordance with applicable law, and otherwise shall act in the best interests of all Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries and in furtherance of the purpose of the Liquidating Trust. Under no circumstance may the Liquidating Trustee serve on the Board of Directors of any Affiliate of the Liquidating Trust.
27.7
Liquidating Trustee’s Tax Power for Debtors
:
(a)
Following the Effective Date, the Liquidating Trustee shall prepare and file (or cause to be prepared and filed), on behalf of the Debtors, all Tax Returns required to be filed or that the Liquidating Trustee otherwise deems appropriate, including the filing of amended Tax Returns or requests for refunds for all taxable periods ended on or before December 31, 2009.
(b)
For all taxable periods ended on or before December 31, 2009, the Liquidating Trustee shall have full and exclusive authority and responsibility in respect of all Taxes of the Debtors (including, without limitation, as the common parent or other agent of any consolidated, combined or unitary tax group of which the Debtors were the agent), to the same extent as if the Liquidating Trustee was the Debtor-in-Possession. Without limiting the foregoing, each of the Debtors shall execute, on or prior to the Effective Date, a power of attorney authorizing the Liquidating Trustee to correspond with any Authority on behalf of such Debtor and to sign, collect, negotiate, settle, and administer Tax payments and Tax Returns.
(c)
In furtherance of the transfer of the Liquidating Trust Assets to the Liquidating Trust on the Effective Date, the Liquidating Trust shall be entitled to all Tax Refunds of the Debtors (and the Liquidating Trust bears responsibility for (i) all Tax liabilities of the Debtors for taxable years ended on or before December 31, 2009, to the extent not discharged by the Plan or provided for payment in the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement and (ii) WMI’s obligations pursuant to Section 2.4 of the Global Settlement Agreement), it being understood that the Liquidating Trustee only shall have whatever rights WMI itself has pursuant to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement and the Liquidating Trustee shall be contractually bound to all restrictions in the Global Settlement Agreement with respect to tax filings.
27.8
Transferability of Liquidating Trust Interests
:
The Liquidating Trust Interests shall not be transferable or assignable except by will, intestate succession or operation of law.
27.9
Cash
:
The Liquidating Trustee may invest Cash (including any earnings thereon or proceeds therefrom) as permitted by section 345 of the Bankruptcy Code;
provided
,
however
, that such investments are investments permitted to be made by a liquidating trust within the meaning of Treasury Regulation section 301.7701-4(d), as reflected therein, or under applicable IRS guidelines, rulings, or other controlling authorities.
27.10
Distribution of Liquidating Trust Assets
:
The Liquidating Trustee shall distribute to the holders of Allowed Claims on account of their Liquidating Trust Interests, on a quarterly basis, all unrestricted Cash on hand (including any Cash received from the Debtors on the Effective Date, and treating any permissible investment as Cash for purposes of this Section 27.10), except (i) Cash reserved pursuant to the Liquidating Trust Agreement to fund the activities of the Liquidating Trust, (ii) such amounts as are allocable to or retained on account of Disputed Claims in accordance with Section 26.3 of the Plan, and (iii) such additional amounts as are reasonably necessary to (A) meet contingent liabilities and to maintain the value of the Liquidating Trust Assets during liquidation, (B) pay reasonable incurred or anticipated expenses (including, but not limited to, any Taxes imposed on or payable by the Debtors or the Liquidating Trust or in respect of the Liquidating Trust Assets), or (C) as are necessary to satisfy other liabilities incurred or anticipated by the Liquidating Trust in accordance with the Plan, the Global Settlement Agreement, or the Liquidating Trust Agreement;
provided
,
however
, that, and subject to the distribution of Runoff Notes as may be required in accordance with the provisions of Section 31.14 of the Plan, the Liquidating Trustee shall not be required to make a distribution pursuant to this Section 27.10 if the aggregate, net amount of unrestricted Cash available for distribution (taking into account the above listed exclusions) is such as would make the distribution impracticable as reasonably determined by the Liquidating Trustee, with the consent of the Trust Advisory Board, in accordance with applicable law, and so long as such aggregate amount is less than Twenty-Five Million Dollars ($25,000,000.00); and,
provided
,
further
, that the Liquidating Trustee, with the consent of the Trust Advisory Board, may decide to forego the first quarterly distribution to those holders of Liquidating Trust Interests with respect to which the Liquidating Trustee, in its reasonable judgment, is not administratively prepared to make such distribution, in which case, such distribution shall be made to such holders as soon as practicable after the Liquidating Trustee is administratively prepared to do so.
27.11
Costs and Expenses of the Liquidating Trust
:
The reasonable costs and expenses of the Liquidating Trust, including the fees and expenses of the Liquidating Trustee and its retained professionals, shall be paid out of the Liquidating Trust Assets. Fees and expenses incurred in connection with the prosecution and settlement of any Claims shall be considered costs and expenses of the Liquidating Trust.
27.12
Compensation of the Liquidating Trustee
:
The individual(s) serving as or comprising the Liquidating Trustee shall be entitled to reasonable compensation in an amount consistent with that of similar functionaries in similar roles, the payment of which shall be subject to the approval of the Bankruptcy Court.
27.13
Retention of Professionals/Employees by the Liquidating Trustee
:
The Liquidating Trustee may retain and compensate attorneys, other professionals, and employees to assist in its duties as Liquidating Trustee on such terms as the Liquidating Trustee deems appropriate without Bankruptcy Court approval. The Liquidating Trustee may assume
existing contracts and/or leases that WMI is party to, including, without limitation, employment agreements, or may enter into new arrangements on substantially similar terms. Without limiting the foregoing, the Liquidating Trustee may retain any professional that represented parties in interest in the Chapter 11 Cases.
27.14
Federal Income Tax Treatment of the Liquidating Trust
:
(a)
Liquidating Trust Assets Treated as Owned by Creditors
. For all United States federal income tax purposes, all parties (including, without limitation, the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries) shall treat the transfer of the Liquidating Trust Assets to the Liquidating Trust as (1) a transfer of the Liquidating Trust Assets (subject to any obligations relating to those assets) directly to the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries and, to the extent Liquidating Trust Assets are allocable to Disputed Claims, to the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve, followed by (2) the transfer by such beneficiaries to the Liquidating Trust of the Liquidating Trust Assets (other than the Liquidating Trust Assets allocable to the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve) in exchange for Liquidating Trust Interests. Accordingly, the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries shall be treated for United States federal income tax purposes as the grantors and owners of their respective share of the Liquidating Trust Assets (other than such Liquidating Trust Assets as are allocable to the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve, discussed below). The foregoing treatment shall also apply, to the extent permitted by applicable law, for state and local income tax purposes.
(b)
Tax Reporting
.
(1)
The Liquidating Trustee shall file Tax Returns for the Liquidating Trust treating the Liquidating Trust as a grantor trust pursuant to Treasury Regulation section 1.671-4(a) and in accordance with this Section 27.14. The Liquidating Trustee also will annually send to each holder of a Liquidating Trust Interest a separate statement regarding the receipts and expenditures of the Liquidating Trust as relevant for U.S. federal income tax purposes and will instruct all such holders to use such information in preparing their U.S. federal income tax returns or to forward the appropriate information to such holder’s underlying beneficial holders with instructions to utilize such information in preparing their U.S. federal income tax returns. The Liquidating Trustee shall also file (or cause to be filed) any other statement, return or disclosure relating to the Liquidating Trust that is required by any governmental unit.
(2)
On or before the Effective Date, the Debtors shall provide the Liquidating Trustee with a good-faith valuation of the Tax Refunds as of the Effective Date. The Liquidating Trustee will then in good faith value all other Liquidating Trust Assets, and shall make all such values (including the Tax Refund values) available from time to time, to the extent relevant, and such values shall be used consistently by all parties to the Liquidating Trust (including, without limitation, the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries) for all United States federal income tax purposes.
(3)
Allocations of Liquidating Trust taxable income among the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries (other than taxable income allocable to the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve) shall be determined by reference to the manner in which an amount of cash representing such taxable income would be distributed (were such cash permitted to be distributed at such time) if, immediately prior to such deemed distribution, the Liquidating Trust had distributed all its assets (valued at their tax book value, and other than assets allocable to the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve) to the holders of the Liquidating Trust Interests, adjusted for prior taxable income and loss and taking into account all prior and concurrent distributions from the Liquidating Trust. Similarly, taxable loss of the Liquidating Trust shall be allocated by reference to the manner in which an economic loss would be borne immediately after a hypothetical liquidating distribution of the remaining Liquidating Trust Assets. The tax book value of the Liquidating Trust Assets for purpose of this paragraph shall equal their fair market value on the Effective Date, adjusted in accordance with tax accounting principles prescribed by the IRC, the applicable Treasury Regulations, and other applicable administrative and judicial authorities and pronouncements.
(4)
Subject to definitive guidance from the IRS or a court of competent jurisdiction to the contrary (including the receipt by the Liquidating Trustee of a private letter ruling if the Liquidating Trustee so requests one, or the receipt of an adverse determination by the IRS upon audit if not contested by the Liquidating Trustee), the Liquidating Trustee shall (A) timely elect to treat any Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve as a “disputed ownership fund” governed by Treasury Regulation section 1.468B-9, and (B) to the extent permitted by applicable law, report consistently with the foregoing for state and local income tax purposes. All parties (including the Liquidating Trustee, the Debtors, and the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries) shall report for United States federal, state and local income tax purposes consistently with the foregoing.
(5)
The Liquidating Trustee shall be responsible for payment, out of the Liquidating Trust Assets, of any Taxes imposed on the trust or its assets, including the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve. In the event, and to the extent, any Cash retained on account of Disputed Claims in the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve is insufficient to pay the portion of any such Taxes attributable to the taxable income arising from the assets allocable to, or retained on account of, Disputed Claims (including any income that may arise upon the distribution of the assets of the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve), such Taxes may be (i) reimbursed from any subsequent Cash amounts retained on account of Disputed Claims, or (ii) to the extent such Disputed Claims have subsequently been resolved, deducted from any amounts otherwise distributable by the Liquidating Trustee as a result of the resolution of such Disputed Claims.
(6)
The Liquidating Trustee may request an expedited determination of Taxes of the Liquidating Trust, including the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve, or the Debtors under section 505(b) of the Bankruptcy Code for all Tax Returns filed for, or on behalf of, the Liquidating Trust or the Debtors for all taxable periods through the dissolution of the Liquidating Trust.
(c)
Tax Withholdings by Liquidating Trustee
. The Liquidating Trustee may withhold and pay to the appropriate Tax Authority all amounts required to be withheld pursuant to the IRC or any provision of any foreign, state or local tax law with respect to any payment or distribution to the holders of Liquidating Trust Interests. All such amounts withheld and paid to the appropriate Tax Authority (or placed in escrow pending resolution of the need to withhold) shall be treated as amounts distributed to such holders of Liquidating Trust Interests for all purposes of the Liquidating Trust Agreement. The Liquidating Trustee shall be authorized to collect such tax information from the holders of Liquidating Trust Interests (including, without limitation, social security numbers or other tax identification numbers) as in its sole discretion the Liquidating Trustee deems necessary to effectuate the Plan, the Confirmation Order, and the Liquidating Trust Agreement. In order to receive distributions under the Plan, all holders of Liquidating Trust Interests (including, without limitation, (i) holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed Late-Filed Claims, Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Preferred Equity Interests, Allowed Common Equity Interests and holders of Dime Warrants and (ii) Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders, who, in each case, deliver a release in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan) shall be required to identify themselves to the Liquidating Trustee and provide tax information and the specifics of their holdings, to the extent the Liquidating Trustee deems appropriate in the manner and in accordance with the procedures from time to time established by the Liquidating Trustee for these purposes. This identification requirement generally applies to all holders, including those who hold their securities in street name. The Liquidating Trustee may refuse to make a distribution to any holder of a Liquidating Trust Interest that fails to furnish such information in a timely fashion, and until such information is delivered, and may treat such holder’s Liquidating Trust Interests as disputed;
provided
,
however
, that, if such information is not furnished to the Liquidating Trustee within six (6) months of the original request to furnish such information, no further distributions shall be made to the holder of such Liquidating Trust Interest; and,
provided
,
further
, that, upon the delivery of such information by a holder of a Liquidating Trust Interest, the Liquidating Trustee shall make such distribution to which the holder of the Liquidating Trust Interest is entitled, without additional interest occasioned by such holder’s delay in providing tax information; and,
provided
,
further
that, if the Liquidating Trustee fails to withhold in respect of amounts received or distributable with respect to any such holder and the Liquidating Trustee is later held liable for the amount of such withholding, such holder shall reimburse the Liquidating Trustee for such liability (to the extent such amounts were actually distributed to such holder).
(d)
Dissolution
. The Liquidating Trustee and the Liquidating Trust shall be discharged or dissolved, as the case may be, upon the earlier to occur of (i) all of the Liquidating Trust Assets have been distributed pursuant to the Plan and the Liquidating Trust Agreement, (ii) the Liquidating Trustee determines, with the consent of the Trust Advisory
Board, that the administration of any remaining Liquidating Trust Assets is not likely to yield sufficient additional Liquidating Trust proceeds to justify further pursuit, and (iii) all distributions required to be made by the Liquidating Trustee under the Plan and the Liquidating Trust Agreement have been made;
provided
,
however
, in no event shall the Liquidating Trust be dissolved later than three (3) years from the Effective Date unless the Bankruptcy Court, upon motion within the six-month period prior to the third (3rd) anniversary (or within the six-month period prior to the end of an extension period), determines that a fixed period extension (not to exceed three (3) years, together with any prior extensions, without a favorable private letter ruling from the IRS or an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the Liquidating Trustee and the Trust Advisory Board that any further extension would not adversely affect the status of the trust as a liquidating trust for United States federal income tax purposes) is necessary to facilitate or complete the recovery and liquidation of the Liquidating Trust Assets. If at any time the Liquidating Trustee determines, in reliance upon such professionals as the Liquidating Trustee may retain, that the expense of administering the Liquidating Trust so as to make a final distribution to its beneficiaries is likely to exceed the value of the assets remaining in the Liquidating Trust, the Liquidating Trustee may apply to the Bankruptcy Court for authority to (i) reserve any amount necessary to dissolve the Liquidating Trust, (ii) donate any balance to a charitable organization (A) described in section 501(c)(3) of the IRC, (B) exempt from United States federal income tax under section 501(a) of the IRC, (C) not a “private foundation”, as defined in section 509(a) of the IRC, and (D) that is unrelated to the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, the Liquidating Trust, and any insider of the Liquidating Trustee, and (iii) dissolve the Liquidating Trust.
27.15
Indemnification of Liquidating Trustee
:
The Liquidating Trustee or the individual(s) comprising the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, and the Liquidating Trustee’s employees, agents and professionals, shall not be liable to the Liquidating Trust Beneficiaries for actions taken or omitted in their capacity as, or on behalf of, the Liquidating Trustee, except those acts arising out of their own willful misconduct or gross negligence, and each shall be entitled to indemnification and reimbursement for fees and expenses in defending any and all actions or inactions in their capacity as, or on behalf of, the Liquidating Trustee, except for any actions or inactions involving willful misconduct or gross negligence. Any indemnification claim of the Liquidating Trustee (and the other parties entitled to indemnification under this subsection) shall be satisfied solely from the Liquidating Trust Assets and shall be entitled to a priority distribution therefrom, ahead of the Liquidating Trust Interests and any other claim to or interest in such assets. The Liquidating Trustee shall be entitled to rely, in good faith, on the advice of its retained professionals.
27.16
Privileges and Obligation to Respond to Ongoing Investigations
:
All Privileges shall be transferred, assigned, and delivered to the Liquidating Trust, without waiver, and shall vest in the Liquidating Trustee solely in its capacity as such (and any other individual the Liquidating Trustee, with the consent of the Trust Advisory Board, may designate, as well as any other individual designated in the Liquidating Trust Agreement). Pursuant to Federal Rule of Evidence 502(d) (to the extent Rule 502(d) is relevant notwithstanding the fact that the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, the FDIC Receiver and JPMC are joint holders of certain attorney-client privileges, work product protections, or other immunities or protections from disclosure), no Privileges shall be waived by disclosure to the Liquidating Trustee and the Trust Advisory Board of the Debtors’ information subject to attorney-client privileges, work product
protections, or other immunities or protections from disclosure, or by disclosure among the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver, and/or JPMC of information that is subject to attorney-client privileges, work product protections, or other immunities or protections from disclosure jointly held by the Debtors, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver, the Liquidating Trustee and/or JPMC. The Liquidating Trustee shall be obligated to respond, on behalf of the Debtors, to all Information Demands. The FDIC Receiver and JPMC shall take reasonable steps to cooperate with the Liquidating Trustee in responding to Information Demands, and such cooperation shall include, for example, taking all steps necessary to maintain and avoid waiver of any and all Privileges (including, without limitation, any Privileges that are shared jointly among or between any of the parties). The Liquidating Trustee, with the consent of the Trust Advisory Board, may waive Privileges that are held solely by the Debtors and/or the Liquidating Trust, but not jointly held with the FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC, in the event and to the extent the Liquidating Trustee, with the consent of the Trust Advisory Board, determines in good faith that doing so is in the best interests of the Liquidating Trust and its beneficiaries. The Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver and JPMC may disclose information that is subject to attorney-client privileges, work product protections, or other immunities or protections from disclosure that are jointly held with the FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC only (i) upon written permission from the Liquidating Trustee, the FDIC Receiver and JPMC, as the case may be; (ii) pursuant to an order of a court of competent jurisdiction, subject to the procedure described in the next sentence insofar as it applies; or (iii) as otherwise required by law, subject to the procedure described in the next sentence insofar as it applies. If the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver or JPMC receives a request from a third party to disclose information that is subject to attorney-client privileges, work product protections, or other immunities or protections from disclosure that are jointly held with the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC, the party or parties who receives such request will (w) pursue all reasonable steps to maintain the applicable privileges or protections from disclosure, including, if necessary, to maintain the privileges or protections from disclosure by seeking a protective order against and/or otherwise objecting to the production of such material, (x) notify the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC, as the case may be, (y) allow the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC, as the case may be, reasonable time under the circumstances to seek a protective order against and/or otherwise object to the production of such material, and (z) unless required by law, not disclose the materials in question unless and until any objection raised by the Liquidating Trustee, the Trust Advisory Board, the FDIC Receiver and/or JPMC is resolved in favor of disclosure.
ARTICLE XXVIII
PROSECUTION AND EXTINGUISHMENT OF CLAIMS HELD BY THE DEBTORS
28.1
Prosecution of Claims
:
Except as settled and released herein, from and after the Effective Date, the Liquidating Trustee shall have the exclusive right and power to litigate any Claim or Cause of Action that constituted an Asset of the Debtors or Debtors in Possession, including, without limitation, any avoidance or recovery action under section 541, 542, 544, 545, 547, 548, 549, 550, 551, or 553 of the Bankruptcy Code and any other cause of action, right to payment, or claim that may be pending on the Effective Date or instituted by the Debtors, Debtors in Possession or the Liquidating Trust thereafter, to a Final Order, and the
Liquidating Trustee may compromise and settle such claims, upon approval of the Bankruptcy Court. The net proceeds of any such litigation or settlement (after satisfaction of all costs and expenses incurred in connection therewith) shall be transferred to the Liquidating Trust for distribution in accordance with the Plan and the Liquidating Trust Agreement.
ARTICLE XXIX
ACCEPTANCE OR REJECTION OF THE PLAN; EFFECT OF
REJECTION BY ONE OR MORE CLASSES OF CLAIMS OR EQUITY INTERESTS
29.1
Impaired Classes to Vote
:
Each holder, as of the Voting Record Date, of a Claim or Equity Interest in an impaired Class not otherwise deemed to have rejected or accepted the Plan in accordance with Sections 30.3 and 30.4 of the Plan shall be entitled to vote separately to accept or reject the Plan.
29.2
Acceptance by Class of Creditors
:
An impaired Class of holders of Claims shall have accepted the Plan if the Plan is accepted by at least two-thirds (2/3) in dollar amount and more than one-half (1/2) in number of the Allowed Claims of such Class that have voted to accept or reject the Plan.
29.3
Cramdown
:
In the event that any impaired Class of Claims or Equity Interests shall fail to accept, or be deemed to reject, the Plan in accordance with section 1129(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, the Debtors reserve the right to (i) request that the Bankruptcy Court confirm the Plan in accordance with section 1129(b) of the Bankruptcy Code or (ii) subject to the consent of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC and, in the event it affects any of JPMC’s rights, obligations or liabilities, JPMC, amend the Plan.
ARTICLE XXX
IDENTIFICATION OF CLAIMS AND EQUITY
INTERESTS IMPAIRED AND NOT IMPAIRED BY THE PLAN
30.1
Impaired and Unimpaired Classes
:
Claims in Classes 1, 4, and 7
are not impaired under the Plan. Claims and Equity Interests in Classes 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 12A and 13 through 22 are impaired under the Plan.
30.2
Impaired Classes Entitled to Vote on Plan
:
The Claims and Equity Interests in Classes 2, 3, 5, 6, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 12A, 13 through 16, 17A, and 18 through 22 are impaired and receiving distributions pursuant to the Plan, and are therefore entitled to vote to accept or reject the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that, in accordance with the Original Disclosure Statement Order, entitlement to vote in Class 19 does not include the right to elect to receive any portion of the payment provided for by JPMC in Section 23.1 of the Plan.
30.3
Claims and Equity Interests Deemed to Reject
:
The Claims in Class 17B are not entitled to receive any distribution or retain their Claims pursuant to the Plan, are deemed to reject the Plan, and are not entitled to accept or reject the Plan, pursuant to section 1126(g) of the Bankruptcy Code.
30.4
Claims Deemed to Accept
:
The Claims in Classes 1, 4 and 7 are not impaired pursuant to the Plan, are deemed to accept the Plan, and are not entitled to accept or reject the Plan, pursuant to section 1126(f) of the Bankruptcy Code.
30.5
Controversy Concerning Impairment
:
In the event of a controversy as to whether any Class of Claims or Equity Interests is impaired under the Plan, the Bankruptcy Court shall, after notice and a hearing, determine such controversy.
ARTICLE XXXI
PROVISIONS GOVERNING DISTRIBUTIONS
31.1
Time and Manner of Distributions
:
Except as otherwise provided herein, distributions under the Plan shall be made to each holder of an Allowed Claim or Equity Interest as follows:
(a)
Initial Distributions of Creditor Cash and Runoff Notes
. Within ten (10) Business Days following the Effective Date, the Disbursing Agent shall distribute, or cause to be distributed, to each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim, an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, an Allowed General Unsecured Claim, an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, or an Allowed PIERS Claim, such Creditor’s share, if any, of Creditor Cash and Runoff Notes, as determined pursuant to Article VI, Article VII, Article VIII, Article XVI, Article XVIII, Article XIX, and Article XX hereof.
(b)
Allocation of Liquidating Trust Interests
. Within ten (10) Business Days after creation of the Liquidating Trust, the Disbursing Agent shall allocate, or cause to be allocated, (i) to the Liquidating Trustee on behalf of holders of Disputed Claims, (ii) to each holder of an Allowed Senior Notes Claim, an Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim, an Allowed General Unsecured Claim, an Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim, an Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim, an Allowed PIERS Claim, an Allowed Late-Filed Claim, an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim, and Postpetition Interest Claims in respect of the foregoing, and (iii) to each Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holder, such holder’s share, if any, of Liquidating Trust Interests, as determined pursuant to Article VI, Article VII, Article VIII, Article XVI, Article XVIII, Article XIX, and Article XX hereof. In addition, in the event that all Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims are paid in full, the Liquidating Trust Interests shall be redistributed to holders of Subordinated Claims and, after such Allowed Claims and Postpetition Interest Claims are paid in full, holders of Preferred Equity Interests, Dime Warrants and Common Equity Interests as set forth in Sections 23.1, 24.1 and 25.1 of the Plan.
(c)
Distribution of Cash to Holders of Certain Other Claims
. Except as otherwise provided herein, on or as soon as practicable after the later of (i) the Effective Date and (ii) the date on which such claim becomes an Allowed Claim, the Disbursing Agent shall distribute, or cause to be distributed, to each holder of an Allowed Administrative Expense Claim, an Allowed Priority Tax Claim (to the extent applicable), an Allowed Priority Non-Tax Claim, an Allowed WMI Vendor Claim, an Allowed Convenience Claim, or an Allowed Trustee Claim, such holder’s share of Cash, as determined pursuant to Article III, Article V, Article XV, Article XVII and Section 31.12 hereof.
(d)
Distribution of Reorganized Common Stock
. Subject to the provisions of Sections 26.3 and 31.14 of the Plan, within ten (10) Business Days following the Effective Date, the Disbursing Agent shall distribute, or cause to be distributed, to each holder of a Preferred Equity Interest, Dime Warrant (to the extent that holders of Dime Warrants are determined, pursuant to a Final Order, to hold Equity Interests or Allowed Claims subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code), Allowed Common Equity Interests and each holder exercising a right of election pursuant to Sections 6.2(b), 7.2(b), 16.1(b)(ii), 18.2(b), 19.2(b), 20.2 and 31.14 of the Plan, such holder’s share of Reorganized Common Stock.
31.2
Timeliness of Payments
:
Any payment or distribution to be made pursuant to the Plan shall be deemed to be timely made if made within ten (10) days after the date specified in the Plan. Whenever any distribution to be made under this Plan shall be due on a day other than a Business Day, such distribution shall instead be made, without interest, on the immediately succeeding Business Day, but shall be deemed to have been made on the date due, including, without limitation, deeming distributions made pursuant to Section 32.1(a) hereof to have been made on the Effective Date.
31.3
Distributions by the Disbursing Agent
:
All distributions under the Plan shall be made by the Disbursing Agent. The Disbursing Agent shall be deemed to hold all property to be distributed hereunder in trust for the Entities entitled to receive the same. The Disbursing Agent shall not hold an economic or beneficial interest in such property.
31.4
Manner of Payment under the Plan
:
Unless the Entity receiving a payment agrees otherwise, any payment in Cash to be made by the Disbursing Agent shall be made, at the election of the payor, by check drawn on a domestic bank or by wire transfer from a domestic bank;
provided
,
however
, that no Cash payment shall be made to a holder of an Allowed Claim or Equity Interest until such time, if ever, as the amount payable thereto is equal to or greater than Ten Dollars ($10.00).
31.5
Delivery of Distributions
:
Subject to the provisions of Rule 9010 of the Bankruptcy Rules, and except as provided in Section 31.4 hereof, distributions and deliveries to holders of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests shall be made at the address of each such holder as set forth on the Schedules filed with the Court, unless superseded by the address set forth on proofs of Claim or Equity Interests filed by such holders, or at the last known address of such holder if no proof of Claim is filed or if the Debtors have been notified in writing of a change of address;
provided
,
however
, that initial distributions of Creditor Cash by the Disbursing Agent for the benefit of holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and REIT Series, as applicable, shall be made to the appropriate Trustee (or such Trustee’s designee) under the respective governing documents for such obligations, with the REIT Series distributions to be made to the Trust Preferred Trustees for distribution to holders of the REIT Series. Each such Trustee (or such Trustee’s designee) shall, in turn, in accordance with the Plan, distribute and deliver Creditor Cash, as applicable, to those holders in whose name Senior Notes, Senior Subordinated Notes, CCB-1 Common Securities, CCB-1 Preferred Securities, CCB-2 Common Securities, CCB-2 Preferred Securities, PIERS Common Securities, PIERS Preferred Securities, and REIT Series representing Allowed Claims are registered, in the
applicable Trustees’ books and records, on the Distribution Record Date, in the manner provided for in the applicable Indenture and other governing documents. The Trustees may conclusively rely upon the distribution instructions received from the Debtors or their agents with respect to contra-CUSIP positions and escrow positions set up by the Debtors or their agents with the Depository Trust Company, and the Trustees shall close and terminate the original CUSIPS after making initial distributions of Creditor Cash and shall have no further distribution obligations thereafter. The Trustees shall not be required to give any bond or surety or other security for the performance of their duties, unless otherwise ordered by the Court. The Trustees shall only be required to make the distributions and deliveries described in this Section 31.5 and shall be only required to make such distributions and deliveries in accordance with the terms of the Confirmation Order and the Plan and shall have no liability for actions taken in accordance with the Confirmation Order, the Plan or in reliance upon information provided to the Trustees in accordance with the Confirmation Order, the Plan or in connection with distributions to be made hereunder and thereunder, except for liabilities resulting from their own gross negligence or willful misconduct. Initial distributions of Reorganized Common Stock and Liquidating Trust Interests by the Disbursing Agent for the benefit of holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and REIT Series, as applicable, will be made by the Disbursing Agent directly to such holders, upon consent of the applicable Trustee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld. Subsequent distributions to holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, Allowed PIERS Claims, and REIT Series on account of Liquidating Trust Interests (or such holders’ transferees) that have identified themselves to the Liquidating Trustee, to the extent the Liquidating Trustee deems appropriate, will be the responsibility of the Liquidating Trustee as Disbursing Agent. Notwithstanding the foregoing, all distributions are subject to the Lien and priority rights of the Trustees. The Debtors, their agents and servicers, the Disbursing Agent and the Trustees shall have no obligation to recognize any transfer of Senior Notes Claims, Senior Notes, Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Senior Subordinated Notes, CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, CCB-1 Guarantees, CCB-1 Common Securities, CCB-1 Preferred Securities, CCB-2 Guarantees Claims, CCB-2 Guarantees, CCB-2 Common Securities, CCB-2 Preferred Securities, PIERS Claims, PIERS Common Securities, PIERS Preferred Securities, REIT Series, Preferred Equity Interests, Dime Warrants and Common Equity Interests occurring after the Distribution Record Date.
31.6
Undeliverable/Reserved Distributions
:
(a)
(1)
Holding of Undeliverable Distributions by the Disbursing Agent
. If any distribution to any holder is returned to the Disbursing Agent as undeliverable, no further distribution shall be made to such holder unless and until the Disbursing Agent is notified, in writing, of such holder’s then-current address. Undeliverable distributions shall remain in the possession of the Disbursing Agent until such time as a distribution becomes deliverable. All Entities ultimately receiving undeliverable Cash shall not be entitled to any interest or other accruals of any kind. Nothing contained in the Plan shall require the Disbursing Agent to attempt to locate any holder of an Allowed Claim or Equity Interest.
(2)
Holding of Undeliverable Distributions by the Liquidating Trustee
. In connection with distributions to be made pursuant to the
Liquidating Trust Agreement, an “undeliverable” distribution shall include, without limitation, a check that is sent to a holder in respect of a distribution to such holder, which check has not been negotiated within six (6) months following the issuance thereof. Subject to the provisions of Section 31.6(c) of the Plan, if any distribution to a holder of a Liquidating Trust Interest is undeliverable, no additional distribution shall be made to such holder unless and until the Liquidating Trustee (or its duly authorized agent) is notified, in writing, of such holder’s then-current address. Undeliverable distributions shall remain in the possession of the Liquidating Trustee (or its duly authorized agent) until such time as a distribution becomes deliverable or as set forth in Section 31.6(b) of the Plan. All Entities ultimately receiving an undeliverable distribution shall not be entitled to any interest or other accruals of any kind on account of the delay in payment resulting from the undeliverable status of such distribution. Except as required by law, the Liquidating Trustee (or its duly authorized agent) shall not be required to attempt to locate any holder of a Liquidating Trust Interest.
(b)
Failure to Claim Undeliverable Distributions
. If (i) a check is sent, by either the Disbursing Agent or the Liquidating Trustee, to a holder in respect of distributions and such check is not negotiated within six (6) months following the date on which such check was issued, or (ii) any other form of distribution to a holder is otherwise undeliverable, the Disbursing Agent or the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, (or their duly authorized agent) shall, on or prior to the date that is one hundred eighty (180) days from (i) the Effective Date, with respect to all Allowed Claims as of the Effective Date, and (ii) the date that a distribution is made with respect to any Disputed Claim that becomes an Allowed Claim subsequent to the Effective Date, file a list with the Bankruptcy Court setting forth the names of those Entities for which distributions have been made hereunder that have not been negotiated or have been returned as undeliverable as of the date thereof. Any holder of an Allowed Claim or Equity Interest on such list that does not identify itself and assert its rights pursuant to the Plan to receive a distribution within one (1) year from the date so listed shall have its entitlement to such undeliverable distribution discharged and shall be forever barred from asserting any entitlement pursuant to the Plan, against the Reorganized Debtors, the Liquidating Trust, the Liquidating Trustee, the Trustees, or their respective professionals, agents, or property. In such case, the Liquidating Trustee is authorized to permanently remove such holder and its corresponding Claim and/or Trust Interest from such trustee’s books and records and any consideration held for distribution on account of such Allowed Claim or Equity Interest shall revert to such trustee for redistribution to holders of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the terms and provisions hereof.
(c)
Reserve Pending Delivery of Third Party Release
. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, in the event that a holder of a Claim entitled to a distribution hereunder fails to execute and deliver prior to the Ballot Date the third party release required in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan (other than (a) holders that affirmatively elect to opt out of granting the releases provided in Section 41.6 and (b) holders of Claims in Class 17A and Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders), (i) from and after the Effective Date, the Disbursing Agent or the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be,
shall reserve amounts of Creditor Cash and Liquidating Trust Interests (but not Runoff Notes) otherwise to be distributed to such holder, (ii) provided that a third party release is not executed and delivered by such holder to the Liquidating Trustee prior to the three (3), six (6) and nine (9) month anniversary of the Effective Date, on or prior to the fifth (5th) Business Day following any such date, the Liquidating Trustee shall serve a notice (together with a form of release) upon such holder, either directly or indirectly through such holder’s nominee, informing such holder of such reserved distribution and the requirement of such holder to execute and deliver such third party release to the appropriate trustee prior to delivery of such reserved distribution, and (iii) in the event that, on or prior to the one (1) year anniversary of the Effective Date, such holder fails to execute and deliver such third party release to the appropriate trustee, then, such trustee shall be deemed authorized to permanently remove such holder and its corresponding Claim from such trustee’s books and records and any consideration held for distribution on account of such Allowed Claim shall revert to the Liquidating Trustee for redistribution to holders of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the terms and provisions hereof. Without in any way limiting the foregoing, release elections, whether submitted in accordance with this Section 31.6(c) or otherwise, will not be accepted during the period between the Ballot Date and the Effective Date, and any release election submitted during such period shall not be recognized and shall be deemed null and void. In the event that a holder of a Claim seeks to receive and execute a release form in accordance with this provision at any time from and after the Effective Date, but other than pursuant to the periodic notices to be distributed as set forth above, then such holder may, following the Effective Date, submit a request, in writing, to the appropriate trustee to receive a release form, and the appropriate trustee will send such form to such requesting holder on or prior to the fifth (5th) Business Day following the date such trustee receives such request;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstances shall requests for such release form from holders of Claims in Class 17A and Non-Filing WMB Senior Note Holders be honored by the Liquidating Trustee.
31.7
Withholding and Reporting Requirements
:
Any party issuing any instrument or making any distribution under the Plan shall comply with all applicable withholding and reporting requirements imposed by any United States federal, state or local tax law or Tax Authority, and all distributions under the Plan shall be subject to any such withholding or reporting requirements. Notwithstanding the above, each holder of an Allowed Claim or Equity Interest that is to receive a distribution under the Plan shall have the sole and exclusive responsibility for the satisfaction and payment of any Taxes imposed on such holder by any governmental unit, including income, withholding and other tax obligations, on account of such distribution. Any party issuing any instrument or making any distribution under the Plan has the right, but not the obligation, to not make a distribution until such holder has made arrangements satisfactory to such issuing or disbursing party for payment of any such withholding Tax obligations and, if any party issuing any instrument or making any distribution under the Plan fails to withhold with respect to any such holder’s distribution, and is later held liable for the amount of such withholding, the holder shall reimburse such party. The Disbursing Agent may require, as a condition to the receipt of a distribution, that the holder complete the appropriate Form W-8 or Form W-9, as applicable to each holder. If the holder fails to comply with such a request within one year, such distribution shall be deemed an unclaimed distribution.
31.8
Time Bar to Cash Payments
:
Checks issued by the Disbursing Agent on account of Allowed Claims or Equity Interests shall be null and void if not negotiated within
ninety (90) days from and after the date of issuance thereof. Requests for reissuance of any check shall be made directly to the Disbursing Agent by the holder of the Allowed Claim or Equity Interest with respect to which such check originally was issued. Any claim in respect of such a voided check shall be made on or before the later of (i) the first (1st) anniversary of the Effective Date or (ii) ninety (90) days after the date of issuance of such check, if such check represents a final distribution hereunder on account of such Claim or Equity Interest. After such date, all Claims and Equity Interests in respect of voided checks shall be discharged and forever barred and the Disbursing Agent shall retain all monies related thereto for the sole purpose of redistribution to holders of Allowed Claims and Equity Interests in accordance with the terms and provisions hereof.
31.9
Distributions After Effective Date
:
Distributions made after the Effective Date to (a) holders of Claims that are not Allowed Claims as of the Effective Date, but which later become Allowed Claims, (b) holders of Claims that fail to execute and deliver a third party release prior to the Effective Date, but later do so, and (c) holders of Dime Warrants to the extent the Dime Warrants are determined, pursuant to a Final Order, to hold Equity Interests or Allowed Claims which are subordinated to the level of Common Equity Interests in accordance with section 510 of the Bankruptcy Code, shall be deemed to have been made in accordance with the terms and provisions of Article XXXI of the Plan.
31.10
Setoffs
:
Except as otherwise provided in the Plan or in the Confirmation Order, the Disbursing Agent may, pursuant to applicable bankruptcy or non-bankruptcy law, set off against any Allowed Claim and the distributions to be made pursuant to the Plan on account thereof (before any distribution is made on account of such Claim by the Disbursing Agent), the claims, rights, and causes of action of any nature that one or more of the Debtors, Debtors in Possession, or the Reorganized Debtors may hold against the holder of such Allowed Claim;
provided
,
however
, that neither the failure to effect such a setoff nor the allowance of any Claim hereunder shall constitute a waiver or release by the Debtors, Debtors in Possession, or the Reorganized Debtors of any such claims, rights, and causes of action that the Debtors, Debtors in Possession, or the Reorganized Debtors may possess against such holder; and,
provided
,
further
, that nothing contained herein is intended to limit the ability of any Creditor to effectuate rights of setoff or recoupment preserved or permitted by the provisions of sections 553, 555, 559, or 560 of the Bankruptcy Code or pursuant to the common law right of recoupment.
31.11
Allocation of Plan Distributions Between Principal and Interest
:
To the extent that any Allowed Claim entitled to a distribution under the Plan consists of indebtedness and other amounts (such as accrued but unpaid interest thereon), such distribution shall be allocated first to the principal amount of the Claim (as determined for federal income tax purposes) and then, to the extent the consideration exceeds the principal amount of the Claim, to such other amounts.
31.12
Payment of Trustee Fees and Expenses
:
Upon the entry of an order of the Bankruptcy Court authorizing payment thereof, upon notice and a hearing, the Disbursing Agent, unless otherwise stayed, shall pay the Trustee Claims;
provided
,
however
, that, with respect to the allowance of Trustee Claims for which an order of the Bankruptcy Court had been entered prior to the Effective Date the Disbursing Agent shall pay such Trustee Claims as soon as practicable after the Effective Date. To the extent that the Disbursing Agent fails to pay any
Trustee Claim in full, whether as a result of the Bankruptcy Court’s determination as to whether the Trustee Claim or the amount thereof is reasonable, or a Trustee’s determination not to request payment therefor, such Trustee shall have the right to assert its Lien and priority rights pursuant to the applicable Indenture or Guarantee Agreement for payment of any unpaid amount upon any payment or other distribution to be made in accordance with the provisions contained herein. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Disbursing Agent shall be responsible and, upon presentation of supporting documentation in form and substance satisfactory to the Disbursing Agent, shall satisfy the Trustee Distribution Expenses;
provided
,
however
, that, under no circumstance shall the Disbursing Agent be responsible for any indemnification obligation, cost, or expense of any of the Trustees associated with the gross negligence or willful misconduct of a Trustee in making any such distribution. To the extent not liquidated and Allowed as of the Effective Date, Trustee Claims shall remain an obligation of the Liquidating Trust pending termination of the Liquidating Trust;
provided
,
however
, that neither a reserve shall be created nor a distribution shall be made in respect thereof without entry of an order of the Bankruptcy Court authorizing such reserve to be created or distribution to be made.
31.13
Distribution Record Date
:
For purposes of distributions, on the Distribution Record Date, registers of the respective Trustees shall be closed and the Trustees shall have no obligation to recognize, and shall not recognize, any transfers of Claims arising under or related to the Indentures or the Guarantee Agreements occurring from and after the Distribution Record Date.
31.14
Runoff Notes
:
Notwithstanding anything contained in the Plan to the contrary, in accordance with Section 31.1(a) of the Plan, and subject to the provisions set forth in subsections of this Section 31.14, within ten (10) Business Days following the Effective Date, the Disbursing Agent shall distribute Runoff Notes to those holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Allowed General Unsecured Claims, Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims and Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims that elected to receive Runoff Notes in lieu of distributions of Creditor Cash on the Effective Date.
(a)
In the event that elections to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with Sections 6.2(a), 7.2(a), 16.1(b)(i), 18.2(a) and 19.2(a) of the Plan are made in an aggregate original principal amount greater than One Hundred Forty Million Dollars ($140,000,000.00), such elections shall be reduced pro rata such that the aggregate original principal amount elected is equal to One Hundred Forty Million Dollars ($140,000,000.00);
provided
,
however
, that, in the event that, (i) elections to receive Runoff Notes in accordance with Sections 6.2(a), 7.2(a), 16.1(b)(i), 18.2(a) and 19.2(a) of the Plan are made in an aggregate original principal amount equal to or greater than One Hundred Thirty Million Dollars ($130,000,000.00) and (ii) Runoff Notes are tendered in election for the Common Stock Allotment in an aggregate amount less than the Runoff Threshold, such elections to receive Runoff Notes shall be reduced pro rata by an amount necessary to permit the deemed elections contemplated by Section 31.14(d) to occur.
(b)
In the event that less than all of the original principal amount of Runoff Notes have been distributed in lieu of Creditor Cash on the Effective Date, the balance thereof shall constitute Liquidating Trust Assets, and such Runoff Notes and the proceeds thereof shall be distributed to beneficial holders of Liquidating Trust Interests in accordance with the provisions of Article XXVII of the Plan.
(c)
In the event that, pursuant to elections of Reorganized Common Stock in lieu of Runoff Notes, elections are made with respect to Runoff Notes having an aggregate original principal amount in excess of the Runoff Threshold, such elections shall be reduced pro rata by the amount of such excess so that each holder making such election shall receive shares of Reorganized Common Stock equal to its Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment.
(d)
In the event that holders of Claims with the right of elections pursuant to Sections 6.2(a), 7.2(a), 16.1(b)(ii), 18.2(a) and 19.2(a) of the Plan decline to tender, in the aggregate, Runoff Notes in the original principal amount necessary to reach the Runoff Threshold, each of AAOC, severally and not jointly, shall be deemed to have elected to receive its Pro Rata Share of the Common Stock Allotment in lieu of (i) Runoff Notes (based upon an allocation developed in their sole and absolute discretion) that they would otherwise receive on the Effective Date in their capacity as a holder of Allowed PIERS Claims, in the aggregate amount as is necessary to reach the Runoff Threshold;
provided
,
however
, that, to the extent that any of AAOC would not receive Runoff Notes on the Effective Date in its capacity as a holder of Allowed PIERS Claims in an amount sufficient to reach its allocable share of the Runoff Threshold, such AAOC Entity will instead be deemed to have elected to receive such amount of Runoff Notes (based upon an allocation developed in their sole and absolute discretion) in lieu of distributions of Creditor Cash on the Effective Date on account of its Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, and (ii) fifty percent (50%) of such holders’ Litigation Proceeds Interest in their capacity as holders of Allowed PIERS Claims.
Upon the earlier to occur of (x) the determination of the Trust Advisory Board, with the consent of each Entity which would be a recipient of Runoff Notes, (y) all Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claims and Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claims having been paid, in full, in accordance with the provisions of Articles XIX and XX of the Plan, respectively, and (z) Runoff Notes being the sole remaining Liquidating Trust Asset, the balance of the Runoff Notes in the Liquidating Trust, as the balance thereof may have been reduced from time-to-time, shall be distributed to Creditors whose Allowed Claims have not been paid in full as of the date thereof. To the extent that a holder of an Allowed Claim receives Runoff Notes pursuant to such distribution, the amount of such holder’s outstanding Claim shall be reduced on a dollar-for-dollar basis by the lesser of (i) the original outstanding principal amount of the Runoff Notes so received and (ii) the then outstanding principal amount (without regard to any interest paid-in-kind) of the Runoff Notes so received.
ARTICLE XXXII
MEANS OF IMPLEMENTATION
32.1
Incorporation and Enforcement of the Settlement Agreement
:
The Plan incorporates by reference the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement, including, without limitation, (i) the Debtors’ agreement to sell, free and clear of all Claims, rights, interests, and Liens, certain of the Plan Contribution Assets to the JPMC Entities, (ii) JPMC’s obligations to pay certain consideration for such sale, including, without limitation, JPMC’s agreement to pay or fund the payment of the JPMC Assumed Liabilities and certain other Claims, and to waive
certain of its Claims against the Debtors, (iii) JPMC’s obligation to transfer certain of the Plan Contribution Assets to the Debtors, (iv) the FDIC Receiver’s transfer of any interest it or the Receivership might have in any Plan Contribution Assets, and (v) the agreement among the parties to resolve certain pending Claims and litigation, including the Related Actions, pursuant to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement and the Plan.
32.2
Intercompany Claims
:
Intercompany Claims shall be extinguished, unless otherwise agreed or resolved between the parties to a given Intercompany Claim, resolved by the Global Settlement Agreement or released by operation of the Plan. Any such transaction may be effected without any further action by the stockholders of any of the Debtors or the Debtors in Possession.
32.3
Merger/Dissolution/Consolidation
:
On or as of the Effective Date or as soon as practicable thereafter, and without the need for any consent or approval, Reorganized WMI may, in its sole and absolute discretion, (i) cause any of the Reorganized WMI Entities to be merged, dissolved, or otherwise consolidated, (ii) cause the transfer of assets between or among the Reorganized WMI Entities, or (iii) engage in any other transaction in furtherance of the Plan. As soon as practicable after initial distributions are made pursuant to Section 31.1 of the Plan, and without the need for any consent or approval, Reorganized WMI shall complete, or shall cause the completion of, the administrative dissolution of the Washington Mutual Capital Trust 2001.
32.4
Cancellation of Existing Securities and Agreements
:
Except as provided herein, any document, agreement, or instrument evidencing any Claim or Equity Interest shall be deemed automatically cancelled and terminated on the Effective Date without further act or action under any applicable agreement, law, regulation, order, or rule and any and all obligations or liabilities of the Debtors under such documents, agreements, or instruments evidencing such Claims and Equity Interests shall be discharged;
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing cancellation of securities, documents, agreements or instruments shall not apply to (a) the securities related to the WMB Senior Notes or the WMB Subordinated Notes and (b) any security, document, agreement or instrument related to a Disputed Claim until a Final Order resolving any such Disputed Claim is entered; and,
provided
,
further
, that, during the pendency of any such disputes, the Debtors shall not accrue or incur any additional liability or obligation with respect thereto; and,
provided
,
further
, that the Indentures and Guarantee Agreements shall continue in effect for the limited purposes of (i) allowing the Trustees to make distributions pursuant to the Plan and to perform such other necessary functions with respect thereto, (ii) permitting the Trustees to maintain and assert any right or Lien for reasonable fees, costs, expenses and indemnities under the Indentures and Guarantee Agreements, (iii) effectuating the applicable subordination provisions of such documents or contesting the application thereof in the prosecution of any appeal to which a Trustee may be a party as of the Effective Date, (iv) enabling the noteholders and the holders of PIERS Claims to receive distributions and (v) enabling the Trustees to make applications in accordance with Section 31.12 of the Plan; and,
provided
,
further
, that, except as otherwise provided herein, nothing in this Plan shall impair, affect, or adversely affect the related transactions and the rights of the parties thereto. Notwithstanding any of the foregoing, nothing contained herein shall be deemed to impair, waive or extinguish any rights of the Trustees with respect to any rights contained in the respective Indentures or Guarantee Agreements;
provided
,
however
, that, upon payment in full of the
respective Trustee Claims and Trustee Distribution Expenses in accordance with the Plan, the rights of the Trustees to seek payment from or assert claims against the Debtors for amounts owed under the respective Indentures or Guarantee Agreements shall be discharged as provided in this Plan.
32.5
Claims of Subordination
:
Except as specifically provided herein, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, on the latest to occur of (i) the Effective Date, (ii) the entry of a Final Order resolving all Claims in the Chapter 11 Cases, and (iii) the final distribution made to holders of Allowed Claims in accordance with Article XXXI of the Plan, all Claims and Equity Interests, and all rights and claims between or among holders of Claims and Equity Interests relating in any manner whatsoever to Claims or Equity Interests, based upon any contractual, equitable or legal subordination and/or subrogation rights, will be terminated and discharged in the manner provided in this Plan, and all such Claims, Equity Interests and rights so based, and all such contractual, equitable and legal subordination and/or subrogation rights to which any Entity may be entitled will be irrevocably waived. To the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, the rights afforded and the distributions that are made in respect of any Claims or Equity Interests under this Plan will not be subject to levy, garnishment, attachment or like legal process by any holder of a Claim or Equity Interest by reason of any contractual, equitable or legal subordination and/or subrogation rights, so that, notwithstanding any such contractual, equitable or legal subordination and/or subrogation rights, each holder of a Claim or Equity Interest shall have and receive the benefit of the rights and distributions set forth in this Plan.
32.6
Surrender of Instruments
:
Except to the extent evidenced by electronic entry, and except with respect to the WMB Senior Notes and the WMB Subordinated Notes, as a condition of receiving any distribution pursuant to the Plan, each holder of a certificated instrument or note must surrender such instrument or note to the appropriate Trustee or the Disbursing Agent or its designee. Any holder of such instrument or note that fails to (i) surrender such instrument or note or (ii) execute and deliver an affidavit of loss and/or indemnity, or similar affidavit reasonably satisfactory to the appropriate Trustee or the Disbursing Agent before the first (1st) anniversary of the Effective Date shall be deemed to have forfeited all rights, interests and Claims and may not participate in any distribution under the Plan. Any distribution so forfeited shall become the property of the Disbursing Agent for distribution to holders of Allowed Claims in accordance with the terms and provisions hereof.
32.7
Issuance of Runoff Notes, Liquidating Trust Interests and Reorganized Common Stock
:
The issuance by Reorganized WMI of the Runoff Notes, the Liquidating Trust Interests and the Reorganized Common Stock on the Effective Date, if applicable, is hereby authorized without the need for any further corporate action and without any further action by holders of Claims or Equity Interests.
32.8
Exemption from Securities Laws
:
To the maximum extent provided by section 1145 of the Bankruptcy Code and applicable non-bankruptcy law, the issuance under the Plan of the Runoff Notes, the Liquidating Trust Interests and the Reorganized Common Stock will be exempt from registration under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and all rules and regulations promulgated thereunder, and all applicable state and local securities laws and regulations.
32.9
Hart-Scott-Rodino Compliance
:
Any shares of Reorganized Common Stock to be distributed under the Plan to any Entity required to file a Premerger Notification and Report Form under the Hart-Scott-Rodino Antitrust Improvement Act of 1976, as amended, shall not be distributed until the notification and waiting periods applicable under such Act to such Entity shall have expired or been terminated.
32.10
Fractional Stock or Other Distributions
:
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, no fractional shares of Reorganized Common Stock shall be distributed, and no Cash payments of fractions of cents will be made. Fractional dollars shall be rounded down to the nearest whole dollar. Unless otherwise determined by the Bankruptcy Court at the Confirmation Hearing, fractional shares of stock shall be rounded up or down, as the case may be, to the nearest whole unit. No Cash will be paid in lieu of such fractional shares of stock or dollars.
32.11
Credit Facility
:
(a)
Terms of Credit Facility
: The terms of the Credit Facility are set forth in the Credit Agreement annexed hereto as Exhibit “C”.
(b)
Replacement Lenders
: During the period from the date hereof up to and including the Ballot Date, the Debtors shall market the terms of the Credit Facility in an effort to obtain terms superior to those set forth in Section 32.11(a) of the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that, in accordance with the procedures set forth on the Ballot, any Creditor or holder of an Equity Interest may, upon (1) presentation of financial information necessary to establish the ability to participate as a lender in accordance with the provisions of the Credit Facility and (2) the consent of the Equity Committee, which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld, become a lender under the Credit Facility in lieu of the lenders contemplated pursuant to the Credit Agreement. Prior to the commencement of the Confirmation Hearing, the Debtors shall file a notice with the Bankruptcy Court setting forth the lender(s) selected to provide the Credit Facility.
ARTICLE XXXIII
CREDITORS’ COMMITTEE/EQUITY COMMITTEE
33.1
Dissolution of the Creditors’ Committee
:
On the first (1st) Business Day thirty (30) days following the Effective Date, and provided that payments to holders of Unsecured Claims have been made in accordance with Article XXXI of the Plan, the Creditors’ Committee shall be dissolved, and the members thereof shall be released and discharged of and from all further authority, duties, responsibilities, and obligations related to and arising from and in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, and the retention or employment of the Creditors’ Committee’s attorneys, financial advisors, and other agents, if any, shall terminate other than for purposes of filing and prosecuting applications for final allowances of compensation for professional services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred in connection therewith;
provided
,
however
, that the Creditors’ Committee may, at its own discretion, continue or resume its duties arising from or relating to (i) any pending litigation or contested matter to which the Creditors’ Committee is a party, (ii) any appeal filed regarding confirmation of the Plan, (iii)
obligations arising under confidentiality agreements, joint interest agreements, and protective orders, if any, entered during the Chapter 11 Cases that remain in full force and effect according to their terms, (iv) applications for fees and expenses of members of the Creditors’ Committee and requests for compensation and reimbursement of expenses pursuant to section 503(b) of the Bankruptcy Code for making a substantial contribution in any of the Chapter 11 Cases, and (v) motions, appeals or other litigation seeking the enforcement of the provisions of the Plan and the transactions contemplated hereunder or in the Confirmation Order; and,
provided
,
further
, that the Liquidating Trust shall continue to compensate the Creditors’ Committee’s attorneys, financial advisors, and other agents, if any, for any of the post-Effective Date activities identified in this Section 33.1 of the Plan; and,
provided
,
further
, that, in the event that (a) the Creditors’ Committee elects to continue or resume any or all of the enumerated duties set forth in this Section 35.1 and (b) all then-appointed members of the Creditors’ Committee subsequently resign, (i) the United States Trustee may appoint such Persons as the United States Trustee deems appropriate to represent the interests of the Creditors’ Committee and (ii) if no such Persons are appointed, then, (y) all right, title and interest of the Creditors’ Committee in any and all tolling agreements entered into by the Creditors’ Committee, for itself or on behalf of the Debtors and Debtors in Possession, on the one hand, and a potential defendant, on the other hand, shall be deemed assigned to the Liquidating Trust and the Liquidating Trustee and the Liquidating Trust and the Liquidating Trustee shall be entitled to the benefits therein, including, without limitation, timing with respect to the commencement of any litigation, as if the Liquidating Trust and the Liquidating Trustee were a party to any such tolling agreement, and (z) in its sole and absolute discretion, the Liquidating Trustee may, and, if it chooses to, shall, accede to the position of the Creditors’ Committee in prospective or then-pending litigations or contested matters, as the case may be. Without limiting the foregoing, on the Effective Date, the Creditors’ Committee shall take any and all action as is necessary to cause the withdrawal and dismissal, with prejudice, of the appeal taken by the Creditors’ Committee from the September Opinion.
33.2
Dissolution of the Equity Committee
:
On the Effective Date, other than with respect to its duties and obligations set forth herein, the Equity Committee shall be dissolved and the members thereof shall be released and discharged of and from all further authority, duties, responsibilities, and obligations related to and arising from and in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, and the retention or employment of the Equity Committee’s attorneys, financial advisors, and other agents, if any, shall terminate other than for purposes of filing and prosecuting applications for final allowances of compensation for professional services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred in connection therewith;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event that (a) a timely appeal is taken from the Confirmation Order and (b) such appeal remains pending, the Equity Committee shall be dissolved on the earlier to occur of (1) dismissal or withdrawal of such appeal and (2) a determination, by Final Order, as to the merits of such appeal. Without limiting the foregoing, on the Effective Date, the Equity Committee shall take any and all action as is necessary to cause the withdrawal and dismissal, with prejudice, of (x) the Equity Committee Adversary Proceeding, (y) the Equity Committee Action to Compel and (z) the appeals taken by the Equity Committee from (i) the January Opinion and (ii) the September Opinion.
ARTICLE XXXIV
EXECUTORY CONTRACTS AND UNEXPIRED LEASES
34.1
Rejection or Assumption of Remaining Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases
:
Pursuant to sections 365(a) and 1123(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code, all prepetition executory contracts and unexpired leases that exist between one or both of the Debtors and any Entity, and which have not expired by their own terms on or prior to the Confirmation Date, shall be deemed rejected by the Debtors as of the Effective Date, except for any executory contract or unexpired lease that (i) has been assumed and assigned or rejected pursuant to an order of the Bankruptcy Court entered prior to the Effective Date or (ii) that is specifically designated as a contract or lease to be assumed or assumed and assigned on the schedules to the Plan Supplement, including, without limitation, any executory contract or unexpired lease sold, accepted, or transferred to one of the JPMC Entities pursuant to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement;
provided
,
however
, that the Debtors reserve the right, on or prior to the Confirmation Date, to amend such schedules to delete any executory contract or unexpired lease therefrom or add any executory contract or unexpired lease thereto, in which event such executory contract(s) or unexpired lease(s) shall be deemed to be, as the case may be, either rejected, assumed, or assumed and assigned as of the Effective Date. The Debtors shall serve (i) notice of any executory contract and unexpired lease to be assumed or assumed and assigned through the operation of this Section 34.1 by including a schedule of such contracts and leases in the Plan Supplement and (ii) notice of any executory contract and unexpired lease to be rejected through the operation of this Section 34.1 by serving a separate notice to the relevant counterparties to such agreements. To the extent there are any amendments to such schedules, the Debtors shall provide notice of any such amendments to the parties to the executory contracts and unexpired leases affected thereby. The listing of a document on the schedules to the Plan Supplement or in any separate notice shall not constitute an admission by the Debtors that such document is an executory contract or an unexpired lease or that the Debtors have any liability thereunder.
34.2
Approval of Rejection or Assumption of Executory Contracts and Unexpired Leases
:
Entry of the Confirmation Order by the Bankruptcy Court shall constitute approval, pursuant to sections 365(a) and 1123(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code, of the rejection, assumption, or assumption and assignment, as the case may be, of executory contracts and unexpired leases pursuant to Section 34.1 of the Plan or pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement.
34.3
Inclusiveness
:
Unless otherwise specified on the schedules to the Plan Supplement, each executory contract and unexpired lease listed or to be listed therein shall include any and all modifications, amendments, supplements, restatements, or other agreements made directly or indirectly by any agreement, instrument, or other document that in any manner affects such executory contract or unexpired lease, without regard to whether such agreement, instrument, or other document is listed on such schedule.
34.4
Cure of Defaults
:
Except to the extent that different treatment has been agreed to by the non-debtor party or parties to any executory contract or unexpired lease to be assumed or assumed and assigned pursuant to Section 34.1 of the Plan, the Debtors shall,
pursuant to the provisions of sections 1123(a)(5)(G) and 1123(b)(2) of the Bankruptcy Code and consistent with the requirements of section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code, within at least twenty (20) days prior to the Confirmation Hearing, file with the Bankruptcy Court and serve by first class mail on each non-debtor party to such executory contracts or unexpired leases to be assumed pursuant to Section 34.1 of the Plan, a notice, which shall list the cure amount as to each executory contract or unexpired lease to be assumed or assumed and assigned. The parties to such executory contracts or unexpired leases will have twenty (20) days from the date of service of such notice to file and serve any objection to the cure amounts listed by the Debtors. If there are any objections filed, the Bankruptcy Court shall hold a hearing on a date to be set by the Bankruptcy Court. Notwithstanding Section 34.1 of the Plan, the Debtors shall retain their rights to reject any of their executory contracts or unexpired leases that are subject to a dispute concerning amounts necessary to cure any defaults through the Effective Date.
34.5
Rejection Damage Claims
:
If the rejection of an executory contract or unexpired lease by the Debtors hereunder results in damages to the other party or parties to such contract or lease, any claim for such damages, if not heretofore evidenced by a filed proof of Claim, shall be forever barred and shall not be enforceable against the Debtors, or their properties or agents, successors, or assigns, including, without limitation, the Reorganized Debtors and the Liquidating Trust, unless a proof of Claim is filed with the Bankruptcy Court and served upon attorneys for the Debtors or the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, on or before thirty (30) days after the latest to occur of (i) the Confirmation Date, and (ii) the date of entry of an order by the Bankruptcy Court authorizing rejection of a particular executory contract or unexpired lease.
34.6
Indemnification and Reimbursement Obligations
:
For purposes of the Plan, (i) to the extent executory in nature, the obligations of the Debtors to indemnify and reimburse their directors or officers that were directors or officers, respectively, on or prior to the Petition Date shall be deemed rejected as of the Effective Date and such parties’ rights to assert rejection damage claims, if any, shall be governed by Section 34.5 of the Plan and (ii) indemnification obligations of the Debtors arising from conduct of officers and directors during the period from and after the Petition Date shall be Administrative Expense Claims.
34.7
Termination of Benefit Plans
:
Notwithstanding anything contained in the Plan to the contrary, the Debtors and the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, shall be authorized, but not required, to terminate all Benefit Plans, in accordance with the terms and provisions of the documents and instruments relating thereto and applicable law, at such time as determined by the Debtors or the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, in their sole discretion;
provided
,
however
, that, until the transfer or termination of any Benefit Plan, the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, and the Reorganized Debtors, as the case may be, shall (a) continue to perform any and all of their administrative obligations thereunder and (b) with respect to Benefit Plans subject to Title IV of ERISA, continue to make any required minimum funding contributions and pay applicable Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation insurance premiums; and,
provided
,
further
, that, upon termination thereof, the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, or the Reorganized Debtors, as the case may be, shall provide administrative services in connection with the operation and wind down of the Benefit Plans; and,
provided
,
further
, that the continuation of any Benefit Plan by the Debtors, the Liquidating Trustee, or the Reorganized Debtors, as the case may be, from and after the Confirmation Date, including, without limitation,
the provision of administrative services in connection with the operation and wind down of such Benefit Plan, shall not constitute an assumption of such Benefit Plans in accordance with section 365 of the Bankruptcy Code; and,
provided
,
further
, that the failure to perform any obligation under the Benefit Plans or to provide administrative services in connection with the wind down of the Benefit Plans shall be without prejudice to (i) any Entity to assert such failure gives rise to an Administrative Expense Claim and (ii) the Debtors or the Liquidating Trustee to contest the assertion thereof. For the avoidance of doubt, the foregoing shall not apply to any employee benefit or welfare plan to be maintained by the Reorganized Debtors or the Liquidating Trustee, as the case may be, in the ordinary course of business after the Effective Date for the benefit of employees actively employed by the Reorganized Debtors or the Liquidating Trustee.
34.8
Termination of Vendor Stipulation
:
On the Effective Date, that certain Stipulation By and Between Debtors and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. Concerning Certain Contracts, dated October 16, 2008, shall be terminated and deemed of no further force and effect, except as specifically provided in the Confirmation Order and in Section 2.14 of the Global Settlement Agreement.
ARTICLE XXXV
RIGHTS AND POWERS OF DISBURSING AGENT
35.1
Exculpation
:
From and after the Effective Date, the Disbursing Agent shall be exculpated by all Entities, including, without limitation, holders of Claims and Equity Interests and other parties in interest, from any and all claims, causes of action, and other assertions of liability arising out of the discharge of the powers and duties conferred upon such Disbursing Agent by the Plan or any order of the Bankruptcy Court entered pursuant to or in furtherance of the Plan, or applicable law, except for actions or omissions to act arising out of the gross negligence or willful misconduct of such Disbursing Agent. No holder of a Claim or an Equity Interest or other party in interest shall have or pursue any claim or cause of action against the Disbursing Agent for making payments in accordance with the Plan or for implementing the provisions of the Plan.
35.2
Powers of the Disbursing Agent
:
Except as may be provided otherwise hereunder, the Disbursing Agent shall be empowered to (i) take all steps and execute all instruments and documents necessary to effectuate the Plan, (ii) make distributions contemplated by the Plan, (iii) comply with the Plan and the obligations thereunder, and (iv) exercise such other powers as may be vested in the Disbursing Agent pursuant to order of the Bankruptcy Court, pursuant to the Plan, or as deemed by the Disbursing Agent to be necessary and proper to implement the provisions of the Plan.
35.3
Fees and Expenses Incurred From and After the Effective Date
:
Except as otherwise ordered by the Bankruptcy Court, the amount of any reasonable fees and expenses incurred by the Disbursing Agent from and after the Effective Date and any reasonable compensation and expense reimbursement claims, including, without limitation, reasonable fees and expenses of counsel, incurred by the Disbursing Agent, shall be paid in Cash without further order of the Bankruptcy Court.
ARTICLE XXXVI
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO CONFIRMATION OF THE PLAN
36.1
Conditions Precedent to Confirmation of the Plan
:
Confirmation of the Plan is subject to satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:
(a)
Required Orders
. The Clerk of the Bankruptcy Court shall have entered an order or orders (including, without limitation, the Disclosure Statement Order and the Confirmation Order):
(1)
approving the Disclosure Statement as containing “adequate information” pursuant to section 1125 of the Bankruptcy Code;
(2)
authorizing the solicitation of votes with respect to the Plan;
(3)
determining that all votes are binding and have been properly tabulated as acceptances or rejections of the Plan;
(4)
confirming and giving effect to the terms and provisions of the Plan, including the releases in Article XLI of the Plan;
(5)
approving the Global Settlement Agreement in accordance with its terms including, but not limited to the releases of the Released Parties;
(6)
determining that all applicable tests, standards and burdens in connection with the Plan have been duly satisfied and met by the Debtors and the Plan;
(7)
approving the documents in the Plan Supplement;
(8)
authorizing the Debtors to execute, enter into, and deliver the documents in the Plan Supplement, and to execute, implement and take all actions otherwise necessary or appropriate to give effect to the transactions contemplated by the Plan, the documents in the Plan Supplement, and the Global Settlement Agreement;
(9)
determining that the compromises and settlements set forth in the Global Settlement Agreement and this Plan are appropriate, reasonable and approved;
(10)
ordering the sale of the Plan Contribution Assets to be sold to the JPMC Entities or the Debtors, as applicable, pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement, free and clear of all rights, Claims, interests and Liens, and finding that the parties acquired such assets in good faith under
the meaning of, and subject to the protections of, section 363(m) and pursuant to section 1123(a)(5) of the Bankruptcy Code; and
(11)
withdrawing and vacating for all purposes (a) the September Order to the extent relating to the Standing Motion and (b) those portions of the September Opinion relating to the Standing Motion, including, but not limited to, (i) Section III (H) of the September Opinion, pages 108 through 139, and (ii) the first sentence on page 68, footnote 31 on page 70 and the last paragraph of Section III(D) of the September Opinion, page 73.
(b)
Form of Orders
. The Confirmation Order and this Plan each is in a form and substance satisfactory to the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC.
(c)
Confirmation Order
. The Confirmation Order includes (i) determinations that all of the settlements and compromises contained in the Plan and the Global Settlement Agreement satisfy applicable standards under sections 365, 1123(b)(3) and 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code and Bankruptcy Rule 9019, to the extent applicable, and (ii) the releases and injunctions set forth in Article XLI of the Plan.
36.2
Waiver of Conditions Precedent to Confirmation
:
To the extent practicable and legally permissible, each of the conditions precedent in Section 36.1 hereof may be waived, in whole or in part, by the Debtors, subject to the prior written approval of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC. Any such waiver of a condition precedent may be effected at any time by filing a notice thereof with the Bankruptcy Court executed by the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC.
ARTICLE XXXVII
CONDITIONS PRECEDENT TO EFFECTIVE DATE OF THE PLAN
37.1
Conditions Precedent to Effective Date of the Plan
:
The occurrence of the Effective Date and the substantial consummation of the Plan are subject to satisfaction of the following conditions precedent:
(a)
Satisfaction of Certain Settlement Agreement Conditions
. The satisfaction of the “Conditions to Effective Date” set forth in Section 7.2 of the Global Settlement Agreement.
(b)
Entry of the Confirmation Order
. The Clerk of the Bankruptcy Court shall have entered the Confirmation Order in accordance with section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, and the Confirmation Order shall have become a Final Order.
(c)
Execution of Documents; Other Actions
. All other actions and documents necessary to implement the Plan shall have been effected or executed.
37.2
Waiver of Conditions Precedent
:
To the extent practicable and legally permissible, each of the conditions precedent in Section 37.1 hereof may be waived, in whole or in part, by the Debtors, subject to the prior written approval of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate, and AAOC. Any such waiver of a condition precedent may be effected at any time by filing a notice thereof with the Bankruptcy Court executed by the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC.
ARTICLE XXXVIII
RETENTION OF JURISDICTION
38.1
Retention of Jurisdiction
:
The Bankruptcy Court shall retain and have exclusive jurisdiction over any matter arising under the Bankruptcy Code, arising in or related to the Chapter 11 Cases or the Plan, or that relates to the following:
(a)
to resolve any matter related to the assumption, assumption and assignment, or rejection of any executory contract or unexpired lease to which a Debtor is a party or with respect to which a Debtor may be liable and to hear, determine, and, if necessary, liquidate, any Claim arising therefrom, including those matters related to the amendment after the Effective Date of the Plan to add any executory contract or unexpired lease to the list of executory contracts and unexpired leases to be rejected;
(b)
to enter such orders as may be necessary or appropriate to implement or consummate the provisions of the Plan and all contracts, instruments, releases, and other agreements or documents created in connection with the Plan, including, without limitation, the Global Settlement Agreement, unless any such agreements or documents contain express enforcement and dispute resolution provisions to the contrary, in which case, such provisions shall govern;
(c)
to determine any and all motions, adversary proceedings, applications, and contested or litigated matters that may be pending on the Effective Date or that, pursuant to the Plan, may be instituted by the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, or the Liquidating Trustee prior to or after the Effective Date;
(d)
to ensure that distributions to holders of Allowed Claims are accomplished as provided herein;
(e)
to hear and determine any timely objection to any Claim or Equity Interest, whether such objection is filed before or after the Confirmation Date, including any objection to the classification of any Claim or Equity Interest, and to allow, disallow, determine, liquidate, classify, estimate, or establish the priority of or secured or unsecured status of any Claim or Equity Interest, in whole or in part;
(f)
to enter and implement such orders as may be appropriate in the event the Confirmation Order is for any reason stayed, revoked, modified, reversed, or vacated;
(g)
to issue such orders in aid of execution of the Plan, to the extent authorized by section 1142 of the Bankruptcy Code;
(h)
to consider any modification of the Plan, to cure any defect or omission, or reconcile any inconsistency in any order of the Bankruptcy Court, including the Confirmation Order;
(i)
to hear and determine all applications for awards of compensation for services rendered and reimbursement of expenses incurred prior to the Effective Date;
(j)
to hear and determine disputes arising in connection with or relating to the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, or the interpretation, implementation, or enforcement of the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, or the extent of any Entity’s obligations incurred in connection with or released under the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, unless such agreements or documents contain express enforcement or dispute resolution provisions to the contrary, in which case such provisions should govern;
(k)
to issue injunctions, enter and implement other orders, or take such other actions as may be necessary or appropriate to restrain interference by any Entity with consummation or enforcement of the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement;
(l)
to determine any other matter that may arise in connection with or that is related to the Plan, the Disclosure Statement, the Supplemental Disclosure Statement, the Confirmation Order, the Global Settlement Agreement, or any contract, instrument, release, or other agreement or document created in connection therewith, unless such agreements or documents contain express enforcement or dispute resolution provisions, in which case, such provisions should govern;
(m)
to hear and determine matters concerning state, local, and federal Taxes in accordance with sections 346, 505, and 1146 of the Bankruptcy Code (including, without limitation, any matter relating to the Tax Refunds, and any request by the Debtors or by the Liquidating Trustee, as applicable, for an expedited determination of Tax under section 505(b) of the Bankruptcy Code with respect to the Debtors, the Liquidating Trust, or the Liquidating Trust Claims Reserve, as applicable);
(n)
to hear any other matter or for any purpose specified in the Confirmation Order that is not inconsistent with the Bankruptcy Code; and
(o)
to enter a final decree closing the Chapter 11 Cases;
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing is not intended to (i) expand the Bankruptcy Court’s jurisdiction beyond that allowed by applicable law, (ii) grant the Bankruptcy Court jurisdiction over disputes between JPMC and the FDIC Receiver and/or FDIC Corporate under the Purchase and Assumption Agreement, (iii) impair the rights of an Entity to (a) invoke the jurisdiction of a court, commission, or tribunal with respect to matters relating to a governmental unit’s police and regulatory powers and (b) contest the invocation of any such jurisdiction; and
provided
,
further
, that the invocation of such jurisdiction, if granted, shall not extend to the allowance or priority of Claims or the enforcement of any money judgment against the Debtors, the
Reorganized Debtors, or the Liquidating Trust, as the case may be, entered by such court, commission, or tribunal, and (iv) impair the rights of an Entity to (a) seek the withdrawal of the reference in accordance with 28 U.S.C. § 157(d) and (b) contest any request for the withdrawal of reference in accordance with 28 U.S.C. § 157(d).
ARTICLE XXXIX
MODIFICATION, REVOCATION, OR WITHDRAWAL OF THE PLAN
39.1
Modification of Plan
:
The Debtors reserve the right, in accordance with the Bankruptcy Code and the Bankruptcy Rules, except in the event any amendment or modification would materially adversely affect the substance of the economic provisions set forth in the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, to amend or modify the Plan, the Plan Supplement, or any exhibit to the Plan at any time prior to the entry of the Confirmation Order, subject in each case to the consent of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC;
provided
,
however
, that, for the avoidance of doubt, it is understood and agreed that any change to the definition of JPMC Assumed Liabilities or to the releases in Article XLI of the Plan, or to the assets or benefits to be received by JPMC pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement would be material to the JPMC Entities. Upon entry of the Confirmation Order, the Debtors may, with the consent of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, FDIC Corporate and AAOC, upon order of the Bankruptcy Court, amend or modify the Plan, in accordance with section 1127(b) of the Bankruptcy Code, or remedy any defect or omission or reconcile any inconsistency in the Plan in such manner as may be necessary to carry out the purpose and intent of the Plan, subject in each case to the terms of the Global Settlement Agreement. A holder of a Claim that has accepted the Plan shall be deemed to have accepted the Plan as modified if the proposed modification does not materially and adversely change the treatment of the Claim of such holder.
39.2
Revocation or Withdrawal
:
(a)
The Plan may be revoked or withdrawn prior to the Confirmation Date by the Debtors.
(b)
If the Plan is revoked or withdrawn prior to the Confirmation Date, or if the Plan does not become effective for any reason whatsoever, then the Plan shall be deemed null and void. In such event, nothing contained herein shall be deemed to constitute a waiver or release of any claim by the Debtors or any other Entity, or to prejudice in any manner the rights of the Debtors or any other Entity in any further proceeding involving the Debtors.
39.3
Amendment of Plan Documents
:
From and after the Effective Date, the authority to amend, modify, or supplement the Plan Supplement, the Exhibits to the Plan Supplement and the Exhibits to the Plan, and any document attached to any of the foregoing, shall be as provided in such Plan Supplement, Exhibit to the Plan Supplement, or Exhibit to the Plan and their respective attachments, as the case may be.
39.4
No Admission of Liability
:
(a)
The submission of this Plan is not intended to be, nor shall it be construed as, an admission or evidence in any pending or subsequent suit, action, proceeding or dispute of any liability, wrongdoing, or obligation whatsoever (including as to the merits of any claim or defense) by any Entity with respect to any of the matters addressed in this Plan.
(b)
None of this Plan (including, without limitation, the Exhibits hereto), or any settlement entered, act performed or document executed in connection with this Plan: (i) is or may be deemed to be or may be used as an admission or evidence of the validity of any claim, or any allegation made in any of the Related Actions or of any wrongdoing or liability of any Entity; (ii) is or may be deemed to be or may be used as an admission or evidence of any liability, fault or omission of any Entity in any civil, criminal or administrative proceeding in any court, administrative agency or other tribunal; (iii) is or may be deemed to be or used as an admission or evidence against the Reorganized Debtors, the Debtors, or any other Person or Entity with respect to the validity of any Claim; or (iv) is or may be deemed to be used as an admission or evidence of the jurisdiction of any court to adjudicate claims or matters relating to the Receivership. None of this Plan or any settlement entered, act performed or document executed in connection with this Plan shall be admissible in any proceeding for any purposes, except to carry out the terms of this Plan, and except that, once confirmed, any Entity may file this Plan in any action for any purpose, including, but not limited to, in order to support a defense or counterclaim based on the principles of
res judicata
, collateral estoppel, release, good faith settlement, judgment bar or reduction or any other theory of claim preclusion or issue preclusion or similar defense of counterclaim.
ARTICLE XL
CORPORATE GOVERNANCE AND
MANAGEMENT OF THE REORGANIZED DEBTORS
40.1
Corporate Action
:
On the Effective Date, all matters provided for under the Plan that would otherwise require approval of the stockholders or directors of one or more of the Debtors or Reorganized Debtors, including, without limitation, the authorization to issue or cause to be issued the Runoff Notes and the Reorganized Common Stock, the authorization to enter into the Credit Facility, the adoption of the Reorganized Debtors Certificates of Incorporation and the Reorganized Debtors By-Laws, and the election or appointment, as the case may be, of directors and officers of the Reorganized Debtors pursuant to the Plan, as applicable, shall be authorized and approved in all respects, in each case without further action under applicable law, regulation, order, or rule, including, without limitation, any action by the stockholders of the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors, as the case may be. The cancellation of all Equity Interests and other matters provided under the Plan involving the corporate structure of the Reorganized Debtors or corporate action by the Reorganized Debtors, as applicable, shall be deemed to have occurred, be authorized, and shall be in effect without requiring further action under applicable law, regulation, order, or rule, including, without limitation, any action by the stockholders of the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors. Without limiting the foregoing, from and after the Confirmation Date, the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors shall take any and all actions deemed appropriate in order to consummate the transactions contemplated herein, and, notwithstanding any provision contained in the Debtors’ articles of incorporation and by-laws to the contrary, such Entities shall not require the affirmative vote of holders of Equity Interests in
order to take any corporate action including to (i) compromise and settle claims and causes of action of or against the Debtors and their chapter 11 estates and (ii) dissolve, merge, or consolidate with any other Entity.
40.2
Reincorporation
:
No later than one (1) year following the Effective Date, Reorganized WMI may, at the discretion of the board of directors of Reorganized WMI and without requiring the approval of Reorganized WMI’s shareholders, reincorporate from the State of Washington to the State of Delaware, including, without limitation, by merging with a corporation incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware or by such conversion or redomestication process as is authorized under applicable law.
40.3
Amendment of Articles of Incorporation and By-Laws
:
The articles of incorporation and by-laws of the Debtors shall be amended as of the Effective Date to provide substantially as set forth in the Reorganized Debtors Certificates of Incorporation and the Reorganized Debtors By-Laws, each of which shall in form and substance be reasonably satisfactory to the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC. The Reorganized Debtors Certificates of Incorporation and the Reorganized Debtors By-Laws, to the extent applicable, shall prohibit the issuance of nonvoting equity securities to the extent required by section 1123(a)(6) of the Bankruptcy Code.
40.4
Directors of the Reorganized Debtors
:
On the Effective Date, the board of directors of each of the Reorganized Debtors shall consist of five (5) persons: four (4) members selected by the Equity Committee and one (1) member selected by the lenders party to the Credit Facility. The initial directors shall be disclosed prior to the Confirmation Hearing. In the event that, during the period from the Confirmation Hearing up to and including the Effective Date, circumstances require the substitution of one (1) or more persons selected to serve on the boards of directors of the Reorganized Debtors, the Equity Committee and the lenders party to the Credit Facility, as the case may be, shall choose a respective substitute and the Debtors shall file a notice thereof with the Bankruptcy Court and, for purposes of section 1129 of the Bankruptcy Code, any such replacement person, designated in accordance with the requirements of the immediately preceding sentence, shall be deemed to have been selected and disclosed prior to the Confirmation Hearing.
40.5
Officers of the Reorganized Debtors
:
To the extent applicable, the board of directors of the Reorganized Debtors shall elect officers of the Reorganized Debtors as of or after the Effective Date.
ARTICLE XLI
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS
41.1
Title to Assets
:
Except as provided in Confirmation Order, on the Effective Date, title to all assets and properties encompassed by the Plan shall vest in the Reorganized Debtors, Reorganized WMI, the Liquidating Trust, the JPMC Entities or the FDIC Receiver,
as the case may be, free and clear of all Liens and in accordance with sections 363 and 1141 of the Bankruptcy Code, and the Confirmation Order shall be a judicial determination of
discharge of the liabilities of the Debtors and the Debtors in Possession except as provided in the Plan.
41.2
Discharge and Release of Claims and Termination of Equity Interests
:
(a)
Except as expressly provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan or the Confirmation Order, all distributions and rights afforded under the Plan and the treatment of Claims and Equity Interests under the Plan shall be, and shall be deemed to be, in exchange for, and in complete satisfaction, settlement, discharge and release of, all Claims and any other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities of any nature whatsoever, and of all Equity Interests, or other rights of a holder of an Equity Interest, relating to any of the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors or any of their respective assets, property and estates, or interests of any nature whatsoever, including any interest accrued on such Claims from and after the Petition Date, and regardless of whether any property will have been distributed or retained pursuant to the Plan on account of such Claims or other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities, or Equity Interests or other rights of a holder of an equity security or other ownership interest. Upon the Effective Date, the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors shall (i) be deemed discharged under section 1141(d)(1)(A) of the Bankruptcy Code and released from any and all Claims and any other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities, and any Equity Interests or other rights of a holder of an equity security or other ownership interest, of any nature whatsoever, including, without limitation, liabilities that arose before the Effective Date (including prior to the Petition Date), and all debts of the kind specified in sections 502(g), 502(h) or 502(i) of the Bankruptcy Code, whether or not (a) a proof of Claim based upon such debt is filed or deemed filed under section 501 of the Bankruptcy Code, (b) a Claim based upon such debt is allowed under section 502 of the Bankruptcy Code (or is otherwise resolved), or (c) the holder of a Claim based upon such debt voted to accept the Plan and (ii) terminate and cancel all rights of any equity security holder in any of the Debtors and all Equity Interests.
(b)
Except as provided in Sections 41.6 and 41.12 of the Plan or the Confirmation Order, all Entities shall be precluded from asserting against any and each of the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors, and any and each of their respective assets, property and estates, any other or further Claims, or any other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities of any nature whatsoever, and of all Equity Interests, or other rights of a holder of an Equity Interest, relating to any of the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors or any of their respective assets, property and estates, including any interest accrued on such Claims from and after the Petition Date, and regardless of whether any property will have been distributed or retained pursuant to the Plan on account of such Claims or other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities, or Equity Interests or other rights of a holder of an equity security or other ownership interest. In accordance with the foregoing, except as expressly provided in the Plan or the Confirmation Order, the Confirmation Order shall constitute a judicial determination, as of the Effective Date, of the discharge and release of all such Claims or other obligations, suits, judgments, damages, debts, rights, remedies, causes of action or liabilities, and any Equity Interests, or other rights of a holder of an equity interest and termination of all rights of any such holder in any of the Debtors, pursuant to sections 524 and 1141 of the Bankruptcy Code, and such discharge shall
void and extinguish any judgment obtained against any of the Debtors or the Reorganized Debtors, and their respective assets, property and estates at any time, to the extent such judgment is related to a discharged Claim, debt or liability or terminated right of any holder of any Equity Interest in any of the Debtors. As of the Effective Date, and in consideration for the value provided under the Global Settlement Agreement to effectuate the Plan, each holder of a Claim or Equity Interest in any Class under this Plan shall be and hereby is deemed to release and forever waive and discharge as against each and any of the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors, and their respective assets, property and estates, all such Claims and Equity Interests.
(c)
Except as expressly provided in Sections 41.6 and 41.12 of the Plan or the Confirmation Order, in furtherance of the foregoing, and except for the JPMC Assumed Liabilities, Allowed WMB Vendor Claims, and Allowed WMI Vendor Claims, to the extent provided in the Global Settlement Agreement, none of the JPMC Entities or any of their Related Persons shall have any liability for, and the Debtors, on behalf of themselves, their respective estates and their present Affiliates (other than WMB and its subsidiaries), hereby release the JPMC Entities and each of their Related Persons from liability for, any and all Claims that (i) are or were property of the Debtors, their respective estates, or their present Affiliates (other than WMB and its subsidiaries), and (ii) were or could have been brought in any of the Related Actions.
41.3
Injunction on Claims
:
Except as otherwise expressly provided in Sections 41.6 and 41.12 of the Plan, the Confirmation Order or such other order of the Bankruptcy Court that may be applicable, all Entities who have held, hold or may hold Claims or any other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interests or other right of equity interest that is terminated or cancelled pursuant to the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, or who have held, hold or may hold Claims or any other debt or liability that is discharged or released pursuant to Section 41.2 hereof, are permanently enjoined, from and after the Effective Date, from (a) commencing or continuing, directly or indirectly, in any manner, any action or other proceeding (including, without limitation, any judicial, arbitral, administrative or other proceeding) of any kind on any such Claim or other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interest that is terminated, cancelled, assumed or transferred pursuant to the Plan against any of the Released Parties or any of their respective assets, property or estates, (b) the enforcement, attachment, collection or recovery by any manner or means of any judgment, award, decree or order against any of the Released Parties or any of their respective assets, property or estates on account of any Claim or other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interest that is terminated, cancelled, assumed or transferred pursuant to the Plan, (c) creating, perfecting, or enforcing any encumbrance of any kind against any of the Released Parties or any of their respective assets, property or estates on account of any Claim or other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interest that is terminated, cancelled, assumed or transferred pursuant to the Plan, and (d) except to the extent provided, permitted or preserved by sections 553, 555, 556, 559 or 560 of the Bankruptcy Code or pursuant to the common law right of recoupment, asserting any right of setoff, subrogation or recoupment of any kind against any obligation due from any of the Released Parties or any of their respective assets, property or estates, with respect to any such Claim or other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interest that is terminated, cancelled, assumed or transferred pursuant to the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that such injunction shall not preclude the United States of America, any state or any of their respective police or regulatory agencies from enforcing their police or regulatory powers; and,
provided
,
further
, that, except in connection with a properly filed proof of Claim, the foregoing proviso does not permit the United States of America, any State or any of their respective police or regulatory agencies from obtaining any monetary recovery, including fines, restitution or forfeiture, from any of the Released Parties, including, without limitation, the Debtors, the Debtors in Possession or the Reorganized Debtors, or any of their respective assets, property or estates, with respect to any such Claim or other debt or liability that is discharged or Equity Interest or other right of equity interest that is terminated or cancelled pursuant to the Plan, including, without limitation, any monetary claim or penalty in furtherance of a police or regulatory power; and,
provided
,
further
, that, subject to Section 3.8 of the Global Settlement Agreement, such injunction shall not preclude the JPMC Entities, the Receivership, the FDIC Receiver and the FDIC Corporate from pursuing any and all claims against each other or any other defenses thereto pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreement. Such injunction shall extend to all successors and assigns of the Released Parties and their respective assets, property and estates.
41.4
Integral to Plan
:
Each of the discharge, injunction and release provisions provided in this Article XLI is an integral part of the Plan and is essential to its implementation. Each of the Released Parties shall have the right to independently seek the enforcement of the discharge, injunction and release provisions set forth in this Article XLI.
41.5
Releases by the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee and the Equity Committee
:
(a)
Released Parties
. Except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, the Confirmation Order, or the Global Settlement Agreement, on the Effective Date, for good and valuable consideration, each of the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors, on its own behalf and as representative of its respective estate, the Disbursing Agent and each of the Debtors’ Related Persons shall be deemed to have and hereby does irrevocably and unconditionally, fully, finally and forever waive, release, acquit, and discharge the Released Parties from any and all Claims or Causes of Action that the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, and the Disbursing Agent, or any of them, or anyone claiming through them, on their behalf or for their benefit, have or may have or claim to have, now or in the future, against any Released Party that are Released Claims or otherwise are based upon, relate to, or arise out of or in connection with, in whole or in part, any act, omission, transaction, event or other circumstance relating to the Debtors taking place or existing on or prior to the Effective Date, and/or any Claim, act, fact, transaction, occurrence, statement, or omission in connection with or alleged or that could have been alleged in the Related Actions, including, without limitation, any such claim, demand, right, liability, or cause of action for indemnification, contribution, or any other basis in law or equity for damages, costs or fees;
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing release shall not extend to acts of gross negligence or willful misconduct (other than with respect to the JPMC Entities and their respective Related Persons).
(b)
Release of AAOC, Holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Holders of Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims, Holders of CCB-1 Guarantees Claims, Holders of CCB-2 Guarantees Claims and Holders of Allowed PIERS Claims
. On the Effective Date, for good and valuable consideration, each of the Debtors and the Reorganized Debtors, on its own behalf and as representative of its respective estate, the Disbursing Agent and each of the
Debtors’ Related Persons, the Creditors’ Committee and the Equity Committee, without giving any legitimacy or merit to any of the allegations raised or asserted with respect to AAOC, holders of Allowed Senior Notes Claims, Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claims and holders of Allowed PIERS Claims during the Chapter 11 Cases, shall be deemed to have and hereby does irrevocably and unconditionally, fully, finally and forever waive, release, acquit, and discharge (1) the AAOC Releasees, (2) the Senior Notes Claims Releasees, (3) the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees, (4) the PIERS Claims Releasees and (5) the CCB Releasees, and each of their respective officers, directors, agents, employees and, solely in their capacity as counsel with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys from any and all Estate Claims that the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee and the Equity Committee, have or may have or claim to have, now or in the future, against (1) the AAOC Releasees, (2) the Senior Notes Claims Releasees, (3) the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees, (4) the PIERS Claims Releasees and (5) the CCB Releasees, and each of their respective officers, directors, agents, employees and, solely in their capacity as counsel with respect to the Debtors’ Chapter 11 Cases, attorneys.
41.6
Releases by Holders of Claims and Equity Interests
:
(a)
Global Third Party Releases
. On the Effective Date, for good and valuable consideration, and to the fullest extent permissible under applicable law, each Entity (Creditor or holder of an Equity Interest) that (i) has held, currently holds or may hold a Released Claim or any Released Third Party Causes of Action, (ii) is entitled to receive, directly or indirectly, a distribution or satisfaction of its Claim or Equity Interest pursuant to the Plan, and (iii) elects, by not checking or checking the appropriate box on its Ballot or election form, as the case may be, to grant the releases set forth in this Section 41.6, on their own behalf and on behalf of anyone claiming through them, shall be deemed to have and hereby does irrevocably and unconditionally, fully, finally and forever waive, release, acquit and discharge (1) each and all of the Released Parties, from any and all Released Claims and/or any claim, act, fact, transaction, occurrence, statement, or omission in connection with or alleged in the Actions or in the Texas Litigation, or that could have been alleged in respect of the foregoing or other similar proceeding, including, without limitation, any such claim demand, right, liability, or cause of action for indemnification, contribution or any other basis in law or equity for damages, costs or fees incurred by the releasors herein arising directly or indirectly from or otherwise relating thereto and (2) each of (a) the AAOC Releasees, (b) the Senior Notes Claims Releasees, (c) the Senior Subordinated Notes Claims Releasees, (d) the PIERS Claims Releasees and (e) the CCB Releasees from any and all Released Third Party Causes of Action;
provided
,
however
, that each Entity that has elected not to grant the releases set forth in this Section 41.6, including, without limitation, any Entity that fails to execute and deliver a release following notice in accordance with the provisions of Section 31.6(c) hereof, shall not be entitled to, and shall not receive, any payment, distribution or other satisfaction of its claim pursuant to the Plan
; and,
provided
,
further
, that, notwithstanding anything contained in this Section 41.6(a) to the contrary, the release set forth in Section 41.6(a)(1) shall not extend to acts of gross negligence or willful misconduct of any Released Parties (other than with respect to the JPMC Entities and their respective Related Persons); and,
provided
,
further
, that, notwithstanding the foregoing, solely for purposes of this Section 41.6(a), “Released Parties” shall not include Related Persons other than (i) Related Persons of the JPMC Entities and (ii) Related Persons of the FDIC Receiver and FDIC Corporate.
(b)
Limited Governmental Exceptions
. Nothing contained herein or in the Confirmation Order shall (1) (i) release, or is intended to release, any non-Debtor, including any non-Debtor Entity that may be a Released Party or a Related Person, in connection with any legal action or claim brought by the United States Securities and Exchange Commission or (ii) prejudice the rights of any such non-Debtor Entity to defend or otherwise contest any such legal action or claim, (2) (i) to the extent that (A) the Pension Plans are terminated from and after the Effective Date and (B) the Pension Plans are underfunded as of the Effective Date, release, or is intended to release, any non-Debtor, including any non-Debtor Entity that may be a Released Party or a Related Person, from any liability as a fiduciary of the Pension Plans, under any law, government policy or regulatory provision, (ii) enjoin or preclude the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation from enforcing such liability against such non-Debtor Entity during the applicable statute of limitations period set forth in 29 U.S.C. § 1303 following any such termination, or (iii) prejudice the rights of any such non-Debtor Entity to defend or otherwise contest any such legal action or claim, and (3) (i) release the claims held by the California Franchise Tax Board, including rights of setoff and recoupment with respect to claims against or among two or more non-Debtor Entities, against any non-Debtor and, notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan or the Confirmation Order, the California Franchise Tax Board shall not be enjoined from pursuing any such claims and (ii) prejudice the rights of any such non-Debtor to defend or otherwise contest any such legal action or claim.
(c)
BKK Liabilities
. Nothing contained herein or in the Confirmation Order is intended to, nor shall it, release any non-Debtor or non-Debtor Entity that may be a Released Party or a Related Person, in connection with any legal action or claim brought by CDTSC or the BKK Group relating to the BKK Site that is the subject of the BKK Litigation;
provided
,
however
, that nothing contained in this Section 41.6(c) is intended, nor shall it be construed, to (1) constitute evidence of or any support for an argument that any such non-Debtors have any such liabilities, or (2) create any liability on behalf of the Liquidating Trust. For the avoidance of doubt, nothing herein shall affect the releases or other terms of the BKK Settlement Agreement.
(d)
Securities Litigations
. Nothing contained herein, in the Confirmation Order or the Global Settlement Agreement with respect to the releases, exculpations, injunctions or similar provisions is intended to, nor shall it, release, enjoin or impact in any way the prosecution of the claims asserted, or to be asserted, against any non-Debtor or non-Debtor Entity in the Securities Litigations, including, but not limited to, the defendants named in the Securities Litigations (the “
Securities Litigations Carve-Out
”), nor will any potential distribution on account of the relevant proofs of claim filed by lead plaintiffs in the Securities Litigations and/or which have been withdrawn without prejudice (subject to all parties’ rights with respect to the relevant proofs of claim in accordance with and subject to the terms of the Bankruptcy Court-approved stipulations) be forfeited by virtue of the Securities Litigations Carve-Out.
(e)
Tranquility Claim
. Nothing contained herein or in the Confirmation Order with respect to releases, exculpations, injunctions or similar provisions is intended to, nor shall it, affect, impact, impair, modify, or limit or otherwise be used to contest the Tranquility Claim, or Tranquility’s ability to receive distributions on account of the Tranquility Claim;
provided
,
however
, that the Debtors’ ability to contest whether any
subsequent amendments or modifications to the Tranquility Claim were properly filed and relate to the Tranquility Claim are expressly reserved.
(f)
Truck and Fire
. Notwithstanding anything contained herein or in the Verification Form (as defined in the Supplemental Disclosure Statement Order), with respect to the Claims of Truck Insurance Exchange (“
Truck
”) and Fire Insurance Exchange (“
Fire
”) asserted against the Debtors and the Debtors’ chapter 11 estates (collectively, the “
Truck/Fire Claims
”), including, without limitation, those Claims included in Classes 17A and 17B of the Plan, (a) the release and injunction provisions of the Plan are intended to, and shall release only, all Claims of Truck and Fire against any Released Parties arising from or relating to the Truck/Fire Claims, other than any claims, counterclaims or defenses under or relating to any policies of insurance, and (b) the release and injunction provisions of the Plan are not intended to, and shall not release, any claims of Truck, Fire or any Affiliate of Truck or Fire against (i) a non-Debtor as an investor in securities issued by any such non-Debtor Entity, (ii) WMB, (iii) the Receivership, or (iv) the FDIC Receiver solely with respect to the Receivership.
(g)
Texas Litigation
. Nothing contained herein or in the Confirmation Order with respect to the releases, exculpations, injunctions or similar provisions is intended to, nor shall it, release, enjoin or restrain the prosecution of direct claims, if any, asserted, or that could have been asserted, in the Texas Litigation against any non-Debtor Entity;
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing is without prejudice to the rights of any such non-Debtor Entity to contest, upon notice and a hearing, the validity, merits and ownership of or standing to assert any such direct claims; and,
provided
,
further
, that the Bankruptcy Court is not making, either pursuant to the Plan or the Confirmation Order, a determination as to which Entity, including, without limitation, the Debtors, owns the claims asserted, or that could have been asserted, in the Texas Litigation; and,
provided
,
further
, that any and all direct claims against the Debtors and derivative claims of the Debtors, if any, that have been or could have been asserted against any Released Party in the Texas Litigation shall, upon the Effective Date, be released, discharged and enjoined.
In addition to, and not in any way limiting the foregoing, each holder of an Allowed WMB Senior Notes Claim and each Accepting Non-Filing WMB Senior Notes Holder shall be deemed to have released the Debtors, the Reorganized Debtors, and each of their respective Related Persons from any and all direct and derivative claims arising from or related to such holder’s WMB Senior Notes, as well as any misrepresentation or other similar claim for damages arising from the purchase or sale of such holder’s WMB Senior Notes (including, without limitation, any Section 510(b) Subordinated WMB Notes Claims that such holder may have).
Waiver of Section 1542
: All persons providing releases pursuant to the provisions of Section 41.6 of the Plan expressly and voluntarily waive Section 1542 of the California Civil Code, or any similar, comparable or equivalent provision of the statutory or non-statutory law of California or any other jurisdiction. Section 1542 provides:
A general release does not extend to claims under which the creditor does not know or suspect to exist in his or her favor at the time of executing the release, which if known by him or her
must have materially affected his or her settlement with the debtor.
41.7
Injunction Related to Releases
:
As of the Effective Date, all Entities that hold, have held, or may hold a Released Claim, an Estate Claim, any Released Third Party Causes of Action or an Equity Interest that is released pursuant to Sections 41.5 and 41.6 of the Plan, are, and shall be, permanently, forever and completely stayed, restrained, prohibited, barred and enjoined from taking any of the following actions, whether directly or indirectly, derivatively or otherwise, on account of or based on the subject matter of such discharged Released Claims, Estate Claim, Released Third Party Causes of Action or such Equity Interests: (i) commencing, conducting or continuing in any manner, directly or indirectly, any suit, action or other proceeding (including, without limitation, any judicial, arbitral, administrative or other proceeding) in any forum; (ii) enforcing, attaching (including, without limitation, any prejudgment attachment), collecting, or in any way seeking to recover any judgment, award, decree, or other order; (iii) creating, perfecting or in any way enforcing in any matter, directly or indirectly, any Lien; (iv) setting off, seeking reimbursement or contributions from, or subrogation against, or otherwise recouping in any manner, directly or indirectly, any amount against any liability or obligation owed to any Entity released under Sections 41.5 and 41.6 hereof; and (v) commencing or continuing in any manner, in any place of any judicial, arbitration or administrative proceeding in any forum, that does not comply with or is inconsistent with the provisions of the Plan or the Confirmation Order.
41.8
Exculpation
:
The Debtors, the Debtors’ officers and directors serving during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the Effective Date, the Creditors’ Committee and each of its members in their capacity as members of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and each of its members in their capacity as members of the Equity Committee, and each of their respective professionals shall not have or incur any liability to any Entity for any act taken or omitted to be taken in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases (including any actions taken by the Creditors’ Committee after the Effective Date), the formulation, preparation, dissemination, implementation, confirmation or approval of the Plan or any compromises or settlements contained therein, the Disclosure Statement and the Supplemental Disclosure Statement related thereto, the Global Settlement Agreement, or any contract, instrument, release or other agreement or document provided for or contemplated in connection with the consummation of the transactions set forth in the Plan and the Global Settlement Agreement;
provided
,
however
, that the foregoing provisions of this Section 41.8, shall not affect the liability of any Entity that otherwise would result from any such act or omission to the extent that such act or omission is determined in a Final Order to have constituted gross negligence or willful misconduct; and,
provided
,
further
, that, unless otherwise ordered by the Bankruptcy Court in connection with the Dime Warrant Litigation, the foregoing provisions of this Section 41.8 shall not affect the liability of any member of the Debtors’ Board of Directors and officers with respect to actions asserted in the Dime Warrant Litigation and relating to the period from the Petition Date up to and including the Effective Date. Nothing in the foregoing Section 41.8 shall prejudice the right of any of the Debtors, the Debtors’ officers and directors serving during the period from the Petition Date up to and including the Effective Date, the Creditors’ Committee and each of its members in their capacity as members of the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and each of its members in their capacity as members of the Equity Committee, and each of their respective professionals to assert reliance
upon advice of counsel as a defense with respect to their duties and responsibilities under the Plan.
41.9
Bar Order
:
To the limited extent provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan, each and every Entity is permanently enjoined, barred and restrained from instituting, prosecuting, pursuing or litigating in any manner any and all claims, demands, rights, liabilities, or causes of action of any and every kind, character or nature whatsoever, in law or in equity, known or unknown, direct or derivative, whether asserted or unasserted, against any of the Released Parties, based upon, related to, or arising out of or in connection with any of the Released Claims, the Debtors’ Claims, the JPMC Claims, the FDIC Claim, the Purchase and Assumption Agreement (other than any rights or claims the JPMC Entities, the Receivership, the FDIC Receiver or the FDIC Corporate may have under the Purchase and Assumption Agreement), confirmation and consummation of the Plan, the negotiation and consummation of the Global Settlement Agreement, or any claim, act, fact, transaction, occurrence, statement or omission in connection with or alleged or that could have been alleged in the Related Actions, including, without limitation, any such claim, demand, right, liability, or cause of action for indemnification, contribution, or any other basis in law or equity for damages, costs or fees incurred arising directly or indirectly from or otherwise relating to the Related Actions, either directly or indirectly by any Person for the direct or indirect benefit of any Released Party arising from or related to the claims, acts, facts, transactions, occurrences, statements or omissions that are, could have been or may be alleged in the Related Actions or any other action brought or that might be brought by, through, on behalf of, or for the benefit of any of the Released Parties (whether arising under federal, state or foreign law, and regardless of where asserted).
41.10
Deemed Consent
:
By submitting a Ballot or election form and receiving a distribution under or any benefit pursuant to this Plan and not electing to withhold consent to the releases of the applicable Released Parties and the Entities set forth in Section 41.6 of the Plan, or by order of the Bankruptcy Court, each holder of a Claim or Equity Interest shall be deemed, to the fullest extent permitted by applicable law, to have specifically consented to the releases set forth in Section 41.6 of the Plan.
41.11
No Waiver
:
Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in Sections 41.5 and 41.6 hereof, the releases and injunctions set forth in such sections shall not, and shall not be deemed to, limit, abridge or otherwise affect the rights of the Reorganized Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Liquidating Trustee, the JPMC Entities, the FDIC Receiver, or FDIC Corporate to enforce, sue on, settle or compromise the rights, claims and other matters expressly retained by any of them.
41.12
Supplemental Injunction
:
Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, except to the limited extent provided in Section 41.6 of the Plan, all Entities, including Entities acting on their behalf, who currently hold or assert, have held or asserted, or may hold or assert, any Released Claims or Equity Interests against any of the Released Parties based upon, attributable to, arising out of or relating to any Claim against or Equity Interest in any of the Debtors, whenever and wherever arising or asserted, whether in the U.S. or anywhere else in the world, whether sounding in tort, contract, warranty, statute, or any other theory of law, equity or otherwise, shall be, and shall be deemed to be, permanently stayed, restrained and enjoined from taking any action against any of the Released Parties for the purpose of directly or
indirectly collecting, recovering or receiving any payment or recovery with respect to any Released Claims or Equity Interests arising prior to the Effective Date (including prior to the Petition Date), including, but not limited to:
(a)
Commencing or continuing in any manner any action or other proceeding of any kind with respect to any such Released Claim or Equity Interest against any of the Released Parties or the assets or property of any Released Party;
(b)
Enforcing, attaching, collecting or recovering, by any manner or means, any judgment, award, decree or order against any of the Released Parties or the assets or property of any Released Party with respect to any such Released Claim or Equity Interest;
(c)
Creating, perfecting or enforcing any Lien of any kind against any of the Released Parties or the assets or property of any Released Party with respect to any such Released Claim or Equity Interest;
(d)
Except as otherwise expressly provided in the Plan, the Confirmation Order, or the Global Settlement Agreement, asserting, implementing or effectuating any setoff, right of subrogation, indemnity, contribution or recoupment of any kind against any obligation due to any of the Released Parties or against the property of any Released Party with respect to any such Released Claim or Equity Interest; and
(e)
Taking any act, in any manner, in any place whatsoever, that does not conform to, or comply with, the provisions of the Plan, the Confirmation Order, or the Global Settlement Agreement relating to such Released Claim or Equity Interest;
provided
,
however
, that the Debtors’ compliance with the formal requirements of Bankruptcy Rule 3016 shall not constitute an admission that the Plan provides for an injunction against conduct not otherwise enjoined under the Bankruptcy Code.
41.13
Term of Existing Injunctions or Stays
:
Unless otherwise provided, all injunctions or stays provided for in the Chapter 11 Cases pursuant to sections 105, 362, or 525 of the Bankruptcy Code, or otherwise, and in existence on the Confirmation Date, shall remain in full force and effect until entry of an order in accordance with Section
41.23 of the Plan or such other Final Order of the Bankruptcy Court;
provided
,
however
, that the terms of the Stock Trading Order shall remain in full force and effect forever, including, without limitation, with respect to any violation thereof on or before the Effective Date.
41.14
Payment of Statutory Fees
:
All fees payable pursuant to section 1930 of title 28 of the United States Code, and, if applicable, any interest payable pursuant to section 3717 of title 31 of the United States Code, as determined by the Bankruptcy Court, shall be obligations and liabilities of the Liquidating Trust and shall be paid on the Effective Date or thereafter as and when they become due or otherwise pursuant to an agreement between the Debtors and the United States Department Justice, Office of the United States Trustee, until such time as the Chapter 11 Cases are closed in accordance with the provisions of Section 41.23 of the Plan.
41.15
Post-Effective Date Fees and Expenses
:
From and after the Effective Date, the Reorganized Debtors shall, in the ordinary course of business and without the necessity for any approval by the Bankruptcy Court, retain professionals and pay the reasonable professional fees and expenses incurred by the Reorganized Debtors related to implementation and consummation of the Plan without further approval from the Bankruptcy Court.
41.16
Exemption from Transfer Taxes
:
Pursuant to sections 106, 1141 and 1146(a) of the Bankruptcy Code, the issuance, transfer, or exchange of notes or equity securities under or in connection with the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, the creation of any mortgage, deed of trust, or other security interest, the making or assignment of any lease or sublease, or the making or delivery of any deed or other instrument of transfer under, in furtherance of, or in connection with, the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement, including, without limitation, the Runoff Notes, the Reorganized Common Stock, the Trust Preferred Securities, and any merger agreements or agreements of consolidation, deeds, bills of sale, or assignments executed in connection with any of the transactions contemplated under the Plan or the Global Settlement Agreement shall not be subject to any stamp, real estate transfer, mortgage recording, sales, use or other similar Tax. The Confirmation Order shall direct all state and local government officials and agents to forego the collection of any such tax or governmental assessment and to accept for filing and recordation any instrument or other document issued or transferred pursuant to the Plan, without the payment of any such tax or government assessment.
41.17
Withdrawal of Equity Committee Proceedings
:
Without limiting the provisions of Section 35.2 of the Plan, on the Effective Date, the Equity Committee Adversary Proceeding and the Equity Committee Action to Compel, and any other proceeding or action instituted by the Equity Committee (including any appeal), shall be deemed withdrawn, with prejudice, without any further action.
41.18
Payment of Fees and Expenses of Certain Creditors
:
Within ninety (90) days of the Effective Date, (i) Fried, Frank, Harris, Shriver & Jacobson LLP, (ii) Blank Rome LLP, (iii) White & Case LLP, (iv) Kasowitz, Benson, Torres & Friedman LLP, (v) Zolfo Cooper LLC, (vi) Kramer, Levin, Naftalis & Frankel LLP and (vii) in accordance with Section 21.1(a) hereof, Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP, Pachulski Stang Ziehl & Jones LLP, and Boies, Schiller & Flexner LLP, to the extent any clients with respect to the foregoing professionals seek reimbursement for the payment of fees and expenses incurred, shall file with the Bankruptcy Court an application (for purposes of reviewing the reasonableness of the amounts requested therein), together with detailed invoices annexed thereto, requesting payment for reasonable fees and expenses incurred during the period from the Petition Date through and including the Effective Date, in connection with the Chapter 11 Cases, the Global Settlement Agreement, the Plan or the transactions contemplated herein or therein (including, without limitation, investigating, negotiating, documenting, and completing such transactions and enforcing, attempting to enforce, and preserving any right or remedy contemplated under the Global Settlement Agreement and in the Chapter 11 Cases). Within ten (10) Business Days of the entry of a Final Order by the Bankruptcy Court approving the payment thereof, in whole or in part, the Disbursing Agent shall pay such fees and expenses so approved.
41.19
Securities Litigations Documents
:
On the Effective Date, and to the extent that the Reorganized Debtors are formed, the Debtors shall not transfer any documents, in
electronic form or otherwise, to the Reorganized Debtors that relate to the claims, defenses and allegations in the Securities Litigations. All such documents will be transferred to the Liquidating Trust on the Effective Date and shall be thereafter maintained and preserved in accordance with the terms of the Liquidating Trust Agreement;
provided
,
however
, that, in the event that any documents are required for the operations of the Reorganized Debtors and are transferred to the Reorganized Debtors, copies of any such documents shall be transferred to the Liquidating Trust or the Effective Date and thereafter maintained and preserved in accordance with the terms of the Liquidating Trust Agreement.
41.20
Severability
:
If, prior to the Confirmation Date, any term or provision of the Plan shall be held by the Bankruptcy Court to be invalid, void or unenforceable, the Bankruptcy Court shall, with the consent of the Debtors, the Creditors’ Committee, the Equity Committee and AAOC, have the power to alter and interpret such term or provision to make it valid or enforceable to the maximum extent practicable, consistent with the original purpose of the term or provision held to be invalid, void or unenforceable, and such term or provision shall then be applicable as altered or interpreted. Notwithstanding any such holding, alteration, or interpretation, the remainder of the terms and provisions of the Plan shall remain in full force and effect and shall in no way be affected, impaired or invalidated by such holding, alteration or interpretation;
provided
,
however
, that, any holding, alteration or interpretation that alters, amends or modifies the definition of JPMC Assumed Liabilities or the releases provided in the Plan or the assets or benefits to be provided to JPMC pursuant to the Global Settlement Agreement absent JPMC’s express written consent (which may be withheld, delayed, or conditioned in JPMC’s sole discretion) shall render the remainder of the terms and provisions of the Plan and the Global Settlement Agreement of no force or effect. Except with respect to the foregoing proviso, the Confirmation Order shall constitute a judicial determination and shall provide that each term and provision of the Plan, as it may have been altered or interpreted, is valid and enforceable pursuant to its terms.
41.21
Governing Law
:
Except to the extent that the Bankruptcy Code or other federal law is applicable, or to the extent that an exhibit hereto or any document to be entered into in connection herewith provides otherwise, the rights, duties, and obligations arising under this Plan shall be governed by, and construed and enforced in accordance with, the Bankruptcy Code and, to the extent not inconsistent therewith, the laws of the State of New York, without giving effect to principles of conflicts of laws.
41.22
Notices
:
All notices, requests, and demands to or upon the Debtors, the Debtors in Possession, the Reorganized Debtors, or the Liquidating Trustee to be effective shall be in writing, including by facsimile transmission, and, unless otherwise expressly provided herein, shall be deemed to have been duly given or made when actually delivered or, in the case of notice by facsimile transmission, when received and telephonically confirmed, addressed as follows:
To the Debtors or the Debtors in Possession:
Washington Mutual, Inc.
1201 Third Avenue, Suite 3000
Seattle, Washington 98101
Attention: General Counsel
Telephone: (206) 432-8731
Facsimile: (206) 432-8879
With a copy to:
Weil, Gotshal & Manges LLP
767 Fifth Avenue
New York, New York 10153
Attention: Brian S. Rosen, Esq.
Telephone: (212) 310-8000
Facsimile: (212) 310-8007
41.23
Closing of Case
:
The Liquidating Trustee shall, promptly upon the full administration of the Chapter 11 Cases, file with the Bankruptcy Court all documents required by Bankruptcy Rule 3022 and any applicable order of the Bankruptcy Court.
41.24
Section Headings
:
The section headings contained in this Plan are for reference purposes only and shall not affect in any way the meaning or interpretation of the Plan.
41.25
Inconsistencies
: To the extent of any inconsistency between (a) the information contained in the Disclosure Statement and the terms and provisions of the Plan, the terms and provisions contained herein shall govern and (b) the terms and provisions of the Plan and the terms and provisions of the Confirmation Order, the terms and provisions of the Confirmation Order shall govern and be deemed a modification of the Plan;
provided
,
however
, that under no circumstances shall the Confirmation Order modify the economic terms set forth herein.
Dated:
|
Seattle, Washington
|
|
WASHINGTON MUTUAL, INC.
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/ William C. Kosturos
|
|
|
Name:
|
William C. Kosturos
|
|
|
Title:
|
Chief Restructuring Officer
|
|
WMI INVESTMENT CORP.
|
|
|
|
By:
|
/s/ William C. Kosturos
|
|
|
Name:
|
William C. Kosturos
|
|
|
Title:
|
President & Chief Executive Officer
|
|
/s/ Mark D. Collins
|
|
Mark D. Collins (No. 2981)
RICHARDS, LAYTON & FINGER, P.A.
One Rodney Square
920 North King Street
Wilmington, DE 19801
Telephone: (302) 651-7700
Facsimile: (302) 651-7701
– and –
Brian S. Rosen, Esq.
WEIL, GOTSHAL & MANGES LLP
767 Fifth Avenue
New York, New York 10153
Telephone: (212) 310-8000
Facsimile: (212) 310-8007
ATTORNEYS TO THE DEBTORS
AND DEBTORS IN POSSESSION
|
EXHIBIT A
CCB-1 GUARANTEES CLAIMS
Trust
|
Maturity Date
|
Security
Type
|
Notes Issuance
|
Allowed
Principal
|
Allowed
Accrued Interest
1
|
Allowed Total Amount
|
Post-Petition
Interest at the Federal Judgment Rate
2
|
Post-Petition Interest Pursuant to Contractual Subordination
3
|
CCB Capital Trust IV
|
October 8, 2033
|
Preferred
|
$7,500,000
|
$7,500,000
|
$94,843.83
|
$7,594,843.83
|
$520,150.04
|
$1,042,075.89
|
Common
|
$232,000
|
$232,000
|
$2,933.84
|
$234,933.84
|
$16,089.97
|
$32,234.88
|
CCB Capital Trust V
|
January 23, 2034
|
Preferred
|
$10,000,000
|
$10,000,000
|
$100,140.62
|
$10,100,140.62
|
$691,730.96
|
$1,306,262.57
|
Common
|
$310,000
|
$310,000
|
$3,104.36
|
$313,104.36
|
$21,443.66
|
$40,494.14
|
CCB Capital Trust VII
|
July 23, 2034
|
Preferred
|
$7,500,000
|
$7,500,000
|
$71,762.44
|
$7,571,762.44
|
$518,569.26
|
$905,843.12
|
Common
|
$232,000
|
$232,000
|
$2,219.85
|
$234,219.85
|
$16,041.08
|
$28,020.75
|
CCB Capital Trust VIII
|
July 23, 2034
|
Preferred
|
$7,500,000
|
$7,500,000
|
$76,485.09
|
$7,576,485.09
|
$518,892.70
|
$962,205.25
|
Common
|
$232,000
|
$232,000
|
$2,365.94
|
$234,365.94
|
$16,051.08
|
$29,764.22
|
______________________________
1
This amount includes interest accrued as of the Petition Date, and does not include any Post-Petition interest to which such Claim holders may be entitled.
2
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued at the Federal Judgment Rate of 1.95%, the weekly average 1-year constant maturity Treasury yield as of 9/26/08, through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012.
3
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued and OID accretion from the Petition Date through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012. Each holder’s Post-Petition Interest Claim will continue to accrue until the date that such holder’s Allowed CCB-1 Guarantees Claim and related Post-Petition Interest Claim are paid in full.
EXHIBIT B
CCB-2 GUARANTEES CLAIMS
Trust
|
Maturity Date
|
Security
Type
|
Notes Issuance
|
Allowed
Principal
|
Allowed
Accrued
Interest
4
|
Allowed Total Amount
|
Post-Petition
Interest at the Federal
Judgment
Rate
5
|
Post-Petition Interest Pursuant to Contractual
Subordination
6
|
HFC Capital Trust I
|
June 8, 2031
|
Preferred
|
$9,000,000
|
$9,000,000
|
$274,860.00
|
$9,274,860.00
|
$635,209.75
|
$3,771,954.66
|
Common
|
$300,000
|
$300,000
|
$9,162.00
|
$309,162.00
|
$21,173.66
|
$125,731.82
|
CCB Capital Trust VI
|
April 15, 2034
|
Preferred
|
$10,000,000
|
$10,000,000
|
$110,323.89
|
$10,110,323.89
|
$692,428.38
|
$1,288,552.32
|
Common
|
$310,000
|
$310,000
|
$3,420.04
|
$313,420.04
|
$21,465.28
|
$39,945.12
|
CCB Capital Trust IX
|
March 30, 2035
|
Preferred
|
$15,000,000
|
$15,000,000
|
$216,333.33
|
$15,216,333.33
|
$1,042,124.98
|
$2,123,709.19
|
Common
|
$464,000
|
$464,000
|
$6,691.91
|
$470,691.91
|
$32,236.40
|
$65,693.40
|
______________________________
4
This amount includes interest accrued as of the Petition Date, and does not include any Post-Petition interest to which such Claim holders may be entitled.
5
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued at the Federal Judgment Rate of 1.95%, the weekly average 1-year constant maturity Treasury yield as of 9/26/08, through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012.
6
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued and OID accretion from the Petition Date through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012. Each holder’s Post-Petition Interest Claim will continue to accrue until the date that such holder’s Allowed CCB-2 Guarantees Claim and related Post-Petition Interest Claim are paid in full.
B-1
EXHIBIT C
CREDIT AGREEMENT
C-1
EXHIBIT D
PIERS CLAIMS
Notes Issuance
|
Maturity Date
|
Allowed
Principal
|
Allowed
Accrued Interest
7
|
Allowed Total Amount
|
Post-Petition
Interest at the Federal
Judgment Rate
8
|
Post-Petition Interest Pursuant to Contractual Subordination
9
|
5.375% Junior Subordinated Deferrable Interest Debentures
|
Preferred Securities
|
May 1, 2041
|
$756,230,623.24
|
$9,443,576.39
|
$765,674,199.63
|
$52,438,927.92
|
N/A
|
Common Securities
10
|
May 1, 2041
|
$23,387,254.01
|
$292,052.86
|
$23,679,306.87
|
$1,621,730.84
|
N/A
|
______________________________
7
This amount includes interest accrued as of the Petition Date, and does not include any Post-Petition interest to which such Claim holders may be entitled.
8
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued at the Federal Judgment Rate of 1.95%, the weekly average 1-year constant maturity Treasury yield as of 9/26/08, through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012. Each holder’s Post-Petition Interest Claim will continue to accrue until the date that such holder’s Allowed PIERS Claim and related Post-Petition Interest Claim are paid in full.
9
Pursuant to the Opinion issued on September 13
th
, 2011, all creditors are entitled to post-petition interest at the federal judgment rate. Due to the PIERS contractual subordination, PIERS holders will pay up to more senior creditors at the contract rate. This will limit the recovery of the PIERS holders to an amount less than their prepetition claim. Therefore, the PIERS will not recover any post-petition interest and a chart has not been included.
10
These securities are owned by WMI.
D-1
EXHIBIT E
SENIOR NOTES CLAIMS
Notes Issuance
|
Maturity Date
|
Allowed
Principal
|
Allowed
Accrued Interest
11
|
Allowed Total Amount
|
Post-Petition
Interest at the Federal
Judgment Rate
12
|
Post-Petition Interest Pursuant to Contractual Subordination
13
|
4.0% Notes
|
January 15, 2009
|
$804,984,292.60
|
$6,351,912.45
|
$811,336,205.05
|
$55,566,193.55
|
$118,367,621.56
|
4.2% Notes
|
January 15, 2010
|
$504,220,132.10
|
$4,178,270.72
|
$508,398,402.82
|
$34,818,813.55
|
$78,200,055.34
|
5.5% Notes
|
August 24, 2011
|
$361,181,452.96
|
$1,766,795.55
|
$362,948,248.51
|
$24,857,331.03
|
$74,533,431.72
|
5.0% Notes
|
March 22, 2012
|
$374,791,867.96
|
$208,722.22
|
$375,000,590.18
|
$25,682,762.89
|
$70,307,128.80
|
5.25% Notes
|
September 15, 2017
|
$726,744,896.63
|
$1,171,426.67
|
$727,916,323.30
|
$49,852,994.43
|
$143,676,877.37
|
Floating Rate Notes
|
August 24, 2009
|
$358,645,000.00
|
$911,252.44
|
$359,556,252.44
|
$24,625,022.51
|
$10,187,795.02
|
Floating Rate Notes
|
January 15, 2010
|
$175,500,000.00
|
$1,099,878.10
|
$176,599,878.10
|
$12,094,841.75
|
$6,965,280.76
|
Floating Rate Notes
|
March 22, 2012
|
$363,350,000.00
|
$141,454.17
|
$363,491,454.17
|
$24,894,533.70
|
$12,776,152.32
|
Floating Rate Notes
|
September 17, 2012
|
$446,815,000.00
|
$359,267.16
|
$447,174,267.16
|
$30,625,740.26
|
$17,226,159.27
|
______________________________
11
This amount includes interest accrued as of the Petition Date, and does not include any Post-Petition interest to which such Claim holders may be entitled.
12
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued at the Federal Judgment Rate of 1.95%, the weekly average 1-year constant maturity Treasury yield as of 9/26/08, through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012.
13
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued and OID accretion from the Petition Date through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012. Each holder’s Post-Petition Interest Claim will continue to accrue until the date that such holder’s Allowed Senior Notes Claim and related Post-Petition Interest Claim are paid in full.
E-1
EXHIBIT F
SENIOR SUBORDINATED NOTES CLAIMS
Notes Issuance
|
Maturity Date
|
Allowed
Principal
|
Allowed
Accrued Interest
14
|
Allowed Total Amount
|
Post-Petition
Interest at the Federal
Judgment Rate
15
|
Post-Petition Interest Pursuant to Contractual Subordination
16
|
8.250% Notes
|
April 1, 2010
|
$451,870,530.25
|
$18,133,500.00
|
$470,004,030.25
|
$32,189,288.18
|
$150,685,503.85
|
4.625% Notes
|
April 1, 2014
|
$729,187,229.50
|
$16,449,467.71
|
$745,636,697.21
|
$51,066,614.28
|
$128,616,663.37
|
7.250% Notes
|
November 1, 2017
|
$437,962,198.47
|
$12,862,043.75
|
$450,824,242.22
|
$30,875,717.05
|
$126,532,649.40
|
______________________________
14
This amount includes interest accrued as of the Petition Date, and does not include any Post-Petition interest to which such Claim holders may be entitled.
15
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued at the Federal Judgment Rate of 1.95%, the weekly average 1-year constant maturity Treasury yield as of 9/26/08, through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012.
16
This amount includes the estimated amount of interest accrued and OID accretion from the Petition Date through an expected Effective Date of February 29, 2012. Each holder’s Post-Petition Interest Claim will continue to accrue until the date that such holder’s Allowed Senior Subordinated Notes Claim and related Post-Petition Interest Claim are paid in full.
F-1
EXHIBIT G
BENEFIT PLANS
Legacy Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plans - DEFINED CONTRIBUTION
|
Abbreviation
|
Full Name
|
Bowery Savings - DCP
|
Bowery Savings - Deferred Compensation Plan
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - CAP
|
Capital Accumulation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - CDCP
|
1989 Contingent Deferred Compensation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - EDCP
|
Elective Deferred Compensation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - LCCAP
|
Loan Consultant Capital Accumulation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - LCEDCP
|
Loan Agents' Elective Deferred Compensation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - ODCAP
|
Outside Directors' Capital Accumulation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - ODEDCP
|
Outside Directors' Elective Deferred Compensation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
|
|
Legacy Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plans - DEFINED BENEFIT
|
Abbreviation
|
Full Name
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - EDCP CAP
|
PROVISIONS WITHIN THE: Elective Deferred Compensation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company & Capital Accumulation Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - ELIP
|
Executive Life Insurance Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - HSB ODRP
|
Ahmanson / Home Savings Bank Outside Directors Retirement Plan
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - ODRP
|
Outside Director Retirement Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - SERP
|
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. – SSERP
|
Senior Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
|
|
WMI Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plans
|
Abbreviation
|
Full Name
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - DCP
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - Deferred Compensation Plan
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - SERP
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - SERAP
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - Supplemental Executive Retirement Accumulation Plan
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - ETRIP
|
Washington Mutual, Inc. - Executive Target Retirement Income Plan
|
Individual Contracts
|
Abbreviation
|
Full Name
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - AHM Supplemental
|
HFA AHM Supplemental - Hazel Legg
|
(collection of individual contracts)
|
HFA AHM Supplemental - Anna Varosy
|
H.F. Ahmanson & Co. - Individual Contracts
|
HFA Individual Contract - John Holoman
|
|
HFA Individual Contract - Charles Roussin
|
|
HFA Individual Contract - Bruce Manley
|
|
HFA Individual Contract - William Wiley
|
|
|
Split Dollar Plans
|
Abbreviation
|
Full Name
|
HFA ELIP
|
Executive Life Insurance Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
HFA SELIP
|
Senior Executive Life Insurance Plan of H. F. Ahmanson & Company
|
EXHIBIT H
WATERFALL RECOVERY MATRIX
EXHIBIT H
WATERFALL RECOVERY MATRIX
Washington Mutual, Inc.
Waterfall Recovery Matrix
|
|
Senior Fixed
Rate Notes
|
Senior
Floating
Rate Notes
|
Senior
Subordinated
Notes
|
CCB
Guarantees
(
17)
|
PIERS
|
General
Unsecured Creditors
|
510(b) Sub.
Claims
|
Preferred
Stock
|
Recovery
(
18
)
|
Tranche 1
|
Prepetition
Claim
|
Prepetition
Claim
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
Pro Rata
Share Based
on Prepetition
Claims
(
19
)
|
|
|
Tranche 2
(
20
)
|
Intercreditor
Interest Claim
|
Intercreditor
Interest Claim
|
Prepetition
Claim &
Intercreditor
Interest Claim
|
–
|
–
|
Pro Rata
Share Based
on Prepetition
Claims
(3)
|
–
|
–
|
Late Filed
Claims
(
21
)
|
Post-Petition
Interest
Claim
(
22
)
|
Tranche 3
|
–
|
|
–
|
Prepetition
Claim &
Intercreditor
Interest Claim
|
–
|
Post-Petition
Interest
Claim
(6)
|
–
|
–
|
Tranche 4
|
–
|
|
–
|
–
|
PIERS Claim
|
–
|
–
|
Remaining Postpetition
Interest
Claim
(
23
)
|
Tranche 5
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
Claims
|
–
|
Tranche 6
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
–
|
|
Claims
|
Notes:
______________________________
(
1
)
CCB Guarantees include HFC Capital Trust I, CCB Capital Trust IV, CCB Trust V, CCB Trust VI, CCB Capital Trust VII, CCB Capital Trust VIII and CCB Capital Trust IX.
(2
)
Eligible claims in Tranches will be paid in order with Tranche 1 claims receiving disbursements first and Tranche 5 claims receiving disbursements last. Tranche 1 eligible claims must be satisfied in full prior to Tranche 2 eligible claims receiving disbursements and so forth. For information regarding the distribution of Reorganized Common Stock, see Sections 6.2, 7.2, 16.2, 18.2, 19.2, 20.2 and 32.1(a) of the Plan.
(3
)
Pro Rata share of General Unsecured Claims are calculated by (a) determining the fraction in which the numerator equals the amount of General Unsecured Claims and the denominator equals the total amount of prepetition claims, and (b) by multiplying that by total cash distributed within the Tranche. The cash distributed within the Tranche is the lesser of (i) the amount necessary to satisfy all claims within the Tranche or (ii) the amount of cash available.
(4
)
Within Tranche 2, the Senior Notes Intercreditor Interest Claim and the Subordinated Notes Prepetition Claim and Intercreditor Interest Claim will share pro rata based on the size of those claims. For the calculation of the General Unsecured Creditors' pro rata share in all Tranches, see footnote 3.
(5
)
Late filed claims will be paid only after all other prepetition claims (other than Subordinated Claims) are paid in full without giving effect to applicable turnover provisions. Late filed claims will not share pro rata with any other claims. Therefore, to the extent late filed claims are paid, this will create a break in the recovery of other creditors prior to their recovery on account of post-petition interest from the Debtors. The placement of late filed claims in the chart above is illustrative only, as the size of the pre-petition Allowed General Unsecured Claims and the amount of post-petition interest turned over on account of contractual subordination provisions will influence their position in the waterfall. The late filed claims will, in any event, be paid immediately after satisfaction of pre-petition Allowed General Unsecured Claims, but prior to the payment of post-petition interest and Subordinated Claims.
(6
)
If it is provided for in an applicable contract or by law, the General Unsecured Creditors' Post-Petition Interest Claim will share pro rata with distributions to holders of PIERS claims on account of post-petition interest with respect to all post-petition interest claims, including Post-Petition Interest Claims to which the holders of PIERS Claims have been subrogated (on account of turnover in accordance with contractual subordination provisions). The chart above is illustrative only, as the point at which the Allowed General Unsecured Claims begin receiving post-petition interest is dependent on the size of the Allowed General Unsecured prepetition claims and the amount of post-petition interest paid pursuant to contractual subordination.
(7
)
The Senior Floating Rate Notes Remaining Post-Petition Interest Claim will be paid only when interest in excess of the contract rate would have been paid if such payment were actually being made by the Debtors as opposed to by reason of contractual subordination. After that trigger has been met (currently projected to occur during the payouts in Tranche 4), that claim will be paid pari passu with the remaining claims in Tranche 4.
EXHIBIT I
GLOBAL SETTLEMENT AGREEMENT
I-1
EXHIBIT J
RUNOFF NOTE INDENTURE
J-1